Andronov Bifurcations
Andronov Bifurcations
Andronov Bifurcations
T.-l
? i
"-<Sh
A. A. ANDRONOV, E.A. LEONTOVICH, q.1
THEORY OF BIFURCATIONS
OF DYNAMIC SYSTEMS
ON A PLA N E
J '~
, . ' ,- . - .
Translated from Russian 2 .
.
:..
,u
~
-- >?"
1I111llillll00b9000
llllliIIililI I
A.A. Andronov, E.A. Leontovich,
1.1. Gordon, and A.G. Maier
THEORY OF BIFURCATIONS
OF DYNAMIC SYSTEMS
ON A PLANE
(Teoriya bifurkatsii dinamicheskikh sistem
na ploskosti)
I
Published P u r s u a n t to an A g r e e m e n t with
THE NATIONAL AERONAUTICS AND SPACE ADMINISTRATION
and
T H E NATIONAL SCIENCE FOUNDATION, WASHINGTON, D. C.
Copyright 8 1971
Iaael Rogram for Scimtific Trandadonr L?d#
IPST Cat. NO. 5438
T r a n s l a t e d by IPST staff
Available f r o m the
u. s. DEPARTMENT OF COMMERCE
National Technical Information Service
Springfield, Va. 22151
I XII/lB/S I
PREFACE
E. A. Leontovich
I. I. Gordon
Gor'kii, 1 9 6 6
iv
Table of Contents
Introduction ..................................... 1
introduction .........................................
9 3. C l o s e n e s s of solutions. Regular t r a n s f o r m a t i o n of close
systems ........................................ 23
1. Theorems of closeness of solutions (23). 2. E -closeness of regions. Lemmas of regular
transformation (27).
Introduction ..................................... 50
vi
i 15. S t r u c t u r a l l y unstable c l o s e d paths - ---. .- - - - 124
1. The fundamental l e m m a (124). 2. The thcorem of the creation of d closed path from a
multiple limit c y c l e (127). 3. Structural instability of a closed path with a zero characterlstic
index (133).
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . , 136
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202
. S22.The d e g r e e of s t r u c t u r a l instability and bifurcations of
dynamic s y s t e m s . . ............................... 203
-
multiple equilibrium state with u # o (222). 3. The character of the structurally stable
equilibrium states obtained from a multiple equilibrium state with a 0 (227).
Introduction .................................... 2 38
...
Vlll
5 29. Creation of limit c y c l e s f r o m t h e s e p a r a t r i x loop of a
s i m p l e saddle point ................................ 299
1. s o m e properties of the separamx loop (299). 2. Theorems of the creation of a closed path
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 377
iY
Chapter XIV. THE APPLICATION O F THE THEORY O F
BIFURCATIONS T O THE INVESTIGATION O F PARTICULAR
DYNAMIC SYSTEMS . . . . . . . .. . . .. .. . . . . . . .. .. . . . . . . 423
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 423
Appendix . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . .. . . . . . . .. .. . . 462
1. Theorems of the continuous dependence of the solutions of a system of differential equations
on the right-hand sides and of the differentiability of solutions (462). 2. A proposition regarding
functions of many variables (468). 3. The l e m m a about the normals of a simple smooth closed
curve (469). 4. Proof of the differentiability of the function R (P. e) with respect to P (471).
5. A remark concerning the definition of a structurally stable dynamic system (477).
X
INTR 0D UC TION
xii
Structurally stable s y s t e m s a r e the rule, so t o say, in the m e t r i c s p a c e
whose points a r e dynamic s y s t e m s defined in s o m e region. It is shown
in Chapter VI that s t r u c t u r a l l y stable s y s t e m s f o r m a n open everywhere
dense s e t in this space. The s e t of s t r u c t u r a l l y stable s y s t e m s is
partitioned into components, each consisting of s t r u c t u r a l l y stable s y s t e m s
of identical topological s t r u c t u r e . The "partitions" between these
components consist of s t r u c t u r a l l y unstable dynamic s y s t e m s . When a
dynamic s y s t e m is a l t e r e d or modified, i t s topological s t r u c t u r e will
change only i f the s y s t e m p a s s e s through an intermediate s t a g e of
s t r u c t u r a l instability. The t h e o r y o f b i f u r c a t i o n s, which is con-
c e r n e d with changes in the topological s t r u c t u r e of dynamic s y s t e m s ,
t h e r e f o r e appropriately concentrates on s t r u c t u r a l l y unstable s y s t e m s .
St tucturally unstable s;ystems a r e a l s o of i n t e r e s t in applications: the so-
called conservative s y s t e m s (see Chapter XIII), often encountered in
physics, a r e s t r u c t u r a l l y unstable. We a r e thus naturally led t o a detailed
examination of s t r u c t u r a l l y unstable s y s t e m s .
T h e f i r s t s t e p in t h i s direction evidently involves a classification of
s t r u c t u r a l l y unstable s,ystems. Structurally unstable s y s t e m s can be
divided into ''less s t r u c t u r a l l y unstable" and " m o r e s t r u c t u r a l l y unstable."
T h i s l e a d s to a classification according to the d e g r e e s o f s t r u c t u r a 1
i n s t a b i 1 i t y origin;illy introduced in / 9 / . The least structurally
unstable s y s t e m s in t h i s classification a r e the s y s t e m s o f t h e f i r s t
d e g r e e o f s t r u c t u r a l i n s t a b i l i t y : under s m a l l changes, t h e s e
s y s t e m s e i t h e r go to a s t r u c t u r a l l y unstable s y s t e m or retain t h e i r
topological s t r u c t u r e . The complete conditions f o r a s y s t e m t o be of the
f i r s t d e g r e e of s t r u c t u r a l instability w e r e derived f o r plane s y s t e m s (see
/9, IO/; t h e s e conditions are derived in Chapter XII). A dynamic s y s t e m
of the f i r s t d e g r e e of s t r u c t u r a l instability was found t o have one and only
one s t r u c t u r a l l y unstable singular path, i.e., it h a s either a multiple
equilibrium state, or i multiple l i m i t cycle, o r a saddle-to-saddle
separatrix." T o establish the bifurcations of a s y s t e m of the f i r s t d e g r e e
of s t r u c t u r a l instability, it suffices t o consider the changes in i t s topological
s t r u c t u r e in the neighborhood of i t s s t r u c t u r a l l y unstable singular path.
Bifurcations involving a change in the number of l i m i t cycles - i.e.,
bifurcations in which k m i t c y c l e s a r e c r e a t e d or d e s t r o y e d - a r e
of p a r t i c u l a r i n t e r e s t in theory and in applications. Dynamic s y s t e m s of the
f i r s t degree of s t r u c t u r a l instability m a y only exhibit the following
instances of creation of limit cycles: f r o m the multiple focus of the s y s t e m ,
f r o m the multiple cycle_.,f r o m a loop of a saddle-point s e p a r a t r i x , f r o m a
loop of a saddle-node s e p a r a t r i x . The v a r i o u s cases a r e t r e a t e d s e p a r a t e l y
in Chapters IX through XII. Note that the m a t e r i a l presented in t h i s chapter
applies t o bifurcations of s y s t e m s of both f i r s t and higher d e g r e e s of
s t r u c t u r a l inst ability.
T h e concepts of s t r u c t u r a l instability, d e g r e e s of s t r u c t u r a l instability,
and especially examination of the s i m p l e s t bifurcations l e a d s t o a number
of techniques f o r the investigation of p a r t i c u l a r differential equations.
T h e s e techniques w e r e successfully applied t o a number of equations of
s p e c i a l physical i n t e r e s t (see, e.g., /2, 3, 20, 2 5 - 2 8 1 ) .
* Certain additionai conditions !hould also be rausfied; they are formulated in Chapter XII.
xtii
Chapter XIV is e n t i r e l y devoted to examples of dynamic s y s t e m s ,
analyzed by the tools of the t h e o r y of bifurcations.
Chapter XI11 occupies a somewhat s p e c i a l position in t h e book: it
t r e a t s the c r e a t i o n of limit cycles f r o m closed paths of conservative
systems.
xiv
Chapter I
JIULTIPLICITY OF ROOTS OF FUNCTIONS AND
.ZIULTIPLICITY OF INTERSECTION POINTS OF
TWO CUR Y E S
IhTRODUCTION
J 1. h 1 U L T l P L I C I T Y OF A ROOT OF A F U N C T I O N
1. 6 - c l o s e n e s s to r a n k : r
\Ve w i l l consider functions defined a t all points :VI (r,,I$. ..., z,,) of s o m e
open (or c l o s e d ) region G (or 4 ) i n n-dimensional euclidean s p a c e E , . In
I
applications we w i l l be mainly concerned with the c a s e s n = 1 o r n = 2.
Here it is assumed, however, that n is any natural number.
A function is said to be a function of c l a s s k in G (or E,), where k is a
natural number, if it is continuous and continuously differentiable up to
o r d e r k , inclusive, in i t s domain of definition; a function is said to be a
function of the analytical c l a s s in s o m e region if it is analytical in that
region."
.
Let Fo (xi, x 2 , . ., a)be a function of c l a s s k or a n analytical function in
G (or C , ) > 8 is some positive number, r a natural number such that r < k if
Fo is a function of c l a s s k .
D e f i n i t i o n 1 . Afunction F(xlrx2,...,x,,) of class k , > r oranalytical
in G (8,) i s said to be 8 -close to rank r to the function Fo(x,,xZr . ., x,,) in the .
region G(C,) if at any point of the region
where 1
... + % = I .
- . . ., r , all
1,2, ai are non-negative numbers and a,+ a2 +- ...
Clearly i f two functions a r e 8-close to rank r in some region G, they a r e
8 - c l o s e to any r a n k r, < r in that region; moreover, f o r any 81, 8 , , 8 , they
a r e b1-close to rank r in any subregion of G.
If everywhere in the region we only have the one inequality
F, (2) = p sin 5
I('
( p > 0). For any given 6 > 0, an appropriate choice of a sufficiently small p
* If 5,is closed and Mo is a boundary point, partial derivatives (of any order and type) do not necessarily
exist at Mo. In this case, a partial derivative at M o is defined as the limit value of the corresponding
partial derivative at an inner point M when M tends to d d o (see /ll/, Vol. I, Sec. 258, p. 589). An
analytical function in a closed region is evidently defined in some larger open domain.
will c l e a r l y make this function 8-close to z e r o , but only to rank 0.
Indeed,
I
F ; (x)= -COS
P
<P
and as p d e c r e a s e s , the upper bound of F; (5) i n c r e a s e s to infinity. T h e r e -
fore, if 6 is sufficiently s m a l l , w e c a n never choose a p that w i l l e n s u r e
6 - c l o s e n e s s of F, (I) to z e r o to rank higher than 0. It is a l s o clear that,
by an appropriate choice of a sufficiently s m a l l p, the function
3
Ch. 1. MULTIPLICITY OF ROOTS AND INTERSECTION POINTS
and
F r o m (l), (2), and ( 3 ) i t follows that rp(x, y) is the unique solution of the
equation
F ( x , y, 2) -0 (4)
in A, and the surface
z-'p(+, Y)
h a s no common points either with the top o r the bottom of A . Moreover,
in virtue of the theorem of implicit functions, rp ( 5 , y) is a function of c l a s s k .
T h e o r e m 3. Forany e>Othereexists 6>0suchthatfmany
function p ( x , y, z) defined in A which is 6-close to rank r ( I < r < k ) to
F ( x , y, 2) the equation
F ( x , y, z ) = O
has a solution
defined in the rectangle R , such that (a) @(x, y) is the only solution of
equation (5 1 in A; (b) @(x, y) is a function of class 2 r ana' i s e - close to the
function ' p ( x , y) to rank r .
P r o o f . According to o u r assumptions, inequality ( 2 ) is satisfied a t
any point of the rectangle R:
21 < 'p ( 5 , Y) <z2.
Therefore, if e, >0 is sufficiently s m a l l , we have
zi < q@, Y) * 8, <zz. (6)
W e choose e,>O which satisfies condition (6), such that e i < e . By (1) in A
F ; ( x , y, z ) # O .
To fix ideas, let in A
F;(x, Y, 4>0. (7)
F r o m ( 3 ) , ( 6 ) , and (7) i t follows that in R
F ( G Y, ~ ( x Y. ) - ~ I ) < 0, F ( x , Y, y)+ed>
(~(2. 0. (8)
Now since F and cp a r e continuous, w e conclude f r o m (8) that a t any point in
H
F ( s , Y, ~ ( x y)-el)<-c,
, F ( x , Y, cp(x, y ) + e J > c , (9)
4
ii. -.I( L I P L L C ~ T YOF A ROL)I' OF .A F L K C T W L
w h e r e c is a p o s i t i v e n u m b e r . LIoreover, f r o m i n e q u a l i t y ( 7 ) we c o n c l u d e
that i n 1
F; ( x . y. z ) m, (10)
x.rhere m i s a p o s i t i v e n u m b e r .
L.et b b e s u c h t h a t
C o n s i d e r a n y functicm F ( x . y, ; ) d e f i n e d i n A which is 8 - c l o s e to r a n k r to
t h e function F ( s . y. z ) i n A . F r o m t h e d e f i n i t i o n of 8 - c l o s e n e s s a n d f r o m
re1ation.s ( S i , ( l o ) , a n d (11) i t f o l l o w s t h a t i n 1
a n d that
F; -7 FIT,) =.:1
F; 1- F;vq = U, (15)
F:x C 2F;,v; + F;, (9;)' C F&iX = 0.
....................
a n d t h e p a r t i a l d e r i v a t i i . e s of &-,y) a r e c a l c u l a t e d f r o m analogous equations:
S i n c e F ; ( x . y , z ) # 0 n o w h e r e i n A, t h e p a r t i a l d e r i v a t i v e s of 'p (s,y) t o o r d e r r
i n c l u s i v e a r e c o n t i n u o u s f u n c t i o n s of t h e a r g u m e n t s F;. F I , FI, F I X , F&. .... F:;',
a n d t h e r a n g e of t h e s e a r g u m e n t s c a n b e r e g a r d e d as a c l o s e d r e g i o n .
Hence i t c l e a r l y f o l l o w s t h a t if 8 > 0 is s u f f i c i e n t l y s m a l l , e.g., 6 < 6!, a n d
t h e function 7 is 6 - c l o s e t o r a n k r t o F , t h e f u n c t i o n (p ( 5 , y) is &-closet o
r a n k r to 'p (I. y). Thus any positive number 6 s m a l l e r than 5- , ,;- a n d 6,
satisfies the theorem. This c o m p l e t e s the proof.
5
I Ch. I. MIJLTIPLICITY OF ROOTS A N D INTERbECTlUN POINTS
2 ) the equation
F I ( ~Y,, u , v)=O
h a s in IT the solution
u = e (z,Y, u),
defined a t any point x , y, u, xI<x<xz, y,<y<y,, ul<u<u2, such that
u, < 0 ( 5 , y, u) < u2. Since %# 0, this solution is unique;
3 ) the equation
F~ (2,Y, U, e (5,Y, U N =o
h a s a solution u=cp(x, y) in the rectangle R,
6
51. \ICLTIPL[CiTY OF A R O O T OF A FUliCTIOZ
* Theorem 3 applies to functions of three variables. Nevertheless, it c a n be formulated and proved without
modifications for a function of any number of variables.
7
Ch. I. MULTIPLICITY OF ROOTS AND INTERSECTION POINTS
We choose one of t h e s e z, s a y zlr and keep i t fixed. Then 0 < z, < q l and
F ( 5 1 ) = 2: Q, (51) > 0. If a , - i is of sufficiently s m a l l magnitude, the function
F1 (I) = + z"Q, ( z ) a t the point x , h a s the s a m e sign a s the function
F ( x ) . The number a,-,t h e r e f o r e can b e chosen so that
+ JCD (z)).
Fl (z)= z"-l (a,,-,
Fl (zl)=U,,-lz~-'+z~CD(z~<o.
+
Fz (zz)= c%-,zn-* F1 (z)= zn-' (G-2 + + 20 (z)).
The number is chosen so that
an-, >0, I %-, I <6, F2(zl)>0, <0.
Fz (zz)
8
$1. .:C'LTIPBICITY OF .A ROOI' OF A FLihCflON
and
where 1 < k l < k2 < . . . < k,+i s n - 1, and s < n. In t h i s case w e can choose
(sufficiently s m a l l ) n u m b e r s aki such that in any a r b i t r a r i l y s m a l l neighbor-
hood of the point z = Cl the function F @) h a s a t least s different r o o t s . This
proposition is proved like the l e m m a . A s i m i l a r r e m a r k applies to
functions considered i n Remark 1.
9
Ch.1. MULTIPLICITY OF ROOTS AND INTERSECTION POINTS
I F"'(z)I >E
2 - E.=
4 E>
4 0. (18)
= zro(I),
F, (I) (19)
~ ) ( e x ) (0 < e
F o ( 4 = z r F7 < 1).
Setting
Q , ( I ) = ~f o r z.fO and a ( 0 ) = l i m @ ( z ) = TFP)
, (0)
-0
10
51. E.IULT[PLICITY OF A ROOT OF A FCNCTION
or
(if the function Fo (I) is a polynomial, Fo (I) itself can be chosen a s P (2)).
P (3)h a s the f o r m zr+W ( x ) , where cf, (I) is s o m e polynomial. We may take
Q(0) # 0 (otherwise, we may take f o r P (z) the function xr+i (Q (I) + y ) , where
y is a sufficiently s m a l l number, y # 0). By L e m m a 1 t h e r e e x i s t s a
polynomial P ( 5 ) which is 6/2-close t o r a n k r to P ( I ) , and t h e r e f o r e 6 - c l o s e
to r a n k r to F , (z)~ and which h a s a t l e a s t r + 1 r o o t s for I z I < e . Hence,'
2' = 0 is not a root of multiplicty r f o r Fo (s). T h i s completes the proof.
It follows f r o m Theorem 5 that f o r analytical functions, and in p a r t i c u l a r
for polynomials, root multiplicity in the s e n s e of Definition 2 coincides with
the n o r m a l concept of multiplicity.
R e m a r k . Let z = 0 be a s i m p l e root of the function Fo (z), i.e., r = 1,
Fo (0)= 0 , Fi (0)# 0. Then t h e r e exist e, > 0 and 6o > 0 such that any function
F (.r) which is 6,-close to FO (I) h a s precisely one root f o r I z I < eo, which is
m o r e o v e r a s i m p l e root. F u r t h e r m o r e , f o r any e < e,, e > 0, we s a n find
6 > 0 such that any function F (z), 6-close to Fo (I), h a s p r e c i s e l y o n e ( s i m p l e )
root f o r \ z I < E .
Indeed, f o r eo we may take any number such that the derivative F; (3)does
not vanish on the segment I x I < e O . Then on t h i s segment I F; (z) I ,m > 0
and for 6, we may take, say, any positive number which s a t i s f i e s the
inequality
12
$1. \!L'LTLPLLCITY OF A ROOT OF A FCKCTION
W, c mp c W A c
13
Ch.1. MULTIPLICITY OF ROOTS AND INTERSECTION POINTS
1. Definition of multiplicity
F , ( x . y) = 0, Fz ( x , y) = 0. (11
14
$2. hIL'LTPLLCITY OF A CO!.l~.lOS POIKT OF T W O CCRVES
y=O, ~-FO(Z)=O. (2 1
2. Condition of s i m p l i c i t y f o r a n i n t e r s e c t i o n point
of two c u r v e s
15
Ch.1. MULTIPLICITY OF ROOTS AND INTERSECTION POINTS
FZ (5,Y) = 0 (CZ)
+
Pi (z,Y) = A i s + B , y C l i . . . .+
Pz (5,Y) = A z J + Bzy+ C ~ Z . . . + .
where A -1
O-
4 BBiz
A,
I = 0, but a t l e a s t one of the coefficients A I , B,, A,, B, does
16
F , (s,y) and F 2 ( x , y), re:.pectively). Then the c u r v e s pt ( r ,y) = 0 and PZ( x , y) =
= 0 have a t l e a s t two common points in U e (0), namely the point 0 and the
point MI. This c l e a r l y signifies that the intersection point 0 of the c u r v e s
F I (2. y) = 0 and F Z ( x , y)= 0 in case ( a ) is not a s i m p l e ( s t r u c t u r a l l y
s t a b l e ) intersection point of t h e s e c u r v e s .
In case (b), when
6
are -close to the polynomials P I and Pf, respectively, and the c u r v e s
pi (5. Y) = 0 and PZ( x , y)= 0 p a s s through the point kf. Thus again 0 ( 0 , O ) is
not a simple point ot c u r v e s (C,) and (C2). We have proved that the condition
S = 0 is n e c e s s a r y . Tne sufficiency of this condition follows directly f r o m
Theorem 4, if we a s s u m e that the functions F , , F 2 and F,, FZof that t h e o r e m
are dependent on x and y only ( s e e r e m a r k to T h e o r e m 4). This completes
the proof.
R e m a r k 1. If the original functions F, (z,y) and Fz ( x , y) are polynomials,
w e may take them as the polynomials Pi and P?. Then the polynomials
P , ( x , y) and P, ( r ,y) constructed in o u r proof of the necessity of condition ( 4 )
are of the s a m e d e g r e e as the polynomials F, and F Z respectively.
R e m a r k 2. It follows f r o m condition ( 4 ) that if O ( 0 , 0 ) is a simple
intersection point of c u r v e s ( C , ) and (C2),the angle between these c u r v e s
a t the point 0 is o t h e r than z e r o , i.e., the c u r v e s a r e not tangent to each
other a t this point.
R e m a r k 3 . A s i m p l e (structurally s t a b l e ) intersection point 0 ( 0 , 0 )
of the c u r v e s ( C , )and (C:!)h a s the following property: t h e r e exist E O > 0 and
60 > 0 such that if the functions cD1 ( x , y) and ~ D (z r ,y) a r e &,-close t o the
functions F , ( r , y) and F2 (s,y). respectively, the c u r v e s
have exactly one intersection point in U, (0) and this intersection point is
a l s o simple. hloreovei-, r e g a r d l e s s of how s m a l l E < E~ is, So can be made
sufficiently s m a l l s o that t h i s intersection point f a l l s inside C', (0).
The validity of t h i s r e m a r k follows directly f r o m T h e o r e m 4 ($1. 2 ) and
Theorem 6.
17
Ch. I. MULTIPLICITY OF ROOTS AND INTERSECTION POINTS
Fl(2, Y) = 0, Fz ( x , Y) = 0
with a common point O ( 0 , 0). F, and F 2 a r e now a s s u m e d to be functions of
c l a s s 2 in C.
T h e o r e m 7. A common point 0 (0,0 ) of the two curves F1 (5,y) .= 0
and F 2 ( x , y) = 0 i s a double intersection point if and only if the followtng
conditions are satisfied:
(a)
I
F i x (0,0) Pi, (0,0)
"= Fix(0,0) F;, (0,0)
1 = o;
(b) at least one of the elements in the determinant A. i s other than zero;
(c) the number x = 0 i s a double root of the function Fz (2,cp ( x ) ) , where
y = cp ( x ) i s the solution of the equation F , (x,y) = 0 fmy in some sufficiently
small rectangle I x I g a , I y (this solution exists and is unique in virtue
of condition (b) and the themem of implicit functions; also cp (0) = 0).
If F ; , (0, 0 ) = 0, but s o m e other element of A,, does not vanish, condition
( c ) should be appropriately reworded.
P r o o f . 1) Necessity. Condition (a), A. = 0, is c l e a r l y n e c e s s a r y by
Theorem 6. We will now show that condition ( b ) is n e c e s s a r y . Suppose
that t h i s condition is not satisfied, i.e.,
5438 18
cr'. ;,:rLr:PL[c[rY C ~ .FI COLI:.:OK T TW
P C ~ OF CORVES
and
0
that the polynomials and Fz are - c l o s e t o r a n k 2 to the polynomials Pl
and P, and t h e r e f o r e 6 - c l o s e t o r a n k 2 to the functions FI (I, y) and F Z (I. y).
I f , m o r e o v e r , I z1 I < E , [ yl I < E , the c u r v e s Bl (I. y) = 0 and P, (I, y) = 0 have
at l e a s t 3 common points i n c', ( 0 ) : t h e s e a r e 0 (0, 0), MI (I,, 0), and N1 ( ( 1 . y,).
This c l e a r l y p r o v e s that the common point 0 af c u r v e s (C,) and (C,) i s of
multiplicity higher than 2. &.e have thus established that condition ( b ) is
also necessary.
Let u s now proceed with condition (c). Let y = q (I) b e the unique solution
of the equation
Fl(3, Y) = 0
19
(3.1. MULTIPLICITY OF ROOTS AND INTERSECTION POINTS
Let
Y"(x)=O,
20
$2. h'L1LTIPLIC17-t' OF A CO?.JhJOh POIhT OF T W O CCRVES
such that if E , > 0 is sufficiently s m a l l , -MI and -VI2 lie in U e(0). T h i s means,
however, that 0 (0, 0) is not a double intersection point of the c u r v e s (C,)and
(C?). The necessity of condition (c) is thus established.
Note that if F , and F? are polynomials, they can be used a s PI and P?.
The polynomial P2 in t h i s case is of the s a m e d e g r e e a s the polynomial F : .
2 ) Sufficiency. Let conditions (a), (b), and ( c ) of T h e o r e m 7 be
satisfied. Since Fi,(O. O ) # o , by Theorem 3 f o r any 6,>0 we c a n find b o > O
such that i f the functions Fl(r,y) and P,(s,y) are 6,-close t o r a n k 2 to the
function F1 and Fz in c, the following holds true;
1) the equation Fl (3, y) = O h a s a unique solution y=<(z) in the rectangle
Izl,<a, Iyl-<p, and @(z)is&-close to rank 2 t o c p ( t ) f o r l z l < a ;
2 ) the function 6(z)=Fz(z,<(z)) is 6 - c l o s e t o r a n k 2 to the function
O ( z ) = F ? ( r ,~ ( 3 )f)o r Izl<o:.
In virtue of condition (c), x = O is a double root of the function 0 ( 1 ) .
Therefore, t h e r e e x i s t s E , > 0 such that f o r sufficiently s m a l l 6, the equation
F,=O and F 2 = 0
and
21
22
C h a p t e r II
DYNA.ZIIC SYSTEiZlS C L O S E TO A GIS'EN SYSTEJI
AND PROPERTIES OF THEIR PHASE PORTRAITS
I NT RGDU C T ION
1. T h e o r e m s of c l o s e n e s s of solutions
23
Ch.11. CLOSE DYNAMIC S Y S T E M S
and
O ( G Y ) - - Q ( G Y ) = ~ ( ~v).
P(,Y)-~(,~Y)=P(I,Y), ,
The functions p (2,y) and q (z,y) a r e the i n c r e m e n t s of the right-hand
s i d e s of s y s t e m (A). If t h e s e functions a r e 8-close to r3nk r to zero, w e
w i l l c a l l them 6 - i n c r e m e n t s of r a n k T . System (A) considered in
conjunction with (A) is called m o d i f i e d ( r e l a t i v e to s y s t e m (A)), and is
s o m e t i m e s written in the f o r m
I n w h a t follows, i f s y s t e m (A) i s 6 - c l o s e - t o r a n k 1 t o s y s t e m
(A), w e s h a l l s i m p l y s a y t h a t s y s t e m (A) i s 6 - c l o s e t o
s y s t e m (A), omitting the qualification "to r a n k 1."
Consider two vector fields defined by s y s t e m (A) and a 8-close s y s t e m
(A). At each point M (I,y) of G two v e c t o r s a r e defined, v ( P , Q) and @, 0).
Let v # 0, # 0, and let f3 be the angle between v and ( s e e QT, Appendix,
95.1). It is readily s e e n that this angle is infinitesimal f o r sufficiently
s m a l l 6 . Indeed,
24
43. REG( L A R TRAE;SFORXI.-\TIOS OF CLOSE SYSTElfS
of s y s t e m (a)
corresponding to v a r i o u s points MO (xo,yo) of region F .
Suppose that e a c h solution ( 1 ) is certainly defined in a closed interval
25
26
91.. REGLL.4R TR.LNSFOfihlATION OF CLOSE SYSTELIS
u = x, u=y. (4)
if the functions q (I, y) and $ ( x , y) in this region are & - c l o s eto rank r to the
functions 3: and y. respectively.
Suppose that transformation ( 3 ) is considered in a n op?n domain G, and
GI is a closed bounded region, 6 , c G. Let
x=f(u, r), y = g ( u , c) (5 1
x =u, y = L.
If the plane ( u , L.) coincides with the plane (z, y) and the a x e s x and y coin-
cide with the a x e s u and c , respectively, i.e., if the point .\I* (u,c) is in fact
a point in the plane (+, y) with the coordinates u , u (relative to the s y s t e m of
coordinates defined in t nat plane), then, transformation ( 3 ) being 6-close
to the identity transformation, we immediately conclude that a:
is 6,-close
to z,, where 61 = v/z6.
Consider a dynamic system of class k
27
I defined i n domain G of plane (2, y).
Ln.11. CLOSE DYNAMIC SYSTEMS
We apply to t h i s s y s t e m a r e g u l a r
transformation ( 3 ) of c l a s s k f 1:
(A*), l i k e (A), is c l e a r l y a s y s t e m of c l a s s k.
Treating u , u as coordinates in the plane (x, y) and r e v e r t i n g to previous
notation, we write s y s t e m (A*) in the f o r m
I Let
dx
-
dt = P* (5, y), -$-= Q* (x, g).
F, c G be a closed bounded region, and GT i t s image under (3).
(A* )
-=
du
dt P* (4 4, x
dv = P(u, 4 (A* )
and
du
-=
d* p* (u, VI, dv =
dt P (u, v) (X*1
which a r e both s y s t e m s of c l a s s k defined in G* (G*is the image of G under
(3)).
L e m m a 2. F m any e > 0 there exists 6 > 0 such that if system (A) is
8-close to rank k to system ( A ) i n G, then the system(A*)i s e-close to
rank k to system (A*)in G*.
28
$3. REGL'L.AR TRA?iSFORhl.4TION OF CLOSE SYSTEMS
The sine of the angle-@ betureen the directions of the field of s y s t e m ( A ) and
the field of s y s t e m (A) is e x p r e s s e d by
In o u r p a r t i c u l a r case ( f E l), the angle between the fields of (A) and (A)
is constant everywhere in the region,
'The angle between two ordered vectors is defined as the angle not exceeding 180' through which the first
vector should be rotated so as to coincide with the second vector.
29
Ch.11. CLOSE D Y N A M K SYSTEMS
P - p f Q = 0, pfP + Q = 0. (11)
-;fI=i+pf.
does not vanish f o r any x , y, equations (11) can be satisfied if and only if
p (5,Y) = Q (5,v) = 0.
i.e., if and only if the point x , y is a s t a t e of equilibrium of s y s t e m (A).
This completes the proof.
* With increments of this form, the field vectors of system (A) are not only turned through a constant angle
but also stretched in a ratio of J/v.
are concerned only with directions, however.
We
30
$4. LNTERSECTIOh {IF PATHS WITH ARCS AivD CYCLES \VITtiOCT CONT.ACT
( H , A)&((r7, 1).
H and should be horr.omorphic and E -close to each o t h e r . N o r e o v e r , i t
i s n e c e s s a r y that the partitions of t h e s e regions by the paths of the c o r r e -
sponding s y s t e m s have the s a m e topological s t r u c t u r e (see QT, 15,
Definition V). T h e s e n e c e s s a r y conditions, however, a r e not sufficient
in general, since even if they a r e satisfied, t h e r e may prove to be no
topological mapping of H onto a
which c o n s e r v e s paths and is a t the s a m e
t i m e a n -translation.
Now suppose that the arc 1 , which is a n a r c withoat contact f o r the paths
of s y s t e m ( A ) , is defined by the p a r a m e t r i c equations
z=i(s), Y==g(S)*
* The term e-translation is generally understood in a wider iense. Indeed. 8-translation is defined as a
continuou.? mapping (not n e e isarity topological) which translates e a c h point of the set by less than e.
However, we will have opportunity to use this concept only in relation t o topological mapping;, and
therefore in what folIows e-translation is understood in the restricted iense of Definition 8 .
** A mapping which transforms paths into paths is given in QT (15. Definition V). This is a topological
mappinz. such that any two points of a path of system (A) are mapped into points of o n e path of system (x),
and any t w o points of a path of system (A) are mapped by the reverse mapping into two points of o n e path
of system (A). In QT this m t p p i n g i s c a l l e d an i d e n t i f y i n g m a p p i n g . We wilI refer to it as a
m a p p i n g w h i c h m a p s p a t h s i n t o p a t h s or more briefly a p a t h - c o n s e r v i n g m a p p i n g .
31
Let
Now suppose that a t any point M o(zo, YO) of the a r c 1 (to= f (s), go = g (s). a d s < b )
solution (1) is defined for a l l t , to<f,<T (s), * where T (s) is a continuous
function (in p a r t i c u l a r , it may b e a constant), and that the corresponding
a r c of the path is completely contained in G* and h a s no common points with
the a r c 1 , except M o . Evidently, under t h e s e conditions, the functions
CD ( f , s), 'Y ( f , s) a r e a p r i o r i defined everywhere in the closed region
@;v, s ) = d ( t - - t o , f(49 g ( s ) ) ,
( t , s) = ,cp;
Q,:
%(4
- t o , f (4,g (s)) f' (4+ 'pio( t - to* f (4.8 (4) d (s),
S)=4Go(1--o,
(t
'Yi( t , s) = 9; (t -tor f (4, g (s)),
f(4,g ( S ) ) f ' ( S ) + $ P ; o ( ~ - - f of , (4,g ( s ) ) g ' ( s ) .
F u r t h e r , by QT, 5 3 . 5 . Lemma 8, equations ( 3 )
t (7)
x = Q, ( t , s), I/ = Y ( t , s)
* Or for all t , t o > t > 7 (z). This case is analyzed precisely in the same way.
32
44. [NTERSECTION OF PATHS WITH ARCS AND CYCLES WITHOL'T CONTACT
gE
54
FiCCrRE 2. FIGL'RE 3
L e m m a 2. For any e > 0, there exists 6 2 0 such that if the system (A)
is 6-clo:e t o ( A )in G*, the functions 6 (f, s) and Y ( t , s) cmresponding to
system (A) are defined in region (6), hace continuous f i r s t - order partial
derittatices in this region, and are &-closethere to the functions Q, ( t , s) and
Y ( t ,s).
The proof of t h i s l e m m a follows directly f r o m Theorem 9 ( 3 ) and f r o m
Appendix, subsection 1, T h e o r e m 3.
L e m m a 3. (a) There exist 6 > 0 and h > 0 such that the system is
6 -close in b to systew(A!, the mapping
x = 6 (t. s), y = F ( t , s) (4
is a regular mapping of the rectangle
a<s,<b, It--t,l,<lr (8 )
in the plane ( t , s) onto the closed region K" in the plane ( x , y), and R i s entirely
contained in @.
(b) Let K be a closed region which is the image of rectangle ( 8 ) under
the transformation
33
Ch.11. CLOSE DYNAMIC SYSTEMS
under (4) into the s a m e point of the plane (z,y). i.e., such that
34
Xpplying T a y l o r ' s expansion to these equalities, w e see that
Gt ( t l , SI) ( t ' - t " ) + 8):( t l , SI) (s'-s*) =o,
Ti(!?. SZ) ( 1 - t " ) + R ( t 2 * s*)(s'-sJ')=O. (15)
whsre t, and t2 a r e numbers lying between t' and t', and si and s, are
n u m b e r s lying between s'and s". We will now show that I s ' - s" I S G . Indeed,
i f I s' - s" I <,.T, w e have I sl - .s2 I < u. F u r t h e r m o r e , I f l - t 2 I < I t - t' I < q
and I tt - to I < ko.l t 2 - t3 I < ho by (13). Hence, inequalities (11) are s a t i s -
fied, and by ( 1 2 )
;Di ( t L ,Si)
- (f:.s;),
=ac(ti, s:), vi ( t i , s;) = Y, (16)
(16), w e get
or, f r o m (5),
35
01.11. CLOSE DYNAMIC SYSTEMS I
Let now M O( X O , YO) be an i n t e r i o r point of the a r c 1 , corresponding to the
value SO of the p a r a m e t e r s (a < so(b).
L e m m a 4 . For any e > 0 , hO> 0, there exist q > 0 , 8 > 0 which satisfj!
the following condition: system (A) i s 8 -close to_systeim ( A )in *, M is
some point in U, ( M o ) , and L" i s the path of system ( A )which at t = to passes
through the point M , then f o r some t * , I t* - to I < ho, the path intersects
the arc 1 at the point M 4 , such that the arc MM* of the path f; is entirely
contained in U. (M,) (Figure 4 ) .
FIGURE 4 FIGURE 5
36
54. INTERSECROX OF PATHS W I T H ARCS A N D CYCLES WITHOCT CONTACT
L e m i n a 5 . F m any e>O, h>O, there exist q > O and d > O such that if
systein ($1 is a - close to system (A) in E*, .goE U,, (.wd, and is the path of
systein (A)zuhichat t = t o passes through the point;M,, then at some t=G the
path L crosses the a r c I at the point M so that (a) I T - z I c h ; (b) z % U c ( ~ v f ) ;
(d the a r c ROL% of the path Z is Contained entirely in G+; (d) i j I.r'-tol<
< I r - t o ( , then i @ ( t ) c U c ( M ( t )fm) all t c [ ? , to]; if, on the other hand, l>-tol,
>17--t01, then . @ ( t ) U , ( M ( t ) for
) all t c [ z , to]and the arc of the path L coyre-
sponding to t E ,I; T ~ i ]s entirely contained in U. ( M (z)) * (Figure 6 ) .
L e m m a 5 is a n obvious c o r o l l a r y f r o m Theorem 8 ( 8 3 ) and Lemma 4.
R e m a r k . Lemma 5 c a n be generalized like the preceding l e m m a {see
r e m a r k t o Lemma 4). Indeed, consider a compact s e t F i n G* such that
each path which a t t = to p a s s e s through the point Mo (q, yo) of t h i s s e t i n t e r -
s e c t s a t s o m e t = 7 ( 3 0 , y,) the a r c without contact 1 a t the point M (zo,yo), always
remaining inside G until the intersection point is reached; then for given
* Here, as i n the following. M ( t ) IS the point of the path of the relevant system which corresponds to the
time t for the particular motion chosen along the path.
37
(3.11. CLOSE DYNAMIC SYSTEMS
e > 0 and h > 0, the n u m b e r s q > 0 and 8 > 0 entering Lemma 5 can be chosen
independently of the point M o E F , and w i l l thus satisfy the lemma i r r e s p e c -
tive of the p a r t i c u l a r point Mo E F that is taken. In what follows, the compact
s e t F is generally identified with s o m e a r c without contact 1 which has no
common points with the a r c 1 .
In Lemma 3 the functions Q, ( t , s),Y ( t , s), and a l s o (t, s) and q ( t ,s), were
considered only f o r t such that t - to I<ho, where ho > 0 is some sufficiently
s m a l l number. Let u s now again consider the c a s e when the functions
Q ( t , s) and Y ( t , s) a r e determined f o r a l l t and s in the closed region
35
SI
x=fl(S), Y=i?t(S)
39
I Ch.11. CLOSE DYNAMIC-SYGTEMS
FIGURE 9
I By assumption, (P
r = c o ( t , s), y = Y (f,8 ) .
inequalities
and f o r all t h e s e t and s the points ((P ( t . s), Y ( t . s)) belong t o G*. By QT, 53.4,
(18)
I u,<s,<~, to<t,<~(~)+ho
and for a l l t h e s e values of the p a r a m e t e r s the points ((P(f,s),Y ( t , s)) lie i n G*.
(19)
The points ((P ( t , s), Y ( t , s)) f o r which s i Q s 4 s 2 , T (s) < t< T (s) + ho evidently lie
outside the e l e m e n t a r y quadrangle r, Le., t h e s e points and the i n t e r i o r
points of l 2 c l o s e to I lie on the two s i d e s of the a r c La.
By L e m m a s 1,2,5 and r e m a r k to L e m m a 5, we see that f o r any t > O and
h>O, h < h o , t h e r e e x i s t 6 > 0 and q > O such that l i and la are a r c s without
contact f o r any s y s t e m (A) which is a-close to s y s t e m (A) in c?*, and
moreover:
1) the functions & i t , s), ( t , s) a r e defined f o r all t and I ( a < s g b , to<
. - < t < ~ ( ~ ) + and
h ~ ) f o r t h e s e values of the p a r a m e t e r s they are e-close to the
fuqctions (P and Y, respectively, the points ( g ( t ,s). q ( t , 8 ) ) lying in G*;
40
44. ~ T E R S E C T ~ OI N~ FPATHS w t r t i ARCS A N D CYCLES w t r m . x r CONTACT
41
Ch. 11. CLOSE DYNAMIC SYSTEMS
x=a,t, s)='p(t--to, f ( 4 ,g ( s ) ) ,
?/='Y(t. S ) = S ( t - - t o , f (SA g ( s ) ) .
Similarly the point P"(z,
3 of the elementary quadrangle can be made to
correspond to the curvilinear coordinates 7, G, ;i<G<& to<;<<;G), and
c I - -
r=cD(t,s),
- - c
v = ' P ( t , s).
"/---I:
'I
FIGURE 11
S=S, t=to+k('C(S)-fo).
42
coordinates i, by the analogous r e l a t i o n s
-4st g o e s f r o m to to G G ) , X a l s o v a r i e s f r o m o to 1.
Let u s nou find the inlapping T of t h e q u a d r a n g l e r , a s s u m m g t h a t e a c h
point P (k, s) of t h e quadrangle is mapped onto a new point T ( P ) = p ( c where 6,
-s.=u)(s). -
h-i..
(r (a(s))--to)t a (s)).
a (W,)
-
= MI, a (.VI) =.Yi,
-
and a mapping $ of the section Jf2S2 of the path L2 onto the s e c t i o n .c2.v2
of
the path z2,
such that
-
p (.)I?) = -112, $ (.VVc)
-
=N 2
(Figure 9).
L e t n pi a 9. F m at!g e > 0, there exist 6 > 0 arid q > 0 such that If
systetn (A) is 6 -close to system (A) and the mappings 'p, a, a d $ are
q - translatioris (Definition 8, 0 4 . 4 , there exists a path - conserving topo-
logical wrapping T of'the eleiiientary quadrangle r anto lr"(iohich also
c o n s e w e s the directiov! o j rktotion ) that coincides on the sections J 1 , X 2 ,.$I,.v,,
arid M2SL. of the bounda,ry of the eletnentary quadrangle r with the wiappings
'p. c*, and $, respectirely, and i s an &-translation.
43
Ch.11. CLOSE DYNAMIC SYSTEMS
Y = q ( ( t o + ~ a ( h ) ( ~ - P ) + B ( ~ ) P I ; 6 i (1-q
-
( C L ) ) + ~ + ( P ) ) , (~-vw)+&w)-
st
The mapping T defined in t h i s way is r e a d i l y s e e n to be a path-conserving
topological mapping of the elementary quadrangle I? onto ?? which coincides
with the mappings q , a,B on the corresponding s e c t i o n s of the boundary. If
now 6 and q a r e sufficiently s m a l l , and Y can b e made a s %lose 5 s is
a
needed to Q, and Y, a ( I ) and $ ( I ) to 1,; and to p and I , and sl and 8 2 to s,and
s2, respectively. But then f o r sufficiently s m a l l 6 and q the mapping T is
an e-translation. Q. E. D.
Retaining the previous notation, let u s consider the e l e m e n t a r y quad-
r a n g l e I? formed by the a r c s of the paths of s y s t e m (A), Here, with
s y s t e m (A), we will only consider modified s y s t e m s (A) of one p a r t i c u l a r
f o r m , namely s y s t e m s
d"=P
dt
- (S, Y), 2 = B (z,Y). (A1
such that a t any point of 61 which is not a s t a t e of equilibrium of s y s t e m (A)
we have
P"QQP#O. (21)
44
$4. IkTERSECTIW OF P.4THS WITfi .IRCS A N D CYCLES Lv'ITHOL-T COST.4CT
x = / I (s), Y =RI(S)
z = f 2 ( Z ) , y=gz(S), Z,<546.
both have the s a m e sign. Suppose that D l > 0 and D z> 0 (this c o r r e s p o n d s
to the case schematica.lly shown in Figure 1 2 ) .
FIGL'RE 12
45
Ch.11. CLOSE DYNAMIC SYSTEMS
where
si ,<S Q So. to Q t 45 (s)
then any path L" of this system which at t = t o meets the section MoS of the
ayc 1, at the point A7 will cross the sectionNJf,of the arc l2 at the point
at t = ; , so that the section I@@of Z has no common points with the arcs 1,
and I , , except its two end points, and is completely contained in the
elementary quadrangle r2. A similar proposition holds true if the point s
lies on the section M O M l of the arc I, and Pd-QF<O. In this case, the
section f i f i of E i s entirely contained in the quadrangle P,.
P r 00:. By the r e m a r k to Lemma 7, t h e r e e x i s t s 6 > 0 such that i f
s y s t e m ( A )is 6-close to s y s t e m (A) and i t s path 2; p a s s e s through s o m e
point 2 of the a r c MQS at t = t o , then at t the path =<
m e e t s the a r c l 2 at
s o m e point 8 s o that the section M f i of Z h a s no common points with the
a r c s 1, and 1 2 , except i t s end points, and is entirely contained in the
s t a r t i n g quadrangle r. W e will now show that if inequality (23) is addition-
ally satisfied, the section M f i of is entirely contained in rz.
Let T denote the p a r a m e t e r ( t i m e ) along the path (so as to distinguish
it f r o m the p a r a m e t e r t of the paths of s y s t e m ( A ) ) . The corresponding
motion along the path L" is described by the equations
x=aI((t,s), y=Y((t,s).
( D ( t ,s ) = G ( T ) , Y(t, s ) = $ ( T )
46
I
-
for any T f r o m the inte.-val [ t o , T G ) ]have a unique solution for f and s in the
region ( 2 5 ) . L V e w r i t e this solution in the form
t-t(T), s=s(T).
ds
Let u s calculate z. Differentiation of ( 2 6 ) with r e s p e c t to T g i v e s
The determinant of t h i s s y s t e m is
where
But
Therefore
47
Ch.11. CLOSE DYNAMIC SYSTEMS
48
In conclusion of this chapter w e will prove another lemma which i s
concerned with regions delimited by two c y c l e s without contact.
Let C, and C2 be two s i m p l e cl_osed c u r v e s , which a r e c y c l e s without
contact f o r the paths of s y s t e m ( A ) ; one of t h e s e c u r v e s , Cp say, lies
inside the other c u r v e . Suppose that e a c h path L of s y s t e m ( A ) passing a t
t = t,, through the point 111 of the cycle C, i n t e r s e c t s f o r s o m e T = T (W) > t o
the cycle CSa t the point .V, s o that the section J1.V of the path L h a s no
common points with the c y c l e s C1 and C2, other than i t s end-points
( F i g u r e 14). Let W be a closed annular region between the c y c l e s Cl and
C?, s o that 11. c C*.
L e v i wi a 12. For a,ay E > U there exists 6 > 0 such that if SyStepTi ( K )is
b-close to system ( A ) i n C*, then
(a) cycles C, and L'? are cycles without contact for the trajectories of
sgstevi (A);
(b) the partition of V by paths of system (A) i s E -identical to the
partitian 01this region $ 5 paths
~ of systerii(Al.
P r o o f . Draw any two paths which i n t e r s e c t the cycle without contact
C',.They c l e a r l y partition into two e l e m e n t a r y quadrangles. Applying
Lemma 8 to each of t h e s e quadrangles, w e readily verify Lemma 1 2 .
49
C h a p t e r III
5438 50
$5. T H E SPACE OF DYNAMIC SYSTElIS
and also the maxima of the absolute values of the differences between
the corresponding derivatives of these functions to o r d e r r , inclusive, i.e.,
and
51
Ch.111. T H E SPACE OF DYNAMIC SYSTFMS AND STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTEMS
RP? 2 RC 2 RZ). (5 1
2. The s p a c e of dynamic s y s t e m s on a s p h e r e
52
$5. THE SPACE OF DYNAh!IC SYSTEhIS
53
Ch.111. THE SPACE OF DYNAMIC SYSTEMS AND STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTEMS
closed covering
-z*= {GF, e,.. ., Gif..)
and equations analogous to ( 6 ) ( s e e QT, 52.2).
To define a m e t r i c in the s e t of dynamic s y s t e m s on a s p h e r e and thus
convert this s e t into a m e t r i c space, we will d e s c r i b e a l l the dynamic
s y s t e m s using one fixed s y s t e m K of local coordinates on a s p h e r e .
Suppose t h i s s y s t e m is defined by a closed covering = . . ., 8,) and a {c,,
s e t of equations ( 6 ) . Consider two dynamic s y s t e m s (A) and (A) of c l a s s k
(or of the analytical c l a s s ) . Let s y s t e m (A) be described by the equations
au(= du
dt ut ( w r 01). +=vi (ut. ut) (A,)
(A,)
Choose a natural number r > l , such that r < k , i f k is the c l a s s of the
s y s t e m (for analytical s y s t e m s , any r can be chosen). Consider the
numbers
and a l s o the n u m b e r s
$6.D E F I N I T I O N OF A S T R U C T U R A L L Y STABLE
DYNAhIIC SYSTE3.I
1. Dynamic s y s t e m s on a plane
Let
55
Ch.111. THE SPACE OF DYNAMIC SYSTEMS AND STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTFMS
E x a m p 1e 3 . Consider the s y s t e m
xe + y* 100.
ts + y* Q 16. (3)
2 + g 25. (4)
.-, - " , . _
l i s h e s the s t r u c t u r a l instability of s y s t e m ( 2 )
in region (3).
Before proceeding any f u r t h e r with our
analysis, we would like to offer s o m e back-
FIGURE 15 ground information on s t r u c t u r a l l y stable
s y s t e m s . Structurally stable s y s t e m s w e r e
f i r s t considered i n 1937 by A. A. Andronov and
L. S. Pontryagin 141, who originally called them s y s t B m e s g r o s s i e r
or c o a r s e s y s t e m s .
They considered, however, dynamic s y s t e m s
in a particular region W lying inside a cycle without contact. The definition
56
$6. 5fRCiCTURALLY ST.ABLE DYh.4.L.K SYS I ELIS
(if-, d ) E (W,
A)
defined in 6,which maps this region into s o m e region @ i n the plane (u,u).
2. Structurally stable s y s t e m s on a s p h e r e
Also see the remark in the previous subsection concerning the definition of structural stability of a system
inside a cycle wirhout contacr.
When speaking of a n &-translation, w e naturally a s s u m e that s o m e
m e t r i c is defined on the s p h e r e , e i t h e r internal or induced by the enclosing
euclidean space.
To define a s t r u c t u r a l l y stable s y s t e m , w e introduce s o m e s y s t e m of
local coordinates on the s p h e r e and m e a s u r e the distances between two
dynamic s y s t e m s r e l a t i v e to this coordinate s y s t e m ( s e e 15.2).
D e f i n i t i o n 12. A dynamic system ( D ) on a sphere S is said to be
structzcrally stable if f o r any e > 0 there exists 6 > 0 such that, for any
system ( 6 ) ,6 -close to system ( D ) , we hace
(S, D ) (S, 5)
Otherwise s y s t e m (D) is said to be s t r u c t u r a l l y u n s t a b l e .
If a dynamic s y s t e m (D) on a s p h e r e is s t r u c t u r a l l y unstable, t h e r e
e x i s t s eo >,0 with the fo:llowing property: f o r any 6 > 0 t h e r e e x i s t s a
s y s t e m (D) 6-close to (D), such that partitions of the s p h e r e ( S )by the
paths of (D) and ( 6 )are n o t eo-identical.
Definition 1 2 m a k e s u s e of a particular s y s t e m of local coordinates K on
the s p h e r e . W e now have to establish that the concept of a s t r u c t u r a l l y
stable s y s t e m is in fact independent of the choice of the local s y s t e m of
coordinates on the s p h e r e , or in other words, we have to show that i f
s y s t e m (D) is s t r u c t u r a l l y stable when the m e t r i c (in the s p a c e of dynamic
s y s t e m s ) is defined in t e r m s of s o m e s y s t e m of local coordinates K , it is
a l s o s t r u c t u r a l l y stable in the m e t r i c defined using any other s y s t e m of
local coordinates K *. This proposition c l e a r l y follows f r o m a previous
proposition formulated a t the v e r y eqd of 1 5 (in the r e m a r k to 55.2).
Definition 1 2 is thus meaningful, and s t r u c t u r a l l y stable s y s t e m s on a
s p h e r e c a n be analyzed in a m e t r i c introduced using a n a r b i t r a r y fixed
s y s t e m of local coordinates.
Let (A) be a dynamic: s y s t e m on a s p h e r e and W s o m e subregion of the
s p h e r e whose c l o s u r e F: d o e s not coincide with the e n t i r e s p h e r e . We
choose a s y s t e m K of local coordinates so that a t l e a s t one of the compo-
nents of the closed covering corresponding to this s y s t e m , Gl say,
entirely contains ff', i.e., rf'c GI. F r o m the definition of the s y s t e m of
local coordinates and or' a dynamic s y s t e m on a s p h e r e ( s e e 15.2) w e see
that c o r r e s p o n d s to s o m e region Fl on the plane ( u l , cI). Let W -c o r r e -
spond to s o m e W* on the plane, iT* c Hi. System (A) on the s p h e r e thus
c o r r e s p o n d s to s o m e dynamic s y s t e m (Al) in gl.
L e m m a 3 . If ( A ) I S a structurally stable system on a sphere, the
dynainic system ( A l ) is shctzcrally stable in w*.
This lemma follows directly f r o m the definitions of s t r u c t u r a l stability
(Definitions 10 and 1 2 ) and the uniform continuity of the mapping of G , onto
Hi.
In s i m p l e r language, Lemma 3 c a n be formulated a s follows: if
s y s t e m ( D ) is s t r u c t u r a l l y stable on a s p h e r e , i t is s t r u c t u r a l l y stable in
any subregion of the s p h e r e .
59
Ch.111. THE SPACE OF DYNAMIC SYSTEMS AND STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTEMS
60
56. SLRLCTLRALLY STABLE DYhALIIC SYSTmIS
Let f u r t h e r r, c= r2 ::h
~ (A) is a dynamic s y s t e m of c l a s s k, 111 is the
point corresponding to (A) in E: (or i n RP; w e r e c a l l that both t h e s e
s p a c e s a r e made up of the s a m e points, but the corresponding m e t r i c s a r e
different, see 15.1). Then, i f s y s t e m (A) i s s t r u c t u r a l l y s t a b l e
i n I i r e l a t i v e t o Ryl), i t i s a l s o s t r u c t u r a l l y s t a b l e i n W
r e 1 a t i v e t o E;?. T h i s follows directly f r o m Definition 13 and f r o m the
relation
1.6 (.If 1 RF) c Lb ( L\f1 R:)
( s e e $5.1).
I s the r e v e r s e a l s o t r u e ? In other words, c a n we maintain that i f
s y s t e m (A) is s t r u c t u r d l y stable in If- relative t o R;* i t is a l s o s t r u c t u r a l l y
-=
stable r e l a t i v e to Rh: ( r g k , k2)or, alternatively, if s y s t e m (A) is s t r u c -
turally stable in ti relative to Rh,i t i s a l s o s t r u c t u r a l l y s t a b l e r e l a t i v e to
,;Ill ( r , < r? .<k) ? T h e s e propositions c l e a r l y do not follow directly f r o m the
definition of relative s t r u c t u r a l stability. Moreover, i f s y s t e m (A) belongs
to two s p a c e s R a n d R*, s u c h that R* c R, then in g e n e r a l s y s t e m (A) may
prove s t r u c t u r a l l y s t a b l e in W relative to the enclosed s p a c e R*, w h e r e a s i t
i s s t r u c t u r a l l y unstable r e l a t i v e to the enclosing s p a c e R .
However, i f a t the c o s t of generality we concentrate on the s p a c e s RY
and Ra, which are of the main i n t e r e s t in the a n a l y s i s of dynamic s y s t e m s ,
the situation is considerably simplified. It c a n be shown that i f s y s t e m (A)
belongs to one of these s p a c e s , the n e c e s s a r y and sufficient conditions f o r
i t s s t r u c t u r a l stability (in W )relative to these s p a c e s are a t the s a m e time
the n e c e s s a r y and sufficient conditions of i t s s i m p l e s t r u c t u r a l stability
(i.e.> s t r u c t u r a l stability r e l a t i v e to R , ) . T h i s will be established in the
derivation of the n e c e s s a r y and sufficient conditions of s t r u c t u r a l stability
(518.4, R e m a r k d); additional proof (in connection with RF or R!:) is
naturally r e q u i r e d only for the n e c e s s a r y conditions of s t r u c t u r a l stability,
Thus, if s y s t e m (A) belongs t o RF or Rr and is s t r u c t u r a l l y s t a b l e in IF
relative to the corresponding space, i t is simply s t r u c t u r a l l y stable.
Therefore, w e do not have to consider s t r u c t u r a l stability r e l a t i v e to these
s p a c e s and i n what follows w e can concentrate on s t r u c t u r a l stability in the
s e n s e of Definition 10.
The situation is c l e a r l y the s a m e for dynamic s y s t e m s on a s p h e r e .
The above a r g u m e n t s pertaining to dynamic s y s t e m s are analogous to the
v a r i o u s a r g u m e n t s offered in 51.4 in connection with r o o t s of functions and
a t the end of $2 in the a n a l y s i s of intersection points of two c u r v e s . T h i s
analogy between dynamic s y s t e m s , on the one hand, and functions or p a i r s
of c u r v e s , on the o t h e r , unfortunately b r e a k s down a t one significant point.
Let u s d i s c u s s t h i s a s p e c t in s o m e detail.
W e will consider the analogy between dynamic s y s t e m s i n a plane region
G and p a i r s of c u r v e s F 1(z, y ) = O , F? (z, y) =O. At the end of S2 we considered
the multiplicity of the i i t e r s e c t i o n point of two c u r v e s r e l a t i v e to a given
c l a s s Bl of functions. %R w a s identified in p a r t i c u l a r with the class a,,of
all polynomials in two \,ariables not higher than of d e g r e e n and the n e c e s s a r y
and sufficient condition of s t r u c t u r a l stability of the intersection point of two
c u r v e s relative to t h i s ,class was established t o coincide (A # 0) with the
condition of s t r u c t u r a l stability in the s e n s e of Definition 5 (S2.1).
61
ch.111. THE SPACE OF D Y N A M I C SYSTEMS A N D STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTEMS
requirements.
!7. S r R l . C r l ~ l U L L Y ST.-\RLE .%hU CLSI.4dLE PATHS
Let
-
be a dynamic s y s t e m defined in G , and l e t be a closed region, tV c G .
T h e o Y e ni 10. I f systeni ( A ) i s structrivallg stable in F, it has only
a finite nunrbev of equilibrirm states in SS;.
P r o o f . \Ve will f i r s t show that f o r any ( A ) and any 6 > 0, t h e r e e x i s t s
a dynamic s y s t e m (A) 3 - c l o s e t o ( A ) which h a s only a finite number of
equilibrium s t a t e s . C i o o s e s o m e S > 0. F r o m W e i e r s t r a s s s theorem
&
( 1.1, Theorem 1) t h e r e exist two polynomials P* (z, y). Q* (z, y). which are z-
c l o s e in 6 to the f u n c t i m s P (z, y),-Q (2,y).
If P* and Q* are irreducible, (A) c a n be chosen a s the s y s t e m
63
Ch.111. THE SPACE OF DYNAMIC SYSTEMS AND STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTEMS
6
Indeed, t h i s s y s t e m is Z-close, and hence a l s o 6-close, to s y s t e m (A).
Its equilibrium s t a t e s a r e determined f r o m the s e t of equations
P* ( x , y) = 0, Q* (I,Y) = 0,
and since the l a r g e s t common divisor (P*,Q*)= 1, t h e s e equations have only
a finite number of solutions according t o the Bkzout theorem (see /12/,
Chapter 111, 53.1).
Now suppose that P* and Q* a r e not i r r e d u c i b l e . They can be written in
the f o r m
(I,Y) = Pi (G Y) [ R(z, Y) + a
19
64
57. STfiC'CT[lRALLY ST;\BLE AhD C'hS T;\BLE PATHS
i s impossible). F r o m ( E f a, R +
p) = 1, ( P t , Q,)= 1 and condition 3 it
follows, using a well-known algebraic theorem, that ( p , 0)= 1. Then the
system
dr
x=P(z,
- dy
id, x=az,
v)
( H , A) 2 (p,.2), (2)
3. Multiplicity of an equilibrium s t a t e
Consider a dynamic s y s t e m
The m u l t i p l i c i t y o f t h e e q u i l i b r i u m s t a t e M o is defined a s
the multiplicity of the intersection point .%Io of the two c u r v e s ( 3 ) (see $2.1).
D e f i n i t i o n 15. An equilibrium state M o (xo,yo) of a dynamic system is
said to be of multiplicity r (OY r -tuple) if M u i s a common point of multipli-
city r of cumes ( 3 ) .
65
Ch.111. THE SPACE OF DYNAMIC SYSTEMS AND STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTEMS
An equilibrium s t a t e of multiplicity 1 is s a i d to be s i m p 1e .
An equilibrium s t a t e M o is s a i d to be of infinite multiplicity if M o is a n
intersection point of infinite multiplicity of c u r v e s ( 3 ) .
An equilibrium s t a t e M O is said to be of multiplicity higher than r if it
is of finite multiplicity r' > r or h a s infinite multiplicity.
Finally, an equilibrium s t a t e is s a i d to be multiple if i t s multiplicity is
> 1.
F r o m Definition 5 (2.1) and Definition 15 we s e e that if an equilibrium
s t a t e M O is of multiplicity r , then s y s t e m (A) is a s y s t e m of c l a s s k > r and
the follow_ingare satisfied: a ) t h e r e e x i s t E, > 0 and 60 > O such that any
s y s t e m (A) 6,-close to rank r to s y s t e m (A) h a s a t most r equilibrium s t a t e s
in Ueo(Mo); b ) for any e < eo and 6 > 0 t h e r e e x i s t s a s y s t e m (A) 6-close to
r a n k r to s y s t e m (A) which h a s a t l e a s t r equilibrium s t a t e s in U , ( M o ) .
The following theorem e s t a b l i s h e s the n e c e s s a r y condition of s t r u c t u r a l
stability of an isolated equilibrium s t a t e .
T h e o r e m 11. An isolated equilibrium state M o ( x 0 , yo) is structurally
stable only if it is simple (of multiplicity l ) , i.e., a necessary condition
of structural stability of an equilibrium state i s the inequality
FIGURE 16
66
57. 5 F R I ' C T I ' R 4 L L Y S T E L E .AND C;NSI'.ABLE PATtlS
' Indeed, take some point M W outside HI. Let f denote the e-translation which transforms CLo into 2,
and let I'be the boundary of the neighbarhood U E o ( M ) , Fthe boundary of 2 (f'=f(r)), andM=f(.M).
6y sssuniption p(M, %) <$. T h e sesment .MS contains at least one point s o f the boundary
-r. There-
fore p (Jf. 5)< %. Let s"=f (,S), where S ( r . Then p (S. 3)< +. This leads fo the inequality
p (S,M)Q p (AI, s ) + p (g,S) < 2, which is impossible since p (S,Fi')=?.
C h a p t e r IV
EQUILIBRIUM S T A T E S OF S T R U C T U R A L L Y S T A B L E
S Y S T E M S . S A D D L E - T 0-SADDLE S E P A R A T RIX
INTRODUCTION
Since 0 is a s i m p l e equilibrium,
or
i.?--aE.+l=O, (5)
where
or
where p + O .
69
Ch.IV. EQUILIBRIUM S T A T E S OF STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTEMS
case (9) a c o n f l u e n t n o d e .
111. h, and & a r e real, different, and of opposite signs. In t h i s c a s e ,
the canonic f o r m of the s y s t e m is a s in c a s e I, i.e., (7). but A i l z = A < 0.
The point 0 is then called a s a d d l e p o i n t .
IV. hi and hz a r e complex numbers, which a r e not pure imaginary. The
canonical f o r m of s y s t e m (1)is then
I
where h i , 2 = a f pi, a + O p>O. The equilibrium s t a t e 0 is then a f o c u s
(a s i m p l e f o c u s ) .
V . hi and & a r e pure imaginary numbers, Li=pi, & = - p i , f5=#=0. The
canonical f o r m of s y s t e m ( 1 ) is then
P +ya = rs (12)
of sufficiently s m a l l r a d i u s r a r e contact-free c y c l e s f o r the t r a j e c t o r i e s
of the s y s t e m . Let 0 be a s t a b 1 e n o d e ,* i.e., hl < 0, hz < 0. Then any
path with 0 as i t s limiting point goes to 0 f o r t -+ +
00. Let
-dd=
z
t ) . * f f q ( s , Y). $==.2Y,*(X, Y). (Aj
'F (J.Y) =*a", \I* Y) 4-Y g 2 (z, Y)t Ip (3, Y) = x i ! (f, Y) 5 Y/? (I,Y), (15)
where
i 1
gl (5,Y) = 1'fk (tr, CY) d t ,
0
g? ( 5 , Y\ = j
a
(FY ( t ~ t, ~d t), (16)
Let
For k we can take any positive number, satisfying the inequality k C 4 >.
CI
See QT, 57.1.
71
c;h.IV. EQUILIBRIUM STATES OF STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTEMS
Since
9 = 2ps ( t ) [It, cos2 e + & s i n g e+ cos) eg, + cos e sin e ( g 2 + f , ) + sins ef,j, (21)
x2+ys=rs, (23)
72
98. STRCCTVR4L STABILITY OF &ODE .WD SIhlPLE FOCL'S
written in the f o r m
--
d;;"dt ( I ) - 2 3 [(Ai cos25 + sin2 ir, + (atc o s ~e'+ (a2 as)cos tt s i n e +
1.2
# #
f Z;
- - 6 + (g, f f , ) cos 8sin tl+
sine e) C g ,
COS~
# - - -f 2 sin? m. (26)
- 1
We compare the values of thesc expressions in the same point (z, y), i.e., w e take p = p , 8=8. The
5
closeness of the Functions and & to f i andqi, respectively, follows from equations (16) and the analogous
relations for 'fi and T i . Here closeness is to be understood to rank 0.
* * Hence it follows, in particular, that the point 0 is a node or a focus of system (6). It c a c be shown with
much less effort, using the continuous dependence of the characteristic roots on the system coefficients,
that for sufficiently close systems (B), 0 is a node. This is not enough for our purposes, however. It is
clear from the proof that, among other things, system (8) has no h i t cycles in p.
73
Ch. IV. EQUILIBRIUM STATES OF STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTEMS
14
The proof will be c a r r i e d out f o r the c a s e when O i s a n ordinary node.
In the other cases (confluent and d i c r i t i c a l node, focus) the proof is exactly
the s a m e . System (A) is taken in canonical f o r m (7).
Let H be the region considered in Lemma 1, i.e., the i n t e r i o r of a
circle Co of sufficiently s m a l l r a d i u s ro centered a t 0 . Let GI be s o m e
region satisfying the condition H c Gt, gt c G ( F i g u r e 18; c
is the original
region used to define the c l o s e n e s s of s y s t e m s ) . c,
is a t a positive distance
f r o m the boundary of G. Let this distance be d .
FIC L'RE 18
2
( H , -4) = (H, B).
P (0,0,)
= m< Po. (28)
75
ch. IV. EQUILrBRIUM STATES OF STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTEMS
We have thus shown that for any e > 0 t h e r e e x i s t s 6 > 0 such that if
system (A) is & - c l o s e to (A) in 6, r e l a t i o n (32) applies. This i m p l i e s i n
i t s t u r n that s y s t e m (A) is s t r u c t u r a l l y stable i n H, i.e., 0 is a s t r u c t u r a l l y
stable s t a t e of equilibrium of s y s t e m (A).
76
?e. STRC'CTL'R4L ST.4BILITY OF SODE AKD SIhlPLE FOCL'S
Since E*<,; w e conclude that H* c H'. Hence, and by (33), i t follows that
K* contains no closed paths of s y s t e m (A). The boundary circle of H* is
a r l y a cycle without contact f o r s y s t e m (A).
c l e-
H* is thus enclosed by a cycle without contact of s y s t e m (A) and a l l
s y s t e m s sufficiently c l c s e to (A) have no closed paths in F*. The r e s t of
the proof proceeds along the s a m e lines a s th? proof of L e m m a 1, but the
paths of s y s t e m (A) and of the c l o s e s y s t e m (A) in g e n e r a l tend to different
points 0 and 6.
R e m a r k 2. A s i m p l e s t a t e of equilibrium M o (q, yo) of the s y s t e m
is a node or a focus i f
1. Reduction of t h e s y s t e m to canonical f o r m by a
n e a r l y identical t r a n s f o r m a t i o n
where e , and e2 are infinitesimal, and the functions and 5 together with
tlteir f i r s t derivatives vanish at the point 0 (0.0) and are arbitrarily close
to the cmresponding functions g, and 9.
PI- o o f . Let eo and B2 be two positive n u m b e r s with the following pro-
perty: f o r any s y s t e m (A) Bo-close in E to s y s t e m (A), t h e r e is p r e c i s e l y
one equilibrium s t a t e a (Eo, qo) in U,, (O),and this equilibrium s t a t e is a
saddle point. The existence of t h e s e eo and Bo follows f r o m Theorem 6 and
Definition 5 (S2.1), and a l s o f r o m the fact that s m a l l changes in s y s t e m (A)
leave the determ-inant A = liX2 negative.
Let s y s t e m (A) be 6 -cl_ose to s y s t e m (A), where 8 5 6,, and let (to, a qo) be
the equilibrium s t a t e of (A) lying in U, (0). System (A) c l e a r l y c a n be
written in the f o r m
78
F. 5-RLCTLRAL S T A B I L I T Y OF .A SADDLE POIST
we obtain the s y s t e m
is sufficiently c l o s e to the m a t r i x
W e s e e k S i n the f o r m
and
79
ch. IV. EQUILIBRIUM STATES OF STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTEMS
( h +~ e,) Y + ~ l r(11.
dx
= (kit- ei) X + 'pa (x, v), = r Y) (14)
80
5". SI'KI'CTl'RAL ST.4BILITY OF .4 SADDLE P O I N T
where f , , f ? , g,. g, a r e continuous functions which vanish a t the point 0 (0, 0).
LVithout loss of generality, we again take
A ff
Y Y
4 I 4
FIGURE 19
z=z(t), y=y(t).
where
I-/<k.
81
ch.IV. EQUILIRRIUM S T A T E S OF STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTEMS
(19)
and
z (to) i
m G T . (20)
Since the functions f l and gi a r e continuous and vanish a t the point 0 (0, 0),
r e l a t i o n s (161, (17), and (19) f o r sufficiently s m a l l s o l e a d to the equalities
FIGURE 20 I
5438 82
$,I. 5 LKL~CI'L'WL Sl'ABILITY OF .4 S.4DDLE POINT
* This is so because if system (x)is sufficiently close t o system (A), the functions 7, and 2~are arbitraril)
close to f i and g i , respectivel) (I= 1.21, as we see from equations (151, 95 and the corresponding
reiations for f i , 7,. gi.
83
Ch. IV. EQUILIBRIUM STATES OF STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTEMS
84
$3. STRK'CTL'RAL STABILITY OF A SADDLE POIKT
85
a.IV. EQUILIBRIUM STATES OF STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTEMS
I, IF \c A
I I
FIGURE 23 FIGURE 24
86
5'. STRL'CTCRAL STASILITY OF A SADDLE P O I N T
t:
FIGURE 2 5
87
ch. LV. EQUILIBRIUM STATES OF STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTEMS
to the canonical f o r m
(x)
If s y s t e m is sufficiently close to (A), t h i s transformation, by
Lemma 1, is a r b i t r a r i l y close to the identity transformation. The a r g u -
m e n t s used i n the proof of Lemma 1 2 t h e r e f o r e still apply. Q. E. D.
R e m a r k 1. F r o m Lemma 4 and the proof of Theorem 1 3 we s e e that
if H is a sufficiently s m a l l canonical neighborhood of the saddle point 0, then
for any E* > Othere e x i s t s 6* > 0 with the following property: if s y s t e m (A*)
is 6'-close to s y s t e m (A), then
e*
( H , A) = (H*, A*), (27)
88
respectively, by a linear transformation (Tpecifically, by the transformation
which r e d u c e s ( M )to the canonical f o r m (A)). T h e r e f o r e H* is a l s o a
canonical neighborhood of the saddle point O*.
R e m a r k 2. A s we have a l r e a d y noted, i f Mo ( r o ,yo) is a s i m p l e saddle
point of s y s t e m (A), any s y s t e m sufficiently c l o s e to (A) h a s precisely one
s t a t e of equilibrium in a sufficiently c l o s e neighborhood of M0,which is
a l s o a saddle point.
where
~ ( p e, ) = a p i g (pcose, psin8)cose+Ip(pcose, psine)sine,
tp (p cos 6, p sin 6) case- p ( p c 0 ~ 6 p. s i o 6 ) sin 8.
0 (p, 6)= - (4)
P P
It is f u r t h e r a s s u m e d that
a (0, e) = o (5)
89
I
Ch.IV. EQUILIBRIUM STATES OF STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTEMS
P=P(Q, e=ew
is a solution of s y s t e m (3), 2 is the corresponding path, and (po, e0)is a point
on this path,
P = f (0, eo, p0) (13)
is the equation of this path.
90
910. iTRC C I I R.:.L LYSr.ABlLITY c T AX EQLrIL[SRIK.\! STATE
FIGLrRE 26.
91
Ch. IV. EQUILIBRIUM STATES OF STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTEMS
92
5 IO. STRL'CTVFUL IPST.4BILITY OF AN EQCILIBRICrhl STATE
The i-th focal value is the number d i )(0) (if it exists. of course).
93
Ch. IV. EQUILIBKIUM STATES OF STKUCTUKALLY STABLE SYSTEMS
Let @ > O a n d s u p p o s e t h a t O ( 0 , O ) i s a s t a b l e f o c u s . A s w e h a v e n o t e d
a t the end of $10.1, t h e r e e x i s t s ro > 0, such that f o r a l l po. 0 < P O < ro, the
function d (p0) is defined and d (po) < 0 .
Let ri be some fixed number, 0 < r, < ro. Then
d (rl) <0.
Consider the modified s y s t e m
dx -
==ax-@By+cp(x, By),
(A)
~ = b + ~ B y + w Z Y)
,
d"(rz)> 0. (28)
94
$10. STRC CTCrR.-\L C\ST;\R[LLTY OF AS EQK'ILISRILrhl ST.-\TE
4. Proof of s t r u c t u r a l instability
95
Ch.lV. EQUILIBRIUM STATES OF STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTEMS
@
non-zero a.
Under these Zonditions 0 E H" and i t is an equili-
b r i u m s t a t e of (A). It follows f r o m (29) that, a s
H c o n t a i t s only one equilibrium s t a t e of (A),
s y s t e m (A) h a s only one equilibrium s t a t e in B,
namely the point 9. Since a # 0, the point 0 is a
I
focus of s y s t e m (A). - H e n c ~ ,in a sufficiently s m a l l
neighborhood of 0 s y s t e m (A) h a s no closed paths.
Under the e-translation realizing relation (29),
FIGURE 27 point 0 is mapped into itself (since t h i s is a path-
conserving translation). T h e r e f o r e s y s t e m (A) does
not have any closed paths in a sufficiently s m a l l
neighborhood of 0, e i t h e r . This indicates that 0 is neither a c e n t e r nor a
center-focus for (A), i.e., it is inevitably a focus.
We have shown so far that if 0 (0, 0 ) is a s t r u c t u r a l l y stable s t a t e of
equilibrium of s y s t e m (A), 0 is a multiple focus.
Let U be the neighborhood UT(O),where r is so s m a l l that s y s t e m (A) has
no closed paths in U and the only equilibrium s t a t e in t h i s neighborhood is 0;
moreover, s y s t e m (A) is s t r u c t u r a l l y stable in U. For a s m a l l r, t h e s e
conditions a r e satisfied since 0 is a s t r u c t u r a l l y stable multiple focus.
I
Let W denote U,,z (0)( F i g u r e 27). Fix E > 0, e (2, and let 8 > 0 be s o s m a l l
that if s y s t e m (A) is 8-close to (A), w e have
e - -
(u,A ) = (U,A ) ,
where @ i ssome region. System (z)
is a s y s t e m 8-close to (A) which h a s
a closed path & in W ; t h i s s y s t e m (A) e x i s t s i n v i r t u e of Theorem 14
(i.e., the theorem of creation of a limit-cycle f r o m a multiple focus).
Note that W c b.* Therefore @contains the closed path of s y s t e m (A),
and then, by (30), U contains a closed path of s y s t e m (A). This c o n t r a d i c t s
our choice of U. The contradiction e s t a b l i s h e s the fallacy of our original
96
4 11. A SADDLE- TO-SADDLE SEP.IP..ATRLX
97
FIGURE 28
98
S 11. .-3.4
I DDLE- TO-SADDLE SEP.4RA TRLX
d t = > . , s i 9: ( 5 , = P (x,y),
(1)
2
_ = &g -!-'p (5, y) = Q (5. y).
w h e r e i.,> 0. A? < 0.
A s in J5, consider a sufficiently s m a l l rectangle with v e r t i c e s
-4, D . B1.A I ( F i g u r e 20). T h e paths of s y s t e m ( A ) i n this rectangle are shown
in Fi-gure 20. A s the s e p a r a t r i x L,, we take L,. W e will f i r s t prove a
p a r t i c u l a r case, when the a r c without contact 1 is the s i d e .4Ac of the
rectangle E.':: The positive direction along 1 is defined as the direction f r o m
A , t o A, and the p a r a m e t e r s is identified with y . Under t h e s e conditions,
the paths of syst-em (A) f o r m positive a n g l e s with A i . 4 .
Note that i f LA) is a s y s t e m sufficiently close to s y s t e m (l), then
1 ) s y s t e m (A) h a s a single equilibrium s t a t e 6 in the rectangle B, which
is a l s o a saddle point a n 3 is a r b i t r a r i l y c l o s e t o 0 (I),@);
2 ) the-sides of the rectangle a r e a r c s without contact f o r the paths of
s y s t e m (A), the paths le.iving R through the s i d e s A A I and BB, and entering
the rectangle R through A B and ?&;
3 ) the s e p a r a t r i c e s I;, and LI, of s y s t e m ( E ) c r o s s the s i d e s A.4, and
CHI a t the points and c,, respectively, which are a r b i t r a r i l y close to C and
C,, and the s e p a r a t r i c e s 2, and z,,
cross the s i d e s A B and d l B 1a t the points
fi and d,, respectively, .,vhich a r e a r b i t r a r i l y close t o D and D,.
The validity of propositions 1 and 2 above is self-evident.
T h e validity of proposition 3 follows f r o m propositions 1 and 2, the
theorem of continuous dependence on the right-hand s i d e s , and f r o m the
fact that ,a closed path cannot e n c l o s e only one equilibrium s t a t e of
s y s t e m ( A ) if it is a saddle point (see QT, 5 1 1 . 2 , C o r o l l a r y 1 of Theore_m 29 and
$11.4, TheoreniJO), so that R contains no closed paths of s y s t e m (A}.""
For s y s t e m (A) we t a k e s a s y s t e m (A'::) of the f o r m
99
I
+z=&
Ch.1V. EQUILIBRIUM STATES OF STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTENS
The path L makes a positive angle with L* a t the point M*. and t h e r e f o r e a s
t d e c r e a s e s , L* p e n e t r a t e s into W,. A s t d e c r e a s e s f u r t h e r , the path L*
should e m e r g e f r o m t h i s region. The path
L*, however, may c r o s s neither the segment
K A 1 nor the a r c N K of the path L . T h e r e -
f o r e , a s t d e c r e a s e s , L* will c r o s s the
segment N A I . But then a l l the paths of
s y s t e m (A*) passing through v a r i o u s points
of the segment A J w i l l c r o s s the segment
4s
N A I a s t d e c r e a s e s , i.e., none of these paths
W' is the s e p a r a t r i x L: of s y s t e m (A*). Hence
N it follows that the s e p a r a t r i x L; c r o s s e s the
4w segment A I A a t a point C*above C, a s o r i g i -
nally stated. The corresponding proposition
FIGURE 29
f o r the o - s e p a r a t r i x L a i s proved along the
s a m e lines. Our l e m m a is thus proved for
a p a r t i c u l a r c a s e , when the a r c without
contact is the segment A I A (or B A ) . Now, by Lemma 10, 44.2, we s e e that
the l e m m a also holds t r u e for any a r c without contact 1 , which s a t i s f i e s
the relevant conditions. Q. E. D.
R e m a r k . It is c l e a r f r o m the above proof that the l e m m a r e m a i n s
valid i f s y s t e m (A*) is given in the f o r m
_
dr -
dt-'-PLf(5> Y)Q. $=Q+Pf(3tY)',
with f ( 5 , y) >0 everywhere in &, except the saddle point, where it may
vanish.
2. Proof of s t r u c t u r a l instability
( H , A) (3,
where gis s o m e region. Let d b e the distance f r o m the boundary of H to
Lo and choose e < d. Let T be the mapping which r e a l i z e s relation ( 2 ) (i. e.,
T is an e-translation which t r a n s f o r m s H into I? and maps paths into paths).
Under the mapping T, the s e p a r a t r i x Lo of system-(A) is c l e a r l y mapped
into a saddle-to-saddle s e p a r a t r i x L", of s y s t e m (A) which l i e s in H (the
-=
l a t t e r follows f r o m the inequality E d , so that the e-translation does not
move the path Lo out of H ) .
100
511. A S.4fiDLE-TO-SADDLE SEPAR4TRIX
6 r,
FIGURE 30
-dd=tz P - p Q , 2d t= Q + p P .
It is assumed, without loss of generality, that the boundary of B is a simple smooth closed curve.
I02
C h a p t e r I7
C L O S E D P A T H S IN S T R U C T U R A L L Y
S T A B L E SYSTEiVIS
INTRODUCTION
I03
ch.v. (ZLOSED I'ATHS IN STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTEMS
Let
z=(P(t), Y = c P W (1)
G = f (n), (4 )
I 04
f; 12. hE[GhBOP.HOOO LF .A CLOSEU P-II'H. SL'CCESSLOh F C h C r l O N
105
$12. .hE[Gfih~Ri:OC~D
CIF .A CLOSED P.4TS. SL'CCESSI<>X F C l C TIQX
I07
Ch.V. CLOSED PATHS IN STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTFMS
=no
f (no) for d (no)=0. (6)
d'(no)=f'(no)-1#O. (9)
108
1.12. \E[GI,BORPOOD OF .1 CLOSED P.l T t l . SC'CCESSION FClKCTIOh
where O<e<l.
Since the k-th derivative is continuous, the s i g n of the coefficient of
(n - no)k in (11) f o r n - no of sufficiently s m a l l absolute value coincides with
the sign of dk)(no). Then it follows f r o m ( l l ) , as in the previous section
f r o m (8), that we obtain one of the c a s e s al, a z r a3, and a4 according as k is
even or odd and d k )(no)is positive or negative.
A s f o r a n analytical dynamic s y s t e m , we c o n s i d e r the case k = I
separately.
In this c a s e , the path is called a s i m p 1 e 1i m i t c y c 1e , as before.*
T h e condition that a t l e a s t one of the n u m b e r s d ( k ) (no),k = 4 , 2, ..., N d o e s
not vanish is sufficient, but not n e c e s s a r y , for the closed path Lo of a
s y s t e m (A) of c l a s s .V to be a l i m i t cycle.
' Sec footnote t o the definition of simple and multiple limit cycles in 512.3.
109
Ch.V. CLOSED PATHS I N STRllCTIlRAI
If for a s y s t e m of c l a s s N
d (no)=d (no)= 6 . . =
d
the motion corresponding to the path L o , T > 0 the period of the functions p
I and Ip. Note that the functions cp and ~p, being solutions of a s y s t e m (A) of
c l a s s N (or a n analytical s y s t e m ) , are functions of c l a s s N + 1 (or
analytical). In p a r t i c u l a r , they a r e a p r i o r i known to have continuous
second derivatives. In what follows, the p a r t i c u l a r choice of the a r c without
contact f o r the construction of the s u c c e s s i o n function n e a r the closed
path i s i m m a t e r i a l . We t h e r e f o r e choose 1 as the s i m p l e s t of these
a r c s , namely a segment of the n o r m a l to the path Lo. We w i l l c o n s t r u c t a
s y s t e m of c u r v i l i n e a r coordinates i n the neighborhood of Lo which is the
most convenient for o u r purpose.
Through e v e r y point M (cp (s), Ip (s)) of the path Lo we draw a n o r m a l to the
path a t that point and lay off s e g m e n t s of length 6 Vcp (s)I + 9 (s)* on e i t h e r
side of Lo along the n o r m a l .
L e m m a 1 . If 6 > 0 i s sufficiently small, no two segments of normals
drawn through different points of L~ have any points in comman.
The proof of this l e m m a using the usual compactness considerations and
the existence and continuity of the second derivatives of the functions q and
'1 is given in the Appendix, subsection -1:.
m
W e will take 6 > (J to be so s m a l l that L e m m a 1
is satisfied. Then the ends of the s e g m e n t s of
length 6 1 q' ( s ) - ~ q' (s)'-laid off the n o r m a l on the
positive (negative) side of the path L,, f o r m a s i m p l e
closed c u r v e I?, (r2). T h e c u r v e s F, and r- are
"concentric" with the path Lo and enclose a region 0
of the plane (2,y). Q is c l e a r l y homomorphic to a n
open c i r c u l a r ring (Figure 3 6 ) .
I'IGi,R .n For a sufficiently s m a l l 6 , s y s t e m ( A ) h a s no
t:quilibrium s t a t e s in SI. We w i l l a s s u m e that this
condition is a l s o satisfied.
M'e introduce the functions
for n = 0 is equal to
i.e., for n=O i t does not vanish for any s , - - s o < s < + m .
F r o m property 4 and the compactness of the segment u,<s,<T, using the
periodicity of the functions 9, and $ in s, we see that for all sufficiently
sniall 1 1 ,
1 ( S . n) =+u.
(5)
--
a ) Mapping ( 6 ) maps the s t r i p ( 3 ) of the (s. n) plane onto the annular
, . -, *
b ) The a x i s n = 0 is mapped by ( 6 ) into the path L o , the l i n e s n =
= C, 0 < I c 1 < 6 p a r a l l e l to the axis s are mapped into nonintersecting s i m p l e
closed c u r v e s which lie one inside the other i n 8 (these c u r v e s a r e
''concentric" with L o ) .
c ) The segments s = const, - 8 < n < 6 , of the s t r i p ( 3 ) a r e mapped into
n o r m a l segments to & ( F i g u r e 37).
FIGURE 37
I12
513. CI.RVILI'.E.W COORDINATES
2. T r a n s f o r m a t i o n to the v a r i a b l e s s, n i n a
dynamic s y s t e m
T a k e the s y s t e m ( A }
_
d2 -
d t - p (I,Y). $= Q (I, Y)
By condition 4, the d e t e r m i n a n t
Since (see ( 2 ) )
I I3
R (s, 0) 3 0.
s = s (t), n =n ( t ) (16)
is a path e
of ( 8 ) , and so, no is a point on this path, the solution n = f (s; so. no)
of equation (8) is a n equation of 2 i n the coordinates s. n. The mapping ( 6 )
moves the path t into the line
2 = 6 (s ( t ) ,n ( t ) ) , Y =3 (s( t ) , n ( t ) ) , (17)
* The treatment of these subjects is analogous to the treatment of paths near a focus. See $10.1 and also
QT, 68.3.
rr138 114
$1':. P \ I L [ T E i R COORDlS.-\TES
<;I
n = f (s; 0, n ; ) .
11. For any e > O , there exists q > 3. q = q (E), such that if no I < q, then
' Thc p t h 1, of (.A) is a n h a s < o f o n e (if it is claed) or infinitely many (if it is o p e d parhs of system ( 8 ) .
t k ' ~ ,w i l l not ci> into this problen. SeeQT. 9E.3.
115
I16
$12. CC'RI I L I 1 E . W COCRDLKATES
Setting n,=O in equation (23) and integrating with the initial condition (24),
we find
rif 0. no)
1 <W;+Q&[in N'P'!s)ll"tV ( ~ ) P ) I ds
')
(t:
= ,o -
-
on,, l-=o I
F r o m (18) and (29). setting S=T and r e m e m b e r i n g that the functions 'p and
rb and their derivatives a r e periodic, we finally obtain a n e x p r e s s i o n
I I7
I Ch. V. CLOSED PATHS I N S'I'RUC'I'URALLY S l A B L E S Y S I'EMS I
for f' (0):
%
0
+ 9 (4)l cis, and t h e r e -
[ P ' ('P (SI,$ (4) Q; ('P (4,
f o r e the c h a r a c t e r i s t i c index x . a r e invariant under a transforniation of
coordinates, i.e., they do not depend on the p a r t i c u l a r s y s t e m of coordinates
i n which the dynamic s y s t e m is d e s c r i b e d . T h i s i n t e g r a l is t h e r e f o r e
completely determined by the closed path L o . ff the c h a r a c t e r i s t i c index
x # O , thend' (0) + O , and the closed path Lo is a l i m i t cycle (112.3 and 512.4).
D ef i n i t i o n 18. A closed path Lo is called a simple limit cycle if
I18
be a dynamic s y s t e m of class S',. 1 or a n analytical s y s t e m , defined i n G.
Let L., be a closed path 3f ( A ) in G , which is a s i m p l e limit cycle. Let a l s o
r=q(t). y=*(t), (1 1
Clearly d (0) = 0, and f r o m the definition of a simple limit cycle, d' (0) fi).
Let d' (u) < 0 , i.e., the limit cycle Lo is stable. If L o is a n unstable limit
cycle, the proof is completely analogous.
* I f the m i n t YOcorresponds t o t =- 0 o n the path L o , the equations of the normal are (see $ 1 ~ 1 .115,)
.
I =~~Iu-~z$'(O), y=t(O)-nq'(O).
I I9
ch.V. CLOSED PATHS IN STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTEMS
I20
the path z2 inside Lo. The segment Pl.G7, of the a r c / c o n t a i n s a sequence of
points.
- - - ..
PI. P , . Pa, .
( H , A)
e - -
= ( H , .A).
In this way w e s h a l l have proved that L o is a s t r u c t u r a l l y s t a b l e path (see
1 7 . 1 and Definition 10, $6.1).
Let n be any positive number. W e s h a l l f i r s t show that i f 6?, 0 < 6? < b 1
is sufficiently s m a l l , and s y s t e m (A) is &-close to s y s t e m (A), w e c a n
c o n s t r u c t a topological mapping 'p of the segment P,Q, of the a r c 1 onto itself
.which h a s the following p r o p e r t i e s :
( a ) The points P , and QI a r e mapped into themselves, i.e., p (PI)= P I ,
'p rQ,)= 0,. Points lying on one path of s y s t e m ( A ) are mapped into points
of one path of s y s t e m (A) (and vice v e r s a ) .
( b ) The mapping 'p is a n-translation ( i . e . , f o r any point ,If of the
segment P I Q l ,.o fJf. p (ill)) -=cn I.
\ V e w i l l first c o n s t r u c t a topological mapping of the a r c P I Q I onto itself
which s a t i s f i e s p r o p e r t y ( a ) above, without bothering with p r o p e r t y (b) for
the time being. T h i s mapping is constructed s e p a r a t e l y on the segment
P,.\I% and then o n the s e g m e n t QI.lfo. The segment P , M 0 is mapped onto the
segment F,,e,, i n the following m a n n e r :
1) T a k e any topological mapping T~ of the segment P I P t onto the
segment such that
TI (PI)=PI. TI (P2)= P , .
21 Assuming that the mapping TFR-,of the segment P&$k onto ph-,P, (k =
= 2. 3. 4 , ..
. ) h a s been c o n s t r u c t e d , we define q Aa s the mapping of P 4 P G Lonto ,
ii$,,, i n d u c e d by the mapping 9 k - I i n the fol1owing s e n s e : i f .Me_,and . ! I k
a r e two s u c c e s s i v e intersection points a t which s o m e path L of s y s t e m ( A )
m e e t s the path l a s t i n c r e a s e s , which lie i n the s e g m e n t s P k - l P k and P I P h . , ,
c3.v. CLOSED PATHS I N s I'RUC I'URALLY STABLE sysrms I
respectively, and M k W l an? iGk a r e two s u c c e s s i v e intersection points a t
which path 2 of s y s t e m (A) m e e t s the arc 1 a s t i n c r e a s e s , which lie in the
I
I
' P h (ivh)= i v k
(Figure 40). In this figure, the intersections of the arc I with the path L and
5
with the path are shown s e p a r a t e l y f o r c l a r i t y . Since e v e r y a r c L (Z)of
s y s t e m (A) ((A)) passing through points of the segment P I P , (Pip,)m e e t s each
of the s e g m e n t s PkPI14,($k&), k = 2 , 3, 4 , . . ., p r e c i s e l y in one point, the
mapping ' p h is single-valued. Clearly,
3 ) Let cp((Mo)=Moand suppose that 'p coincides with 'pR on the segment
P,$Pk+g(k 1, 2, . . .).
E
FIGURE 40
* W e can readily write an analytical expression defining the mapping 'p. Let f(n) be the succession function
on the arc I defined by system (A), and r(n) (x).
an analogous function for system Let g(n) be a function
which defines a topological mapping of the segment P , P , onto Ripz. Clearly, the iteration
[ f ( n ) j k - ' = f ( k - ' ) (n) defines a mapping of P I P z on PkPa+l. This is a topological mapping, and the
inverse mapping therefore exists. The corresponding function for the inverse mapping w i l l be designated
(n). The functions T("-') and f - ( k - l ) are treated similarly. Then if M is a point of the
segment PkP&l, n the value of the parameter corresponding t o this point M , and ;the value of the
parameter corresponding to q ( M ) , we have
\"-'I gf-\"-"(n).
An analogous expression is obtained for the mapping cp on the segment QkQk+l. I(*) (n)= [f (n)f is not a
..
symbol of a derivative here: this is the k-th iteration of the function f. i.e., f (f (f (. f (n) .))). ..
122
!Ve will now show that f o r a sufficiently s m a l l & 2 and a n appropriate
choice of q r and g,,*. the mapping g, constructed according to the above
formula jvill satisfy con,jition (b), i.e., i t will be a 0-translation. To prove
this, w e s t a r t with a fix,-.d u > 0 and choose a sufficiently l a r g e natural
number I, so that the segment P,Qlof the a r c I is entirely contained in
I', ? (.llo)(the point Mo evidently lies on this segment).
A11 the paths passing f o r t = t o through points of the segment P I P 2 ( Q 1 Q 2 ,
respectively) c r o s s all the s e g m e n t s Pipitl (Q,Q,+,,respectively) f o r
i - - 2, 3, .... I - 1 in a fin:.te time (see QT, $ 3 . 8 , L e m m a 13). It follows from
this and f r o m S4.2, L e m m a s 7 through 11, that f o r sufficiently s m a l l 6 2 and
a n appropriate choice of the mapping 'p, and 'pi*
1 J the section p,G, of the a r c 1 (containing the point .\?d) is entirely con-
tained in C,-arz(.If,,);
2 ) the mapping qh of the segment PAPAAIonto the segment Pk& (k =
- 1 , 2, .... I - 1 ) i s a o-translation;
3 ) the mapping q: of the segment QhQk+, onto the segment q& ( k =
- 1. 3. . . ., I - 1) is a u-translation.
Since the two s e g m e n t s P,Q,and p,@,lie in U,.2 and the mapping g: moves
the f o r m e r into the l a t t e r , the mapping 'p is a u-translation on the
segment P,Q,. Hence and f r o m conditions 2 and 3 i t follows that under
these conditions the mapping 'p of P,Q, is a a-translation.
We have thus shown that if a2 is sufficiently s m a l l , and s y s t e m (g)is
a:-close to s y s t e m (A), we c a n construct (for any 0 ) 9 ) a mapping q of the
segment P,Q, of the arc 1 onto itself which s a t i s f i e s conditions ( a ) and (b).
LVe will now show tha: f o r any E > 0 and for s y s t e m (A) sufficiently c l o s e
to [,A), we have
(H, A) & ( E , d).
Let e > O be fixed. By L e m m a 8, S4.2, t h e r e exist u'>O and & > O , & ( b 2
which satisfy the following condition: if q ' is a mapping of the segment P;Q;
of the arc I' onto the szgment p;o; of the s a m e arc, which i s a o'-translation,
and s y s t e m s ( A ) and ( A ) a r e d,-close, t h e r e e x i s t s a mapping T, of the
e l e m e n t a r y quadrangle -I! onto the quadrangle ?12 which coincides with q'on
P,Q;, moves paths into paths, and is a n &-translation. Let & > O , d , < h 2 be
sit s m a l l that if s y s t e m ( E ) is 6,-close t o s y s t e m (A), t h e r e e x i s t s a
mapping T of the e l e m e n t a r y quadrangle A, on the quadrangle 6, satisfying
the following conditions:
1 ) TI coincides on PI(),with the previously described mappinq q~of this
segment onto itself;
2 1 T,moves paths into paths;
3 ) TI is a n -translation;
31 on P@;, the mapping T is a 0'-translation (moving this segment into
P ; Q , ).
'The existence of a number 6, > 0 with the above p r o p e r t i e s follows f r o m
Leninia 8, S4.2, and f r o m the fact that f o r c l o s e s y s t e m s the mapping cp is
a n a r b i t r a r i l y s m a l l translation (property b). A s the number J w e choose-
a n a r b i t r a r y positive number, s m a l l e r than e i t h e r 6 ; o r 6 , . Let s y s t e m ( A )
be &-close to s y s t e m ( A ) . X'e construct a mapping 'p of the segment P,Q,,
then a mapping TI of the cuadrangle A , onto SI with p r o p e r t i e s 1 through 4 .
The mapping q' is identified with the mapping T,on the segment P;Q;(which
123
Ch.V. CLOSED PATHS IN STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTEMS
1. The fundamental l e m m a
Let, as before,
124
915. C TRr.CTC RALLY I N S T A B L E CLc)SED P.A7klS
For a ( s ) and b (s) w e may take the functions $' (s) and - cp' ( s ) , respectively,
provided they are functi.ons of c l a s s 2 (this will be s o i f ( A ) is a s y s t e m of
c l a s s 2, say). If, however, $' ($)and - cp' (,s)arefunctions of c l a s s 1, but
not of c l a s s 2, a (s) and t t (s) c a n be identified with trigonometric polynomials
of period T which e n s u r e a n adequate approximation to 9' (s) and - cp' (s).
I'hese polynomials exist in v i r t u e of W'eierstrass's theorem ( s e e /ll,/,
L'ol. 3 . Sec. 734, p. 5 8 0 ) evidently meet condition (4).
Let 6 be s o m e sufficiently s m a l l positive number. W e will consider ( 2 )
as equations which define the mapping of the s t r i p
of the s t r i p (5) is moved to a straight segment I , through the point .TI (s) of
the path L o corresponding to the value s of the p a r a m e t e r . in virtue of
condition (4), the segment Isdoes not touch the path L o at the point ,I/ (s).
3loreover, from the the3rem of implicit functions and from condition ( 4 )
it follows that i n a sufficiently s m a l l neighborhood of any point (s, 0) of
the a x i s s, the mapping (i2)is one-to-one. But then i t c a n be shown,
p r e c i s e l y a s in L e m m a 1, 513.1, that if 6 is sufficiently s m a l l , no two
s e g m e n t s I , corresponding to different points of the path Lo (e.g., f o r
OKs < T) i n t e r s e c t . W e w i l l a s s u m e that this condition is indeed satisfied.
The s t r i p ( 5 ) is then mo7;ed by mapping ( 2 ) into s o m e closed ring in the
plane (I. y) enclosed by simple closed c u r v e s f,and rn ( F i g u r e 41). If 6 is
sufficiently s m a l l , then a t any point of the s t r i p ( 5 )
(8)
O=[$(s)+nb(s)]~+b(s)~
and
o = [cp (s) + na (s)] 2
aY
+ a (s) *
av
,
l = [ q ( s ) + n b ( s ) j zs+b ( s an) .~
ay
I
For n = O , each of the s y s t e m s ( 8 ) and (9), considered a s a l i n e a r s y s t e m
of equations i n the p a r t i a l derivatives, h a s a determinant A (s) which d o e s not
vanish in v i r t u e of (4). Solving these s y s t e m s and r e m e m b e r i n g that
n = F ( x , y) and that for n = O , z=cp(s), y = Q ( s ) , we find
Hence,
126
The boundary of the- ring 5 c o m p r i s e s the two simple c u r v e s I", and r2
.with t h e p a r a m e t r i c ecquations
and
.r = cp (s) - 6a (Y), y = $ (Y) -6b ( s ) .
I27
Ch.V. CLOSED PATHS IN STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTEMS
128
915. STRVCTLRALLY CKST.ABLE CLOSED P.ATHS
\ IPk((cp(4,+ ~ s ~ ) + ' ? L ( ~ ( s ) , $ ( s ) ) l d s =
i
The continuity of the function ;and inequalities (14) and ( 1 9 ) show that
between n, and ng t h e r e is a t least one value ,R*>O such that a(,*)= 0. This
number c o r r e s p o n d s to a closed path L* of (A) which d o e s not coincide with
Lo. By condition (c) imposed on 8 , . L * c U , ( L o ) . The second closed path of
(A) lying in L'e(Lo) is Lo itself. The theorem is thus proved f o r the case
when (A) is a s y s t e m of class 1.
If (A) is a s y s t e m of c l a s s S > l . r g S , and the c l o s e n e s s is considered
to rank r, the proof proceeds along the s a m e lines, but F ( r , y) is a function
-'+
of c l a s s 1 ( s e e R e m a r k 1 to L e m m a 1 ) and p is sufficiently s m a l l for
( A ) to be &close to (A) to rank r .
Let now (A) be a n analytical s y s t e m . In this case, L e m m a 1 does not
apply i n i t s original f o r m . Indeed, w e c a n c o n s t r u c t in the neighborhood
of Lo a n analytical function F (I, y) satisfying conditions ( a ) and (b); this
may be accomplished a s f o r s y s t e m s of c l a s s A'. This function, however,
cannot be continued to the e n t i r e region i n g e n e r a l . W e will therefore
adopt a slightly different c o u r s e .
To fix ideas, l e t u s suppose, as before, that L o is a stable (multiple)
l i m i t cycle. W e choose s o m e n,. 0 < nl < n * . r h e n d (n,)< 0. Taking a
fixed h > 0 , w e construct a function F (z. y) of class ( r + 1) which s a t i s f i e s
the conditions of L e m m a 1 and consider the s y s t e m (x),
p is chosen as a
a
positive number, Sufficiently s m a l l f o r (A)to be close to (A) to r a n k r and
f o r the following inequality to be satisfied:
d(n,) -==0.
Since f o r p > 0 , 2 (0)> 0 and a l s o d"(0)= 0, we have f o r sufficiently s m a l l
nz>Oand n 3 < 0
129
Ch.V. CLOSED PATHS IN SI'I1UCTUKALLY STABLE SYSlEhlS
and
2 (n.3)<0
(Figure 42a).
FIGLIRE 42
I30
proposition f o r the c a s e of analytical s y s t e m s . The f i r s t , sf'p i s to
c o n s t r u c t , as before, .I s y s t e m ( A I ) of c l a s s 1 of the type ( A ) for which
L,, i s a s i m p l e liniit cy-le and which h a s a n o t h e r c l o s e d path L , close to Lo.
If L , is a s i m p l e liniit cycle, w e take a polynomial (and t h e r e f o r e
a n a l y t i c a l ) s y s t e m (A. I sufficiently c l o s e to ( A I ) . Because of the
s t r u c t u r a l stability of the c y c l e s L , and L , of s y s t e m ( A i ) , s y s t e m (A' )
w i l l have sLructurally :;table c y c l e s f.: and L; in a c l o s e neighborhood of
I.., a n d L t L If L , i s not a simple l i m i t c y c l e of (Ai), we c o n s t r u c t a
s y s t e m \ A , ) r e l a t e d to the c y c l e L , in the s a m e manner a s s y s t e m (.K) is
r e l a t e d to c y c l e L,>n the proof of J 3 e o r e m 15. For a n a p p r o p r i a t e choice
or' the number p , ( A t ) will be so-close to (A,) that in any a r b i t r a r i l y s m a l l
neighborhood of L o the system (Al) will _have a s i m p l e l i m i t c y c l e I%,. The
path L , will be a s i m p l e l i m i t cyc_le of (AI) ( s e e proof of Theorem 15). I t
noiv r e m a i n s to approx-mate to (AI) with a sufficiently c l o s e analytical
sy s te m .
Let u s prove a n o t h e r lemnia ;vhich will be needed in the following. Its
proof is based d i r e c t l y on Leninia 1.
L c )ti ttt n 2. Let
131
Ch.V. CLOSED PATHS IN STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTEh4S 1
Clearly,
WCUCV
FIGURE 43
132
515. S T R I C K R . I L L Y L%ST.-\BLE CLOSED P.XTHS
5 l-pL(T(4? $ ( S ) ) + Q l ( c p ( S ) , $(s))lds=O
( H , A ) E ( H * , A*),
I33
134
51s. m w c r c p i i LI- [ Z 5 l - i W . E C L ~ ~ S EP.-\I~!s
D
I35
C h a p t e r VI
INTRODUCTION
136
5,ystem [%.A) c*
in (The,2r'em 2 3 ) . In 518.3 we prove that these are a l s o
necsessary and sufficient conditions f o r s t r u c t u r a l stability on a s p h e r e
( T h e o r e m 2 4 i . At the end of the section, $18.4 offe1.s a nuniber, of signifi-
c*anf r e m a r k s and supplements. T h e s e include a t h e o r e m which states that
the s t r u c t u r a l l y stable s y s t e m s forni a n open set in the s p a c e of a l l dynamic
systems in a plane retgion (Theorem 2 5 ) and o n a s p h e r e ( T h e o r e m 2 5 ' ) and
ti rheorcni a c c o r d i n g to Lvhich the s t r u c t u r a l l y stable s y s t e m s a r e e v e r y -
Lvhere dense in the s p a c e of the dynamic s y s t e n i s \Theor.em 2 6 ) . T h e s e
t h e o r e m s indicate !hat "almost all" the dynamic s y s t e m s a r e structut-ally
s t a b l e , and s t r u c t u r a l l y unstable s y s t e m s a r e a n exception.
2. r e a d e r ivishing to get h i s teeth into the nieat of the theory without
further. delay may s k i p the proof of the fundamental t h e o r e m s 2 3 ( $ 1 8 . 2 1
ami 2 4 (S18.3j and onl:.- p e r u s e $ 1 6 , 1 , the s t a t e m e n t of T h e o r e m 2 3 i n S 1 8 . 2 ,
iiml a l s o S 1 8 . 3 and S l E . 4 .
6 ) K , o r K , is a saddle point.
7 ) K , or K , is a limit continuum, comprising a saddle point and
saddle -to-saddle s e p a r a t r i c e s which are continuations of one another.
Let u s consider each of the seven c a s e s separately.
C a s e 1 is inapplicable, since all the paths passing sufficiently close to
a node o r a focus go to that singular point, and a r e therefore not closed.
Case 3 is inapplicable, since i f L* leaves G*, any closed path L Apassing
sufficiently close to M * a l s o l e a v e s G*. This contradicts o u r assumption
that all the closed paths are completely contained in G*.
Case 7 is inapplicable, since a structurally stable s y s t e m h a s no
saddle -to-saddle s e p a r a t r i c e s .
We can now concentrate on the remaining c a s e s .
Case 4. Let K , be a node o r a focus 0. Let U, (0)be a sufficiently
s m a l l neighborhood of the point 0, s o that all the paths through this neigh-
borhood go to the point 0 for t + 00 and +
a r e thus not closed. Since the path L* h a s
- points in U, (0), the theorem of the con-
138
None of the c a s e s 1 throuqh 7 is thus applicable. T h i s e s t a b l i s h e s the
validity o i the t h e o r e m .
In QT, $15, we inti-ocluced the concept of o r b i t a l stability and d i s -
t i n p i s h e d between orbitally s t a b l e and orbitally unstable paths. \\e xi11
not repeat the previous r e s u l t s h e r e . It sufiices to s a y that if s y s t e m :A]
is s t r u c t u r a l l y s t a b l e in r e g i o n ti*, i t s orbitally unstable paths in t h i s r e g i o n
a r e a l l the equilibriuni s t a t e s , limit c y c l e s , and saddle-point s e p a r a t r i c e s .
T h e o r e tri 22. [f systetti ( A ) is st,tictusally stable in ti*. it r)iut*h u i v
only a finite nurnber of orbitally tinstable paths and seuiipn!hs in Z;*.
The validity of this theoretn follows d i r e c t l y f r o m Theorem 10,
T h e o r e m 11 ( 7 ) , and T h e o r e m 2 1 ,
Rema r k . T h e o r e m s 2 1 and 22 c l e a r l y r e m a i n valid ..vhen the r e q u i r e -
ment of s t r u c t u r a l stability of s y s t e m (-4)is replaced by a r e o u i r e m e n t that
s y s t e m \.A] satisfies conditions I through 111 (these r e u u i r e m e n t s a r e
actually equivalent, but this still r e m a i n s to be provecl I .
2. Regions w i t h n o r m a l boundary
I39
Ch. VI. NECESSARY AND SUFFICIENT CONDITIONS OF STRUCTURAL STABILITY
FIGURE 45 FIGURE 46
140
!16. SLNGULAR PATHS A N D SEhlIPATHS
LVe will now give a complete l i s t of the various paths, semipaths, and
a r c s of a s t r u c t u r a l l y stable s y s t e m (A) in a region c* with a n o r m a l
boundary.
A) S i n g u l a r o r b i t a l l y u n s t a b l e p a t h s a n d s e m i p a t h s :
1 ) An equilibrium s t a t e (a stable node or focus, a n unstable node or
focus, a saddle point).
2 ) A limit cycle (stable or unstable).
3 ) A s e p a r a t r i x which goes to a saddle point f o r t + + m (- OJ) and to a n
unstable (stable) focus, node, or limit cycle f o r t + - 00 ( - a),or which
leaves c* through a boundary a r c or through a cycle without contact a s t
decreases (increases).
B) S i n g u l a r o r b i t a l l y s t a b l e s e m i p a t h s .
4) A c o r n e r semipath going for t + - 00 (" m ) to a n unstable (stable)
node, focus, or limit cycle.
C) S i n g u l a r a r c s a n d c y c l e s w i t h o u t c o n t a c t :
5) A corner arc.
61 X boundary a r c of a path.
7 ) A boundary a r c without contact.
8 ) A boundary cycle without contact.
D) N o n - s i n g u l a r w h o l e p a t h s a n d s e m i p a t h s :
9 ) P a t h s going for I -+ - m to a n unstable and for t + -i- m to a stable
node, focus, or limit cycle ( 9 different possibilities).
1 0 ) Semipaths goin,g f o r t+ - 00 (+ m) to a n unstable (stable) node,
focus, or limit cycle and emerging f r o m c*through a boundary arc or cycle
without contact as t i n c r e a s e s ( d e c r e a s e s ) .
E) N o n - s i n g u l a r w h o l e a r c s :
1 1 j An a r c of a path which is neither a c o r n e r a r c nor a boundary arc,
whose end points lie on boundary a r c s o r c y c l e s without contact, and all
the other points are in G*.
In what follows, stable nodes, foci, and limit c y c l e s of s y s t e m ( A ) lying
in c*(or i n fact only i n G*) will be called a t t r a c t i o n e l e m e n t s or
s i n k s , and unstable Lodes, foci, and limit c y c l e s w i l l be called r e p u 1 -
s i o n e l e m e n t s or s o u r c e s . Boundary a r c s or c y c l e s without con-
tact through which paths e m e r g e f r o m c* a s t i n c r e a s e s c a n a l s o be i n t e r -
preted in a s e n s e a s attraction e l e m e n t s (sinks), w h e r e a s boundary a r c s
and c y c l e s without contact through which paths e n t e r c* may be r e g a r d e d
a s repulsion e l e m e n t s ',sources).
Since a s t r u c t u r a l l y stable s y s t e m i nc* h a s only a finite number of
singular elements, all the propositions regarding the partition of E* into
c e l l s , formulated i n QY, 16> r e m a i n valid. In particular, the s e t E of all
the points of c* which telong t o singular e l e m e n t s is a closed s e t . Its
complement, i.e., the open s e t C * - E , c o n s i s t s of a finite number of c o m -
ponents, called c e 11 s . Each cell is filled with non-singular paths, s e m i -
paths, or a r c s of paths which show "identical" behavior i n a c e r t a i n s e n s e
(see QT, 516, T h e o r e m s 46-48, 5 3 , 5 7 ) . The cells are e i t h e r singly
connected o r doubly connected. In the next chapter w e w i l l consider the
various types of cells of s t r u c t u r a l l y stable s y s t e m s .
Ch. VI. NECESSARY AND SUFFICIENT CONDITIONS OF STRUCTURAL S'iABILITY
I
s17. A REGULAR SYSTEM OF NEIGHBORHOODS AND
THE PARTITION OF -6* INTO CANONICAL NEIGHBOR-
HOODS AND ELEMENTARY QUADRANGLES
1. A r e g u l a r s y s t e m of canonical neighborhoods f o r
structurally stable systems
143
Ch. VI. NECESSARY A N D SUFFlCIENT CONDITIONS OF STRUCTURAL STABILITY I
FIGURE 48
* In QT, 427, the concept of a regular system of canonical neighborhoods was defined for dynamic systems
of a more general type. T h e dynamic systems considered in this chapter satisfy conditions 1-111, and
therefore their regular system of canonical neighborhoods meets the condition formulated below (these condi-
rions are stronger than in the general case).
144
$17. FEGULAR SYFTEN OF (7.4KOhIC;IL KEIGkfBORtlOODS
FIGURE 49
In Figure 49, the simple a - a r c s AiBl and BzCl a r e the conjugates of the
simple a - a r c s A B and BC, and the simple a - a r c B,B2 is the conjugate of the
cyclic a - a r c I' with M o a s i t s end point. All these a r c s a r e contained i n
the boundary of the doubly connected region 6*.
5438 I46
017. REGULAR SYSTEhI OF C l N O N l C A L NEIGHBORHOODS
I47
Ch. VI. NECESSARY AND SUFFICIENT CONDITIONS OF STRUCTURAL STABILITY
I
with a cycle without contact C which belPngs to a s o u r c e (Figure 51). On
c
the cycle we choose two points A and B on the two s i d e s of R and sufficiently
c l o s e to i t so that the a r c A B of the cycle
contains no points of the previously defined
I
arcs y; and no o t h e r points of any c o r n e r
paths, except the point R. Let u s consider
the a r c s RA and RB s e p a r a t e l y , denoting
them i , and x2.
A s t i n c r e a s e s , the paths through the
points of one of t h e s e a r c s (in F i g u r e 51,
through the points of x 2 ) w i l l c r o s s the a r c
x 2 which is p a r t of a boundary a r c without
contact and h a s R as one of i t s end points
(all the other points of xz belong to non-
singular paths). The paths through the
FIGURE 5 1 points of the second a r c , xi, will c r o s s with
i n c r e a s i n g t the a r c xi, which is a l s o p a r t
of a boundary a r c o r cycle without contact,
o r (as in F i g u r e 51) is p a r t of a cycle without contact which belongs to a sink.
One of the end points of xi - w e denote it by R, - belongs to a c o r n e r a r c o r
semipath o r is a c o r n e r point of the boundary, and all the other points of the
a r c xi belong to non-singular paths. The quadrangle delimited by the a r c s
without contact xi and it (i = 1, 2) and the a r c s of the paths through t h e i r end
points is the e l e m e n t a r y quadrangle A,. The a r c s xi and xi will be called
conjugate, as before.
W e take all the c o r n e r s e m i p a t h s k i , whether positive o r negative, and
c o n s t r u c t the corresponding e l e m e n t a r y quadrangles A, in the s a m e way.
Note that i f t h e r e a r e two different semipaths, a positive and a negative one,
which are a continuation of the s a m e boundary a r c of a path, the two c o r r e -
sponding arcs x and x w i l l be chosen "compatibly." This is b e s t illustrated
with a n example: in F i g u r e 51, the semipaths 2 and L1 with the end points R
and R,, respectively, a r e continuations of the s a m e boundaryAarcR,k,. We
may t h e r e f o r e choose a r b i t r a r i l y one of the two arcs xi and xi, and the other
a r c is automatically determined by this choice. Both t h e s e a r c s define
the s a m e e l e m e n t a r y quadrangle A,.
Let b j ( j = 1, 2, ...,A) be all the f i f f e r e n t e l e m e n t a r y quadrangles constructed
in this way. All the a r c s xt (and x,) are taken sufficiently s m a l l , so that they
have no common i n n e r points between themselves and no common points
(whether i n n e r points o r end points) with the previously defined a r c s y , .
Under t h e s e conditions no two e l e m e n t a r y quadrangles A , ( i = 1, 2, ...) and
6 , ( j = 1, 2, ...) have any i n n e r points i n common (but and d, may have
common a r c s of paths i n their boundaries or p a r t s o,f boundary a r c s . T h e
second c a s e is observed, e.g., for the quadrangles A i and A2in F i g u r e 51).
The e l e m e n t a r y quadrangles A, adjoin c o r n e r paths (and possibly their
continuations also; for example, the quFdrangle A2 i n F i g u r e 51 adjoins the
semipath L , and 6, adjoins the semipath L , i t s continuation - the boundary
a r c RR, - and the continuation of this a r c , the semipath Li).
Following the s a m e p r o c e d u r e a s f o r the quadrangles A j , we define the
e l e m e n t a r y quadrangles A i (k = 1, 2, ..., N*)adjoining c o r n e r a r c s . The a r c s
without contact forming the boundaries of the quadrangle A i will be d e -
signated hk and h f ; t h e s e a r c s will a l s o be called conjugate. Note that a
148
51 7. REGIJLAR SYSTEM OF CANONICAL NEIGHdORHOODS
FIGLIRE 5 2
I49
Ch. VI. NECESSARY AND SUFFICIENT CONDITIONS O F STRUCTURAL STABILITY
I
the boundary of e*, the paths of s y s t e m (A) entering z* (leaving c*)through
them."
Let u s f u r t h e r consider all the non-free cycles without contact &Or) which
belong to s o u r c e s , and a l l the boundary a r c s without contact and the
non-free cycles without contact Z(")through which paths of s y s t e m (A) ente?
G'*. All the a r c s y $ ) (m = 1, 2 , ..., r)belong to these cycles without contact and
boundary a r c s C(nJ,C ( a l , and Z(Or). Removing f r o m each cycle CCa)and Z(Or)and
f r o m each boundary a r c c(") the points of the a r c s y e ) which belong to the
corresponding elements, we obtain a finite number of open a r c s without
contact which have no common points, The c l o s u r e s of t h e s e a r c s a r e
designated ai"), u p ) , ..., a?). Note that the end points of each of t h e s e a r c s
belong to non-singular paths.
Similarly t r e a t i n g a l l the non-free cycles without contact C(") which belong
to sinks and the boundary a r c s without contact do)and the c y c l e s Z(O), w e
remove f r o m them the points of the a r c s yg) to obtain a r c s without contact
whose c l o s u r e s a r e designated aio), u p ) , ... .
Let u s now consider a l l the paths which a t s o m e t p a s s through points of
the a r c aia) (i = 1, 2, ..., p ) . It is readily s e e n that a s t i n c r e a s e s , they a l l
c r o s s one of the a r c s a(") (by a n appropriate choice of our
notation, we c a n e n s u r e that t h i s is the a r c a$*)). Hence
&<@/ it follows directly that the number of a r c s a$@)is exactly
(23
equal to the number of a r c s aiR), Le., p i n both c a s e s .
The a r c s of paths extending between the a r c s without
contact a{") and a!") f o r m an e l e m e n t a r y quadrangle, which
we designate A : ( i = 1, 2, . . , , p ) . All the quadrangles A;,
like the quadrangles A i , a r e e l e m e n t s of the s e t G* - K .
Finally, l e t u s consider the f r e e a - c y c l e s of s y s t e m (A)
FIGURE 53 i n G* (if any). They a r e designated Bia) (i = 1, 2, ..., q). A
cycle BI") is conjugate, a s we know ( s e e 818.1, L e m m a 3),
with the free a-cycle EloJ, and both t h e s e c y c l e s delimit
an annular region filled with sections of non-singular paths (Figure 53).
Drawing t h r e e path sections i n each of these annuli, we partition them into
e l e m e n t a r y quadrangles A; (i = 1, 2, ..., 3q). They a r e all evidently e l e m e n t s
of the s e t E* - K .
It is readily s e e n that each point of the s e t E* - K belongs a t l e a s t to one
of the quadrangles A; ( j = 1, 2, ..., p ) , A i (i = 1, 2, ..., s), and A i ( k = 1, 2, .... 3q),
and that a l l these quadrangles satisfy the conditions of L e m m a 5. T h i s
completes the proof of the l e m m a .
F i g u r e 52 shows a doubly connected region c* with a n o r m a l boundary.
It c o m p r i s e s two canonical neighborhoods, that of a n unstable node Oi and
that of a saddle point 02. The complement c*- K is partitioned into 1 5
elementary quadrangles. T h i s partition m e e t s a l l the r e q u i r e m e n t s of
the lemma.
FIGURE 5 5 FIGURE 57
152
$18. THE FUNDAMENTAL 1HEOREXL OF STRUCTURAL STABILITY
(E,
A)
e1
EE
-
(P,Z),
153
Ch. VI. NECESSARY AND SUFFICIENT CONDITIONS O F STRUCTURAL STABILITY
154
The following l e m m a is a s t r o n g e r version of Leninia 4.
L E i n ttia 5. Let L be a structiwally stable liinit cycle of' systetri (ti),
its canonical neighborhood limited by cycles withoilt contact
y and C2.
Thcn, for an! F > 0 there exist q > 0 am1 6 > 0 with the following property;
~
I55
Ch. VI. NECESSARY A N D SUFFICIENT CONDITIONS OF STRUCTURAL STABILITY
paths of (A) and there exists a mapping T of region y onto which coincides
with cp on the arcs LY)and @', conserves paths, and is an e-translation.
Remark . It evidectly follows f r o m L e m m a 6 that 7 contains a single
I
equilibrium s t a t e 0" of (A), a
being a saddle point and 5 i t s canonical neigh-
borhood. Also I
e , -
(Y?A) = (Y7 A).
I56
IS. THE FUNDAhlENTAL THEOREM OF STRUCTUR>.L STABILITY
(
-
J ,/-\
G Suppose C is made up of arcs without contact
11, I2, ..., ln and arcs of paths 21, z,, ..
., z, of
s y s t e m (A), so that when the c u r v e C is t r a v e r s e d i n
%x,
* /
the positive direction the v a r i o u s arcs are encoun-
.
t e r e d in the o r d e r I t , zl, 1,. z2, . ., I,. z, ( F i g u r e 60),
t h e i r end points ( c o r n e r points) being respectively
Xi. YI, X2, Y l r . . .. X,, Y , . Let Ai, X,, . . ., l,, be s o m e
r, x3 5 fixed elongations of the a r c s I , , 12, .. ., I,. ; Through
* -
y a x the points Y,,Y z . ., Y n we p a s s the arcs ztr z2, ..., z,of
I
157
Ch. VI. NECESSARY AND SUFFICIENT CONDITIONS OF STRUCTURAL STABILITY
158
518. THE FUNDAMENTAL THEOREhl OF STRLrCTURAL STABILITY
(8,A ) 2 (3,2)
159
I Ch. VI. NECESSARY AND SUFFICIENT CONDITIONS OF STRUCTURAL STABILITY
..., &},
I b=min(8i,8z7 qF=min{qt.q~,
9
The end points of the arcs ah may also belong to the elementary quadrangles 4.
161
Ch. VI. NECESSARY AND SUFFICIENT CONDITIONS OF STRUCTURAL STABILITY
3. The fundamental t h e o r e m f o r a s p h e r e
(S, x):(S, A ) .
The n e c e s s a r y and sufficient conditions of s t r u c t u r a l stability of a
s y s t e m defined on a s p h e r e p r e c i s e l y coincide with the corresponding con-
ditions for a s y s t e m on a plane. We w i l l now prove the following t h e o r e m .
T h e o r e m 24. A dynamic system (A) defined on a sphere s is
structurally stable if and only if
I . Each of the equilibrium states of system (A) i s a simple node,
saddle point, m focus.
II. The closed paths of system (A) are simple limit cycles.
III. System (A)has no saddle-to-saddle separatrices.
P r o o f . To fix o u r ideas, l e t ( A ) be a n analytical s y s t e m on a s p h e r e ,
and we will prove s t r u c t u r a l stability r e l a t i v e t o t h e s p a c e Rh". S t r u c t u r a l
stability r e l a t i v e to the s p a c e Rh"(r > 1)i s proved in the s a m e way, and
the proof r e l a t i v e to the s p a c e R g ) is even s i m p l e r .
Su f f i c i e n c y. The sufficiency of conditions I through 111 f o r the
s t r u c t u r a l stability of s y s t e m (A) on a s p h e r e is proved along the s a m e lines
a s T h e o r e m 23, but on the whole the proof is somewhat s i m p l e r . The
simplification naturally d e r i v e s f r o m the fact that t h e r e a r e no boundary
a r c s of paths and boundary a r c s and c y c l e s without contact on a s p h e r e .
N e c e s sit y . We w i l l only prove the n e c e s s i t y of condition II, namely
that e v e r y closed path of a s t r u c t u r a l l y dynamic s y s t e m on a s p h e r e is a
162
$13. THE FLiXDAhlESTAL THEOREhl OF STRUCTURAL STABILITY
z2-L y 2 + z B = i . is)
As the closed covering of the s p h e r e (%see 5 3 . 2 ) we choose the covering
which c a n be r e g a r d e d as the s i m p l e s t in a c e r t a i n s e n s e : i t c o m p r i s e s
two r e g i o n s zl and 4 , where 3 , is the s e t of a l l the points of the s p h e r e S f o r
which z , , ( z < l , and c2is the s e t of all the points of the s p h e r e for which
-1<z,<z2. U e f u r t h e r a s s u m e that - - I < t , = = z O and z , < z 2 < 1 (Figure 62).
Let U,.J'i be the local coordinates in Gi (i = 1, 2); ci c o r r e s p o n d s to a region
kT in the plane ( u i , v i ) . which may be r e g a r d e d as a c i r c l e centered at the
origin.
163
Ch. VI. NECESSARY AND SUFFICIENT CONDITIONS OF STRUCTURAL STABILI IY I
defined i n the plane region at. Since the c h a r a c t e r i s t i c index of L is z e r o ,
the r e s u l t s of Chapter V show that e i t h e r
(1) the path L is a multiple l i m i t cycle of s y s t e m (A), o r
( 2 ) a l l the paths passing i n a sufficiently s m a l l neighborhood of L a r e
closed paths.
Let u s f i r s t consider c a s e (1). In v i r t u e of Remark 2 to Theorem 19
(15.2)> for any 6, > 0 i n t h i s c a s e t h e r e e x i s t s a s y s t e m (AT) bi-close to
(AI) which h a s a t l e a s t two s t r u c t u r a l l y stable l i m i t c y c l e s in any
a r b i t r a r i l y s m a l l neighborhood of L . W e will denote these limit c y c l e s by
L: and L:.
To simplify the presentation, we identify c, with H , , i.e., consider as
a c i r c l e of r a d i u s R with a c e n t e r a t the origin in the plane (ulrv i ) . Let the
ring B be made up of points of the c i r c l e c, for which the r a d i u s - v e c t o r p
s a t i s f i e s the inequality R , , < p , ( R . F u r t h e r l e t the cycle L lie inside the
c i r c l e O<p<<Rz where Hz< Rt ( F i g u r e 63), and l e t the s y s t e m (A;) have
the f o r m
FIGURE 64
The right-hand s i d e s of s y s t e m (AI) - the functions Pl(ui, vi) and Q1(ul, vi) -
a r e defined by the equalities
+
pi = pi ( ~ -f pi)'P (P), 6,= Q$+ (QT-QJ 'P (P), (5)
where p = v m .
System (AI) with right-hand s i d e s defined by (5) is a s y s t e m of class 1
which coincides with s y s t e m (AI) i n the ring B and with the s y s t e m (A;) i n
the c i r c l e O,<p,<RI. Moreover, it is readily s e e n that if 6, is sufficiently
s m a l l , (AI) c a n be made a r b i t r a r i l y c l o s e to (AI).
Since (AI) and (Aa) coincide i n the ring B a s before, taken together they
constitute a c e r t a i n dynamic s y s t e m on the s p h e r e S, which w e denote by (A).
164
$18. THE FUNDAMENTAL THEOREhl OF STRUCTURAL STABILITY
l-q<r<I+-q,
165
Ch. VI. NECESSARY A N D SUFFICIENT CONDITIONS OF STRUCTURAL STABILITY
4. R e m a r k s and supplements
a) R e m a r k r e g a r d i n g s t r u c t u r a l l y s t a b l e s y s t e m s
inside a cycle without contact.
A s w e have already noted (6.1), s t r u c t u r a l l y stable s y s t e m s were
originally considered in a region limited by a cycle without contact 141, and
not i n any g e n e r a l region. The definition of a s t r u c t u r a l l y stable s y s t e m
can be significantly simplified in this c a s e (compared to Definition 10, 96.1).
Indeed, l e t (A) be a dynamic s y s t e m defined in G, and c* a closed sub-
region of G , limited by a cycle without contact r.
c*
F i r s t l e t u s a s s u m e that (A) is s t r u c t u r a l l y stable i n G*. Since is
evidently a region with a n o r m a l boundary, Theorem 2 3 applies and condi-
tions I through I11 a r e thus satisfied in 8*. Repeating the s a m e a r g u m e n t s
as in the proof of the sufficiency i n Theorem 23, we r e a d i l y see that the
following l e m m a holds t r u e .
L e m m a 8 . F o r any e > 0 , there exists 6 > 0 such that if system (A) is
&close to system (A), we have
(a,
A, (@*,A ) . (6)
( H , A, :(R,A ) ,
provided that s y s t e m s (a) and (A) a r e sufficiently c l o s e , and t h i s i m p l i e s
that (A) is s t r u c t u r a l l y stable i n C*.
We have thus shown that i f (A) is s t r u c t u r a l l y stable i n G*, L e m m a 8
holds true, and vice v e r s a . Hence, the statement of Lemma 8 can be
adopted a s a definition of s t r u c t u r a l stability of a s y s t e m (A) in a region
limited by a cycle without contact.
A s i m i l a r r e m a r k applies to the case when the s y s t e m is considered i n
a region limited by s e v e r a l nonintersecting c y c l e s without contact. The
proof is e n t i r e l y analbgous.
In the g e n e r a l c a s e , when @ is a region with a n o r m a l boundary, the
statement of L e m m a 8 no longer provides a definition of s t r u c t u r a l
stability. Indeed, if ( 6 ) is s a t i s f g d , the boundary arcs of paths of c* should
be a r c s of paths of both (A) and (A). This, however, is not generally t r u e .
b) S t r u c t u r a l l y s t a b l e s y s t e m s o n c l o s e d s u r f a c e s .
The conditions of s t r u c t u r a l stability of dynamic s y s t e m s (of c l a s s 1) on
closed s u r f a c e s of non-zero kind, both oriented and non-oriented, w e r e
considered by M. Peixoto 171. These conditions amount to the following:
a dynamic s y s t e m (A) of class 1 defined on a s u r f a c e of the kind p > O is
s t r u c t u r a l l y stable i f and only i f
1) i t h a s a finite number of equilibrium s t a t e s , a l l of which
are s t r u c t u r a l l y stable;
2 ) i t h a s no saddle-to-saddle s e p a r a t r i c e s ;
166
$18. I H E FUSDAhlEh'TAL THEOREhl OF STRL'CTI'RiL STABILI ITY
py/
belongs to the space R,. We w i l l show that all the dynamic s y s t e m s which
a ' r e sufficiently c l o s e to ( A ) are a l s o s t r u c t u r a l l y
s a b l e . This will prove the theorem.
By T h e o r e m 1, 5123.1, and the r e m a r k to this
theorem, t h e r e e x i s t s a region If with a n o r m a l
boundary such that
B* c H c ~ T cG ,
@Cii
( s e e footnote on p. 67).
The region 3 was d e s c r i b e d i n detail in o u r procf to T h e o r e m 2 3 . In
particular, i t h a s been established th2t if s y s t e m (A) is d,-close to s y s t e m
(A), wher-e 6, is sufficiently small, (A) h a s no equilibrium s t a t e s and no closed
paths i n i? o t h e r than those which fall i n the canonical neighborhoods .Viand
.
I',
167
Ch. VI. NECESSARY AND SUFFICIENT CONDITIONS OF STRUCTURAL STABILITY
&
dt= P ( G Y), -$=Q(z, Y) (A 1
168
518. THE FUVDAhlENTAL THEOREM OF STRC'CTCRAL ST.4BILITY
Consider the s y s t e m
I69
Ch. VI. NECESSARY AND SUFFICIENT CONDITIONS OF S rKIIC rLlKHL S I AHILI I Y
zl>0, a=a+d-0.
u*=p(I)-c).
I I70
$18. THE FUE:DAhlNTAL THEOFFkl OF STRL'CTLIRAL STASII.IT1
171
Ch. VI. NECESSARY AND SUFFICIENT CONDITIONS OF STRUCTURAL STABILITY
I72
$18. THE FUNDAMENTAL THE0GEb.L OF STRUCTURAL STABILITY
133
C h a p t e r VII
C E L L S OF S T R U C T U R A L L Y S T A B L E SYSTEICIS. A N
ADDITION T O T H E T H E O R Y OF S T R U C T U R A L L Y
S T A B L E SYSTEMS
INTRODUCTION
1 74
to local considerations (e.g., i n the neighborhood of a p a r t i c u l a r path),
r a t h e r than proceeding with global t r e a t m e n t . On the o t h e r hand, the
definition without e-identity i s intrinsically s i m p l e r and it d i r e c t l y shows
that s t r u c t u r a l l y stable s y s t e m s constitute a n open s e t i n the s p a c e of
dynamic s y s t e m s .
' The set E comprises the points of all orbitally unstable paths and semipathr. the points of corner s e m i -
pdths ind corner arcs of paths, the points of bounJary arcs and cycles without contact and boundxy
arcs of paths, and all the equilibrium states. See 516.2.
'* We recall that a bounded region is said to be simply connected i i its boundary consists of one connected
set (the boundary continuum) ,md doubly connected if its boundxy consists of two n o n i t m w c t i n z
connected sets. In doubiy c o r n e c t e d regions, one of the two continua is an exterior boundary continuum.
and the other is an interior botmdarv continuum. The interior boundary continuum, in particular, may
comprise a single point.
I75
Ch. V11. CELLS OF STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTEMS. ADDITIONS TO THEORY
176
:I?. CELLS OF S ITRL'CTCMLLY STABLE SYSTEhlS
To structurally unstable systenu, this theorem in general is inapplicable. For example, in a cell
-
filled with loops, all the path$ go to the same equilibrium state for t -+ m and t -+ f m , i.e., the
source of this cell coincides with its sink.
* * The condition stated in this definition could be replaced by a requirement of the existence of a mapping
T with the relevant properties moving the cell Z, into ZI (Le., without considering the c e l l closures).
Alternatively. we could omit the requirement that T should be an orientation-consentine mapping or
conserve the direction of m o t i m in I along the paths. The choice of the particular criterion assigning
two cells to the same type is largely arbitrary. Sometimes, the actual choice depends on the problem
k i n g considered.
I77
It i s readily s e e n th2.t all the four c e l l s shown in F i g u r e 67 belong to
different types. On the o t h e r hand, e a c h c e l l in F i g u r e 68 is of the s a m e
type a s the corresponding cell i n F i g u r e 67." T h e r e i s
t h e r e f o r e a total of four types of c e l l s bounded by two
limit c y c l e s .
111. D o u b l y c o n n e c t e d c e l l s f i l l e d w i t h
s e m i p a t h s o r a r c s o f p a t h s . The boundaryof
w
a cell filled with s e m i p a t h s or a r c s of paths evidently
should c o m p r i s e l i m i t a r c s or c y c l e s without contact
{see S19.1). By proposition X in 19.1, the boundary of
a doubly connected c e l l cannot c o m p r i s e singular a r c s ,
and i: t h e r e f o r e i n c o r p o r a t e s at least one s i n g u l a r cycle
without contact. Hence it follows d i r e c t l y that the
boundary of a doubly connected c e l l filled with s e m i p a t h s
c o n s i s t s of a s i n g u l a r cycle without contact and a s o u r c e
or a sink (a l i m i t c y c l e , a node, or a focus). F r o m these considerations,
one c a n r e a d i l y find the different types of t h e s e c e l l s , and this a s s i g n m e n t
is left to the r e a d e r a s an e x e r c i s e . Doubly connected c e l l s filled with
a r c s of paths are bounded by two s i n g u l a r c y c l e s , one inside the o t h e r .
Only one type of such c e l l s is possible ( F i g u r e 69).
3 . I n t e r i o r cells of s t r u c t u r a l l y s t a b l e s y s t e m s .
Simply connected i n t e r i o r cells
The mapping T mavins cell a in Figure 67 into cell a in Figure 68, while conserving the orientation. the
paths and the sense of motion, clearly maps the exterior limit cycle of the cell into the interior limit
c i c l e , and vice v e n a . This, however, does not contradict Definition 22.
179
Ch. VII. CELLS OF STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTEMS. ADDITIONS T O THEORY
180
fl?. (;ELLS OF STRLCTUR.ALLY STABLE S Y S T E h l S
FIGURE 79 FIGURE 71
181
182
Since -%I; and J1.i are two different points, b is a s i m p l e a r c . Let Ct, be a
cycle without contact c o m p r i s i n g the arc b. Cb belongs to the sink to which
the s e p a r a t r i c e s L; and L; go for t + 7 0 0 .
H e r e again w e shou;d consider two a l t e r n a t i v e s :
-461) The c y c l e s without contact C, and C b do not enclose one another.
X l 2 ) The cycle C,: l i e s inside the cycle Cb.
Consider case -411 f i r s t .
A l l ) T h e c y c l e s w i t h o u t c o n t a c t C, a n d C b d o n o t e n c l o s e
o n e a n o t h e r . Let y be a s i m p l e closed cur1.e consisting of the a r c s a
and b, the s e g m e n t s .%f2g2and M , O , of the s e p a r a t r i c e s L? and L , .
respectively, the s e g m e n t s 02M; and O J I ; of the s e p a r a t r i c e s L; and L ; , and
the equilibrium s t a t e s 17,and 02. Let A be the s i m p l y connected region
bounded by the c u r v e y T h e points of t h e c u r v e p which a r e the i n t e r i o r points
of the a r c s a and b belong to the c e l l 2, and a l l the o t h e r points of y a r e
boundary points of 2. All the paths of the cell cross the arc u and e m e r g e
froni the cycle C, with i n c r e a s i n g t . r h e s e paths should e i t h e r e n t e r the
region 3 or leave i t . M'e w i l l show that they n e c e s s a r i l y e n t e r this region.
183
Ch. VII. CELLS OF STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTEMS. ADD1 IYONS TO IHEOKY
Indeed, let the paths of the c e l l 2 which c r o s s the a r c a leave the region
A as t increases (Figure 73). Then t h e r e a r e points of the cell 2 which lie
outside the c u r v e y , and t h e r e f o r e a l s o boundary points of Z with this
p r o p e r t y . Let E be the s e t of these boundary points (which l i e outside y ) .
The s e t E c o n s i s t s of the points of singular paths. It is readily s e e n that
the regions enclosed by the l i m i t c y c l e s C, and Cb lie inside the c u r v e .
T h e r e f o r e , the s e p a r a t r i c e s L t , L;, Lz, and L; have no points which lie
outside y , i.e., E is the s e t of points of singular paths, other than the
s e p a r a t r i c e s L,, L;, L z , L;and c l e a r l y o t h e r than the equilibrium states Oiand
0 2 . But a l l the points which a r e sufficiently c l o s e to the curve y f r o m the
outside belong to nonsingular paths. The s e t E is t h e r e f o r e a t a positive
distance outside the c u r v e y . This m e a n s that E does not i n t e r s e c t with
the boundary continuum which contains the s e p a r a t r i c e s L,, L z , L;, L; and
t h e i r limit points, i . e . , the c e l l 2 h a s a t l e a s t two boundary continua. This
evidently contradicts the assumption that Z is simply connected.
We have thus established that in the c a s e A Lall ~ the paths of the c e l l Z
c r o s s i n g the a r c a leave the cycle C, and e n t e r into the region A as t
i n c r e a s e s ( F i g u r e 72). The cell will be of one of the types shown in F i g u r e 74
according as the s o u r c e o r respectively the sink to which the paths of the
cell go is a n equilibrium s t a t e or a l i m i t cycle, and in the l a t t e r c a s e ,
according as the direction of motion along the l i m i t cycle is positive
(clockwise) o r negative. In c a s e A11 the boundary of the cell 2 evidently
c o n s i s t s of the s e p a r a t r i c e s L , , L;,L z . and L; and their a - and o-limit
FIGURE 75
184
a b C
e i
FIGURE 7 6
8
A ? ) r h e s a d d l e p o i n t 0, c o i n c i d e s w i t h 0 , ( F i g u r e s 7 7 , 7 5 , 8 0 ) .
In this c a s e , the s e p a r a t r i x L ; , which is an w-continuation of the s e p a r a t r i x
in the positive direction, is a l s o a n o-continuation of the
s e p a r a t r i x L , in the negative d i r e c t i o n and e n t e r s the
boundary of the c e l l 2 . L e t b be a n a r c without contact
conjugate with the a r c a , and C h a c y c l e without contact
comprising the a r c 6 . f i e s e p a r a t r i x L ; p a s s e s through
the end point -11; of the arc b. I? is r e a d i l y s e e n that p a t h s
c r o s s i n : ? the a r c a p a s s through the points of the c y c l e Cb
sufficiently n e a r ?he point -\I;, on e i t h e r s i d e of this point.
T h e r e f o r e b is a cyclic a r c .
Let ;m be a s i m p l e c l o s e d c u r v e consisting of the
c, segmen1.s J f I O l and .\I@,of t h e s e p a r a t r i c e s L , and L ? ,
respectively, of the a r c a , and the point 0,; l e t 1 be the
FIGL'KE '77 region Enclosed by the c u r v e y . T h e r e a r e two
possibilities:
A z l ) I ' h e p a t h s of t h e c e l l Z c r o s s t h e a r c a
a n d e n t e r i n t o _I a s t i n c r e a s e s ( F i g u r e 77). In t h i s case, the
s e p a r a t r i x Ll', and a l s o the c y c l e without contact C+, lie inside the c y c l e y,
and the sink to which CS 'Delongs l i e s inside Cb. The c y c l e s C, and Cb d o
not e n c l o s e one a n o t h e r . The boundary of the c e l l Z c o n s i s t s of the
s e p a r a t r i c e s L , . L ? . L ; and t h e i r a - and 6)-limit points. The cell Z belongs
to one of the types shown in F i g u r e 78. A s in the p r e v i o u s cases, the
exact type of the c e l l depends on the c h a r a c t e r of the s o u r c e s and s i n k s to
*xhich the p a t h s of the c e l l go and on the d i r e c t i o n of motion along the
s o u r c e (or the sink), aseuming that i t is a l i m i t c y c l e .
A22) T h e p a t h s o f t h e c e l l Z c r o s s t h e a r c a a n d l e a v e
1 a s t i n c r e a s e s ( F i g u r e s 75 and 80). In this case, e i t h e r the c y c l e s
(.,'? and Cb do not enclose one another ( F i g u r e 79) or cycle C, lies inside
('o ( F i g u r e 80).
Ch. VII. CELLS OF STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTEMS. AIIDITIONS T O 'THEORY
g h i
FIGURE 78
FIGURE 79 FIGURE 80
a s e Ail, we
However, reasoning along the s a m e l i n e s a s f o r c-~ -
- can..show
that the c a s e depicted in Figure 79 is inapplicable. 'Thus, cycle c. l i e s
. _ . ..
inside c b . Hence i t follows that the s o u r c e to which Cb belongs is a limit
186
c y c l e L o , and Cb lies inside L o . The boundary of the cell Z c o n s i s t s of the
s e p a r a t r i c e s L l , L 2 . L ; and t h e i r l i m i t points. The cell Z may belong to one
of t h e types shown in F i g u r e 81
a b
C d
e f
FIGURE 81
187
Ch. VII. CELLS OF STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTEMS. ADDlTIONS TO THEORY
a b
C d
e f
FIGURE 84
* In case A**, the source lies inside the sink, and i n case B, the sink lies inside the source.
188
can have no other type; of simply connected i n t e r i o r c e l l s in addition to
those described. It c a n be proved without difficulty that a l l the c e l l types
described do exist, ho,,vever. This can be done, s a y , by constructing a
dynamic s y s t e m corresponding to each cell type in t e r n i s of its vector
field.
Me have established all the different types of doubly connected c e l l s
I,F19.2), and all the types of i n t e r i o r simply connected c e l l s which may
occur in s t r u c t u r a l l y stable s y s t e m s . It r e m a i n s to consider simply
connected cells which are not internal cells, i . e . , c e l l s whose boundaries
have points in common with the boundary of the region. W e w i l l not
analyze these cells, as t h i s c a n be done along the s a m e l i n e s as before.
F i g u r e 85 depicts the different types of simply connected c e l l s of a
s t r u c t u r a l l y stable s y s t e m which touch the boundary of c * f o r the c a s e
when this boundary c o n s i s t s of a single cycle without contact.
FIGURE 85
189
Ch. VII. CELLS OF STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTEMS. ADDITIONS TO THEORY
assuming that
and
Since f o r s y s t e m (1)
xr+ya=RS.
The path
190
S 20. E IALIPLES OF STRL'CTLrRALLY ST.48LE SYSTEhlS
Hence
so that
yo=kxo= i k m
191
Ch. V11. CELLS OF STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTEMS. ADDITIONS TO THEORY
A2 -n;l + A = 0. (15)
u = a + d >0,
D = @ - 4 A >0.
192
A s in the p r e v i o u s example, c i r c l e ( 6 ) of a sufficiently l a r g e r a d i u s R is
a c y c l e without contact and all the p a t h s of o u r s y s t e m e n t e r into it as t
increases.
Consider the s y s t e 71 inside circle 15 J of sufficiently l a r g e r a d i u s . The
l i n e s y = k , and ~ y = k : ~ where
, k , and k 2 are the r o o t s of (11). are made up
of paths of our s y s t e m .
T h e c h a r a c t e r i s t i c roots 2., and 2.? of t h e equilibrium s t a t e 0 (0. 0)a r e
positive and different in v i r t u e of conditions (171, (181, (19j, so that 0 is a n
unstable node. F r o m (131, ( 1 4 j ,
( 1 6 ) and from the fact that both i.,
and i.? are positive we conclude that
e a c h of the s t r a i g h t l i n e s y = k , ~ ,
y : k,r contains, b e s i d e s the point
0, two o t h e r equilibrium states.
Let these equilibrium s t a t e s be
-4,. B: and A ? . B,, r e s p e c t i v e l y
\ F i g u r e 87J. Calculations show
that for the equilibrium s t a t e s -4,
and B, lying on the s t r a i g h t line
y = k,x, the d e t e r m i n a n t 3 =
= 2i., JTD> 0 , and for the equilib-
r i u m s t a t e s A: and LIZ, A =
- -%?
- 1 < 0 . Thus, d, and B,a r e
s i m p l e nodes, and A ? and B, a r e
s i m p l e s a d d l e points. The s y s t e m
h a s no closed p a t h s for the s a m e
FIGrrRE t.7
r e a s o n s a s before, and i t s p h a s e
p o r t r a i t is s y n i a e t r i c a l r e l a t i v e
to the origin 0. The configuration of the p a t h s i s shown in F i g u r e 87. The
d i r e c t i o n of the a r r o w s along the paths and the d i r e c t i o n of the s e p a r a t r i c e s
a r e determined so a s to e n s u r e that all the paths e n t e r into the boundary
c y c l e without contact as t i n c r e a s e s .
By Iheorem 2 3 , the s y s t e m is s t r u c t u r a l l y s t a b l e i n s i d e the circle (5).
T h i s circle c o n s i s t s O F four cells: Z,.Z 2 and the two c e l l s Z;, 2; in
s y n i m e t r i c a l position :elative to the o r i g i n . Zi is a n i n t e r i o r c e l l . It
c o n s i s t s of whole path.; extending f r o m the unstable node 0 to the s t a b l e
node :I,, and belongs t o the s a m e type as cell a in F i g u r e 74. Cell Z? c o n -
s i s t s of semipaths and belongs to the s a m e type a s c e l l Q in F i g u r e 8 5 . The
stability r e g i o n of the node -4, c o m p r i s e s the c e l l s Z, and Z ? , and that of
the node B, the cells Z ; and 2;.
R e m a r k . System (1) m a y be investigated by analogous methods for
any o t h e r combination of the coefficients a, 6 , c, d . See QT, J30,
Example 18.
E x a m p l e 6 . The s y s t e m
193
Ch. VII. CELLS OF STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTEMS. ADDITIONS TO THEORY I
the c i r c l e
xa+y*---l=O (21)
is a path of the s y s t e m ( s e e QT, $30, Example 14). The focus A lies inside
this c i r c l e , and the saddle point B outside the c i r c l e .
W e will now show that the c i r c l e ( 2 1 ) is a s t r u c t u r a l l y stable limit cycle
of s y s t e m (20). To prove this, we have to evaluate the integral
* This investigation analyzes the behavior of the paths of system (20) at infinity and considers the paths of an
auxiliary system
d+
-=2y+sa+ys-i,
dt
*=
dt
--2r,
+ -
which have a general integral (ze ya l)eY = C . The closed paths of the auxiliary system form a
topographic system of curves for system (20).
I94
f 21. DEFI?.ITLCh' OF STRIICWIUL STABILITY WITHOL'T E -1DEKTTITY
W e should specify in Definitions I and I1 in relation t o what space, RC) or R,;', the structural stability is
being considered. However, by virtue of remark d in 918.4, this is immaterial for Definition I. W e will
i c e in what foilows that it i s immaterial for Definition II. either.
195
Ch. V11. CELLS OF STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTEMS. ADDITIONS TO THEORY
Similar propositions for structurally stable systems in the sense of Definition I were advanced in 918.4.c,
Theorems 25 and 26. Their proof, however, far from following directly from Definition I, conversely
requires a preliminary derivation of the conditions of structural stability.
196
c i r c l e . I 4 e choose E > 0 to be so s m a l l that f o r any two s y s t e m s of the
f o r m \ l ) , the v e c t o r s of the corresponding fields do not point in opposite
d i r e c t i o n s at any point of the c i r c l e C. Then by QT, S10.2, L e m m a 2,
the rotations of the v e c t o r fields of all t h e s e s y s t e m s on the c i r c l e C' a r e
equal to one a n o t h e r . Since C e n c l o s e s a single equilibrium s t a t e 0 of (A),
and hence of any s y s t e m ( I ) , the P o i n c a r e index of the equilibrium s t a t e o i s
constant for all the s y s t e m s (1).
On the o t h e r hand, i t follows f r o m equations (1) that
d5.
dr =P ( X , y) $. E? (I,y) = P*, 2- = Q (5,y) 4- E'P (I,y) = Q*, A"' )
197
Ch. VII. CELLS OF STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTEMS. ADDITIONS TO THEORY
198
In view of the above, e v e r y neighborhood U i j thus neturally c o r r e s p o n d s
to a single s e p a r a t r i x of any s y s t e m (Ai), O.<b < i , namely the s e p a r a t r i x
L::! L V e will refer to tl-,is s e p a r a t r i x a s t h e s e p a r a t r i x c o r r e -
s p o n d i n g t o t h e n e i g h b o r h o o d Uij.
Let now s y s t e m ( A ) have a saddle-to-saddle s e p a r a t r i x y . To fix
ideas, l e t y extend f r o m saddle point 0,to O?. The case of a s e p a r a t r i x
extending f r o m s o m e saddle point to the s a m e saddle point, i.e., forming
a loop, is treated analogously.
Let Tt be a homomorphism of G- into itself, which moves the paths of ( A )
into the paths of (A,) (this homomorphism e x i s t s , s i n c e ( A ) is a s t r u c t u r a l l y
stable s y s t e m and ( A , ) is a feasible system; see Definition n). Evidently,
T , ( y ) i s a s e p a r a t r i x e x k n d i n g f r o m the saddle point T I (0,)to the saddle
point T k (/I2). Being a s e p a r a t r i x of two saddle points, i t c l e a r l y c o r r e -
sponds to two (different) neighborhoods U i i .
T h e r e are uncountably many s e p a r a t r i c e s T k (7) (since 1. E I ) , w h e r e a s
the p a i r s of neighborhoods U i i f o r m a countable set. Consequently, t h e r e
e x i s t s a n u n c o u n t a b 1 e s e t I* c I of the values of A and a l s o two
neighborhoods U i j , e.g., the neighborhoods ci33 and U16of the saddle points
O3 and Oh. such that i f 2. E I * , the s e p a r a t r i x T I ( y ) extends f r o m saddle point
O 3 to saddle point 0, and c o r r e s p o n d s t o the neighborhoods CIJ3 and U6,.
Since I* is a n uncountable s e t of points of the segment I = [O, 11, P c a n -
<
<
not consist entirely of isolated points. Hence t h e r e e x i s t s a t l e a s t one
E, E I * and a sequence of X i . i = 1, 2. 3, . . . *
such that rZi E I* and lim X i = A,. Without
t*.m
l o s s of generality, we m a y take l i to be
&- :WYJ&L4
a monotonically d e c r e a s i n g sequence.
The s e p a r a t r i x T b (y)> and l i k e w i s e
the s e p a r a t r i c e s T A i (y), extend f r o m
saddle point O3 to saddle point O6 and
correspond to the neighborhoods U J 3and
FIGURE 30 U44(Figure 90). Let 'c' be a neighborhood
of the s e p a r a t r i x T b (y). F r o m 89.2,
r e m a r k to L e m m a 3, and f r o m 8 4 . 2 , L e m m a 7 i t follows that f o r all
sufficiently l a r g e n, T I , ty) c V . But the vector field of (Aio) is obtained f r o m
the vector field of (A) by rotation through a positive angle. In o u r proof
of Theorem 16 (511.2) w e established that if t h e r e e x i s t s a saddle-to-
saddle s e p a r a t r i x of s y s t e m ( A ) and a sufficiently s m a l l neighborhood of the
s e p a r a t r i x , the s y s t e m generated f r o m ( A ) by a rotation of the vector field
through a sufficiently sniall angle cannot have a saddle -to-saddle s e p a r a t r i x
in that neighborhood.:'. We have thus reached a cor*tradiction, which
p r o v e s the l e m m a .
R e m a r k . The pr0c.f of the l a s t l e m m a actually shows that i f a dynamic
s y s t e m ( A ) with a finite number of simple saddle points h a s saddle-to-
saddle s e p a r a t r i c e s , the s y s t e m obtained by rotating the v e c t o r field of (A)
through a sufficiently s m a l l angle no longer h a s any such s e p a r a t r i c e s .
In our proof of Theorem 16 w e did not consider systems (Ai), but systems of the form
-
To move from ( A ) to ( A ) , w e t a v e to rotate the vector field through an angle a. tan a = b, and
v m .
stretch the field vectors by a factor
199
Ch. VII. CELLS OF STRUCTURALLY STABLE SYSTEMS. ADDITIONS TO THEORY
200
4 "1. L>EFI?;I rlCtI OF STKCiCTC'RAL STAGILITY WlTtiOUT e - IDEXTITY
20 1
C h a p t e r VIIl
BIFURCATIONS O F DYNAMIC S Y S T E M S .
DECOMPOSITION OF A M U L T I P L E
EQUILIBRIUM S T A T E I N T O S T R U C T U R A L L Y
S T A B L E EQUILIBRIUM S T A T E S
INTRODUCTION
202
topological node, a topological saddle point, a focus o r a c e n t e r , a n
euuilibriutu s t a t e with an elliptical region, a degenerate equilibrium s t a t e ,
a saddle-node. In 523, a relationship is established between the
topological s t r u c t u r e of a multiple equilibrium s t a t e , on the one hand, and
the n u m b e r and c h a r a c t e r of the s t r u c t u r a l l y s t a b l e equilibrium states into
which the multiple s t a t ? decomposes when p a s s i n g to c l o s e s y s t e m s , on
the o t h e r . For example, i f u : P ; (0,0) - (I (0.
,; 0)F 0 and the multiple
ecluilibriuni s t a t e 0 is a topological saddle point, it may only decompose
into a n odd number of s t r u c t u r a l l y stable nodes and saddle points, the
number of s t r u c t u r a l l y stable nodes being of necessity one l e s s than the
number of s t r u c t u r a l l y stable saddle points. The o t h e r r e s u l t s of the
c h a p t e r a r e contained in T h e o r e m s 35, 37 through 39. Note, however,
that f o r o = 0 , the type of the multiple sinqular point is e n t i r e l y determined
by the number of s t r u c : u r a l l y stable equilibrium states into which it
decomposes and by the;r topological s t r u c t u r e . tf, on the o t h e r hand, 0 -= 0 ,
the difference (other than topological) between nodes and foci h a s to be
taken into consideration in s o m e c a s e s , and i n other cases it is altogether
impossible to e s t a b l i s h the c h a r a c t e r of the multiple equilibrium s t a t e
using the component s t r u c t u r a l l y s t a b l e equilibrium states.
A r e a d e r wishing to speed up h i s p r o g r e s s through the book may omit
the proof of T h e o r e m s 37- 35, and f a m i l i a r i z e himself with the s t a t e m e n t
of the t h e o r e m s only.
in conclusion note that $23.3 contains a t h e o r e m by PoincarC
( rheorem 36) wttich stztes that i f a dynamic s y s t e m h a s only s i m p l e
equilibrium s t a t e s and the isocline P ( 5 , y) = 0 ( o r Q (z, y) = 0 )h a s no singular
points (i.e., points a t which P ; = P!, = 0 ) , then saddle points a l t e r n a t e with
nodes and foci along th1.s isocline. T h i s t h e o r e m i s used in the proof of
r h e o r e m 3 8 , but it is a l s o of considerable independent i n t e r e s t .
* 7h< simplert 3nd most complet? picture is obtair,ed for + n a m l c systems on a sphere. where the dcfinition
of rtructural rtabillty is marked.y simpler. W e again wish to emphasize that the restriction imposed on the
relevant reeion is solely intendcd to simplif? the presentation. The concepts of bifurcition and degree of
structural instability can b e defined analoyously for dynamic systcms i n any bounded plane region.
203
ch.VIII. BIFURCATIONS OF DYNAMIC S Y S T E M S
rhus, let
dz dy
= P (2,Y), = Q (G Y) (A)
See 55.1. is the space of dynamic systems of class N with a metric defined b y the distance ( i n G ) of
the functions P and Q and their derivatives to r-th order inclusive. Rr)is the space of analytical functions
with the same metric.
I
204
the f o r m
205
Ch.VIII. BIFURCATIONS OF DYNAMIC SYSTEMS
r e d u c e s to the following: i n v e s t i g a t e t h e c h a n g e s i n t h e
t o p o l o g i c a l s t r u c t u r e of a s t r u c t u r a l l y u n s t a b l e s y s t e m
on p a s s i n g to s u f f i c i e n t l y c l o s e s y s t e m s .
The next topic to consider is the classification of s t r u c t u r a l l y unstable
s y s t e m s . A s t r u c t u r a l l y unstable s y s t e m may be "more s t r u c t u r a l l y
unstable" or "less s t r u c t u r a l l y unstable.'' r h e s e i m p r e c i s e t e r m s c a n be
imbued with p r e c i s e mathematical meaning by introducing the concept
of t h e d e g r e e o f s t r u c t u r a l i n s t a b i l i t y of a s y s t e m . Originally
this concept was introduced in /S/. For the s a k e of simplicity, w e will-
only give a definition of the degree of s t r u c t u r a l instability in a region W
bounded by a cycle without contact. I'he corresponding definition f o r a
general bounded region will be given a t a l a t e r stage (S31, Definition 30).
W e shall a s s u m e that the relevant s y s t e m s are e i t h e r analytical in G o r
of c l a s s N , where N is a natural number whose magnitude, as w i l l be s e e n
f r o m the definition, depends on the degree of s t r u c t u r a l instability of the
system. is a subregion of G bounded by a cycle without contact.
Structurally stable s y s t e m s in w w i l l be called s y s t e m s o f z e r o
d e g r e e o f s t r u c t u r a l i n s t a b i l i t y . A s we know (18.4,a),
s y s t e m ( A ) is s t r u c t u r a l l y stable in it if h a s the following property: for
any e > 0, t h e r e e x i s t s 6 > 0 such that if (A) is I - c l o s e t o ( A ) , then
, e -
(W,A ) =(W, A ) .
W e will define the d e g r e e s of s t r u c t u r a l instability by induction.
D e f i n i t i o n 23. A dynamic system (A) of class N , 3 is said to be a
system of 1st degree of structural instability (or to have a degree of
structural instability 1 ) in @ i f it is not structurally stable in this region
and satisfies the following conditim for any e > 0, there exists 6 > 0 such
that for any structurally unstable system (A) 6-close to (A)to rank 3 we
have - - e -
(W, A ) (W, A ) .
206
Chapter I. Indeed, in defining the multiplicity of a root of a function, s a y
( 9 1 . 3 , Definition 21, w e could speak of a root of multiplicity r of a function
F @)only i f F (z) w a s a function of c l a s s . V > r . A somewhat puzzling point
in o u r definition of d e g r e e s of s t r u c t u r a l instability is the fact that only
s y s t e m s of c l a s s S > 2 k + 1 c a n be of a k-th d e g r e e of s t r u c t u r a l instability.
\\'e will not d i s c u s s h e r e the f a c t o r s r e s p o n s i b l e f o r this r e s t r i c t i o n . Note,
however, that t h i s f a c t is r e l a t e d to the p r o p e r t i e s of a multiple f o c u s d i s -
c u s s e d i n Chapter IX ($25.1, T h e o r e m 40).
A siqnificant shortconiing of Definition 2 3 is that i t d o e s not a s s i g n a
definite d e g r e e of struc:tural instability to e a c h and e v e r y dynamic s y s t e m .
For s y s t e m s of a finite class this is obvious. Indeed, let ?; = 3k L 1. k > I .
\[e c a n e a s i l y c o n s t r u c t a s y s t e m ( A Jof class -V, which is not a s y s t e m of
+
class .V + 1, with k 1 equilibrium s t a t e s , e a c h of niultiplicity 2, i n s o m e
r e g i o n E. It follows f r o m Definition 23 and f r o m the definition of the
multiplicity of a n equilibrium s t a t e (S7.3)that this ( A ) cannot have a d e g r e e
of s t r u c t u r a l instability less than o r equal to k. On the o t h e r hand,
Definition 2 3 s t a t e s that ( A ) cannot have a d e g r e e of s t r u c t u r a l instability
g r e a t e r than k. The s y s t e m ( A ) that w e have c o n s t r u c t e d thus d o e s not have
a definite d e g r e e of s t r u c t u r a l instability.
Let u s now c o n s i d e r the analytical case. It is r e a d i l y s e e n that
analytical s y s t e m s of any finite d e g r e e of s t r u c t u r a l instability e x i s t .
F u r t h e r m o r e , t h e r e e x i s t analytical s y s t e m s with o t h e r analytical s y s t e m s
of a l l finite d e g r e e s of instability contained in any of t h e i r neighborhoods.
r h e s e s y s t e m s a r e naturally a s s i g n e d a n infinite d e g r e e of s t r u c t u r a l
instability. However, it d o e s not follow f r o m Definition 2 3 that e a c h
analytical s y s t e m may have a definite finite o r infinite d e g r e e of s t r u c t u r a l
instability .*.
S y s t e m s of the 1 s t d e g r e e of s t r u c t u r a l instability a r e r e 1a t i v e l y
s t r u c t u r a l l y s t a b l e i n the set of all s t r u c t u r a l l y unstable s y s t e m s . ..'.
Similarly, s y s t e m s of k-th d e g r e e of s t r u c t u r a l instability a r e relatively
s t r u c t u r a l l y s t a b l e i n the s e t of all s t r u c t u r a l l y unstable s y s t e m s of d e g r e e
of s t r u c t u r a l instability > k.
b'e have s e e n before that dynamic s y s t e m s a s s o c i a t e d , w i t h physical
p r o b l e m s g e n e r a l l y contain one o r several p a r a m e t e r s . T h e r e f o r e ,
s y s t e m s dependent on p a r a m e t e r s a r e of p a r t i c u l a r i n t e r e s t . Let, for
simplicity, the right-hand s i d e s contain a single p a r a m e t e r , i . e . , H e a r e
considering a s y s t e m of the f o r m
do
-dt= FJ(1.Y, ).). $=Q((., Y, 1.). (A I )
The p a r a m e t e r 1. m a y v a r y o v e r a c e r t a i n s e t of r e a l n u m b e r s o r r u n
?hisough the e n t i r e real a x i s .
If w e a r e i n t e r e s t e d only in s y s t e m s which are obtained f o r v a r i o u s
v a l u e s of the paramete:- 1, w e should specifically c o n s i d e r the concept of
s t r u c t u r a l stability and d e g r e e s of s t r u c t u r a l instability i n r e l a t i o n to
s y s t e m s (A),). _The following definition of s t r u c t u r a l stability c a n be given
(for a r e g i o n W bounded by a c y c l e without contact): s y s t e m (A %) is
s t r u c t u r a l l y s t a b l e in T? r e l a t i v e to s y s t e m s (A ,,) i f t h e r e e x i s t s 6 > 0 such
207
Ch. VIII. BIFURCATIONS OF DYNAMIC SYSTEMS
208
obtained f r o m (A,! by r e v e r s i n g the direction of the field v e c t o r s a t e v e r y
point of the plane, w e need only consider the s y s t e m {A,) for O g a < x .
F r o m the relations
P(-t, -y.a);=--P(z, y,a), Q(-z, -y,a)=-Q(x, y,a)
- -
w(i,Y, Y, a) = - 4 ( t 2 + y t ) C O S a ,
a) + @(i,
dr UY
dP
w e see that f o r a # % , Cl,ta<n, t h e s u m x + $ d o e s not r e v e r s e i t s sign
a n y x h e r e in the plane. Therefore, by the Bendixson c r i t e r i o n (QT, 12.3),
s y s t e m ( A , ) with a#% h a s neither closed paths (in p a r t i c u l a r , limit
c y c l e s ) nor closed c u r v e s consisting of paths in the phase plane.
Let t = z ( t ) . y = y ( t ) b e paths of ( A a ) . Then, a s i t follows from the
s y s t e m equations,
+ y ( t )y ( t )=Ti
z ( t )z ( t )
* d
+y (t)'] =t z c o s a + 2zy sina--y2
[t( t ) 2 cos a - ( S f y2)* cos a.
FIGURE #9'i
209
Ch.VIII. BIFURCATIONS OF DYNAM[C SYSTEMS
a2
Moreover, on the x axis, ; i l = ( x - x 3 ) ~ ~ ~ a ,s o that $=tan a . The direction
of the s e p a r a t r i c e s of the saddle point 0 is determined f r o m the equation
543 8 210
P 29. DEGREE OF STRL'CTCR..\L ISST;\BILITY AKD BIFLHCAT[ONS
FIGLIRE 94 FIGLIRE 35
21 1
Ch. VIII. BIFURCATIONS OF DYNAMIC SYSTEMS
I
I
If in the determination of the topological s t r u c t u r e w e c o n s i d e r not only
the configuration of the paths but a l s o the direction of motion along the
paths, bifurcation o c c u r s when the p a r a m e t e r p a s s e s through the value
-$, say, since the s t a b l e foci Aand Bchange into u n s t a b l e foci, I
i.e., the topological s t r u c t u r e changes. Note, hoflever, that if the d i r e c -
tions along the paths a r e ignored, the t r a n s i t i o n of the p a r a m e t e r through
the bifurcation value does not lead to a bifurcation in our example.
F i g u r e s 92 through 9 5 enable u s to t r a c e the changes in the configuration
of the paths of (Ao) during the rotation of the v e c t o r field. Originally, the
points A and B a r e nodes, and the s e p a r a t r i c e s of the saddle point O a r e the
coordinate s e m i a x e s . A s the v e c t o r field is r o t a t e d in the positive d i r e c -
tion, the nodes change into foci, the paths wind onto the foci i n the clock-
wise s e n s e , and the tangents to the s e p a r a t r i c e s a t the point 0 a l s o r o t a t e
in the positive direction with half the rotation velocity of the field v e c t o r s . *
For a = ,: all the paths a r e closed, except the foci (which a r e now
c e n t e r s ) and the saddle point 0 with i t s s e p a r a t r i c e s . The s e p a r a t r i c e s
join in p a i r s forming loops. A s the field is f u r t h e r r o t a t e d , the c e n t e r s
again become foci, but the paths unwind in this c a s e . r h e s e p a r a t r i c e s
of the saddle point 0 s e p a r a t e , the a - s e p a r a t r i c e s extending to infinity for
I+ f 00 and the w - s e p a r a t r i c e s going to the foci for t - c - 00. The change
of configuration with f u r t h e r rotation of the field is obvious.
Let u s consider s t i l l another example which i l l u s t r a t e s the v a r i a t i o n
of the topological s t r u c t u r e a s a r e s u l t of field rotation.
E x a m p l e 8. Consider the s y s t e m
2
dt
= --tsin a--y cos a + (sa+ya- 1)s (5 cos a- y sin a),
(E,)
3
df
=s c o s a - y sin a + (9+ g ~ - 1)s (=sin a + y casa).
I
* - I
0
] cos a +sin a cos'a-sin a-A =
h a s the roots
T h e r e f o r e f o r a b e t w e e n t h e l i m i t s -$<a<-$-,
., the equilibrium s t a t e O ( 0 , O )
of (B,) is
a n unstable focus f o r -?<a<
2
--+ and f o r
't --~-==z<~;
4 4
a n unstable dicritical node f o r a = -5-
6'
a multiple focus or c e n t e r f o r a=:;
a s t a b l e focus f o r nlh<a<+.,
f i e paths s = s ( t ) , y=y(t)of (B,) are tangent to the c i r c l e
ga jy* = Ra
Nhen
. .
=;yy= -W+!P), (7)
ifa=?.
2
Finally note that, in polar coordinates, (B,) c a n be written in the form
9
dt -
p [(ps- cos a -sin a], (8 I
-= 2 (p* - i)asin a +cos a. (91
213
Ch.VIII. BIFURCATlONS OF DYNAMIC SYSTEMS
52 ty2 = 2. (12)
The equilibrium s t a t e 0 (0, 0) is a multiple ( s t r u c t u r a l l y unstable) s t a b l e
focus. The motion along the s p i r a l s with i n c r e a s i n g t is in the c o u n t e r -
clockwise s e n s e ( F i g u r e 98).
214
which is a c i r c l e of r a d i u s g r e a t e r than 1, and a s t a b l e l i m i t cycle
$+lJZ=i- I/tan, (14)
s h i c h is a c i r c l e of r a d i u s s m a l l e r than 1. The equilibrium s t a t e O(0,O) is
a n unstable focus. T h o motion along the s p i r a l is i n the counter,clockwise
sense (Figure 59).
5 ) '1 = 0 . T h e s y s t e m h a s one s e m i s t a b l e , and t h e r e f o r e multiple ( s e e
$12.3), l i m i t cycle, the c i r c l e
22 +-y* = 1, (15)
and a n unstable focus 0 (0. 0). The motion along the paths is i n the c o u n t e r -
clockwise direction ( F i z u r e 100).
and
the motion along the paths is counterclockwise, and outside this circle the
motion is clockwise (Fig-ire 101). T h e c i r c l e (16) is evidently orthogonal
to e a c h c r o s s i n g path.
215
Ch.VlII. BIEVRCATIONS OF DYNAMIC S Y S T E M S
and
pa=i- /-.
In the r i n g between t h e s e c i r c l e s , dB > 0, and e l s e w h e r e in the plane $ 0.
T h e r e f o r e the motion along the paths with i n c r e a s i n g t is in the c o u n t e r -
clockwise d i r e c t i o n inside the r i n g and in the clockwise direction outside
the c i r c l e ( 1 7 ) and inside the c i r c l e ( 1 8 ) ( F i g u r e 1 0 3 ) .
For a= -%, the s y s t e m h a s the s a m e paths a s f o r a=;, but the
d i r e c t i o n of motion is r e v e r s e d . A s a f u r t h e r diminishes f r o m - $ t o
- pn, we s u c c e s s i v e l y obtain the s a m e configurations a s in F i g u r e s 97
through 103, but with the d i r e c t i o n of the a r r o w s r e v e r s e d . Finally, for
3
a = - T n , w e r e t u r n to the o r i g i n a l s y s t e m (B,,z) ( F i g u r e 96).
The bifurcation values of the p a r a m e t e r a (for :>a> --%) a r e c l e a r l y
n , -,
y n 0, and
4
.;- Our a n a l y s i s and the figures c l e a r l y show how the paths
of the s y s t e m evolve as the p a r a m e t e r a d e c r e a s e s (i.e.> a s the field
v e c t o r s r o t a t e c1ockwise)and what bifurcations the s y s t e m e x p e r i e n c e s .
On passing through the bifurcation value of the p a r a m e t e r $, a n u n s t a b 1e
216 ,
2'1. DEGREE OF STRCCTIIRIL INST 4 6 t L I T Y AXiJ 6IFC'RC.ITIOKS
217
Ch. VIII. RIFIIRCATIONS OF DYNAMIC SYSTLMS
$ 2 3 . DECOMPOSITION OF A MULTIPLE
EQUILIBRIUM STATE INTO STRUCTURALLY
STABLE EQUILIBRIUM STATES
21 8
4 ?. DECOLIPOS[TIOh OF A A!CLTIPL EQVtLtEiUL'hl STATE INTO S TRCCTCP..ALLY STASLE ST.ATES
Z s r (mod2). (3)
P r o o f . Let C be the boundary of the neighborhood U.,(O). By
definition, the Poincard index l i s equal to the rotation W;t (C) of the v e c t o r field
n?tehborhood of the pointOi(ri, vi). If.=(," :l=O, adding sufficiently small increments to u and d
we obtain a close system withA =i; 0, 1.e.. a system whercOi i s a simple equilibrium state. Similarly, a
jtructurally unstable point c a n be convened into a nruccurally stable point by an arbitrarily small change
of the system.
* [he Fosstbtlity of constructing such a systcm of class r is established in Chapter V I (518.3) i n ow proof
to r'heorem 21.
219
Ch.VIII. BIFUXCATIONS OF DYNAMIC SYSTEMS
Izr(mod2).
The Droof is c o m d e t e .
I To fix i d e a s , l e t
of class r (in particular, analytical system) and let at least one of the f i r s t
derivatives of the functions Pand Q , say Q; (0, O), not vanish at the p d n t
0 (0, 0) . Let further I/ = 'p ( x ) be the solution of the equation
for y in some sufficieiitly small neighborhood of o,* ami
atz+&+ ... + a , - d - l + P ( z , y)
where
l'he equation Q (z.y) = 0 has ,I single-valued solution y = cp (z)in a sufficiently small neighborhood of 0
in virtue of condition (8) and the theorem of implicit functions; here, 'p is a function of class r a n d
cp (0)= 0.
*I
If QI
(0, 0)= 0, but Pi (0,0). say, does not vanish, I3 (z)should be replaced by a function (y)
I* =
=Q (q* (y), y), where z = 'p* (y) is the solution of the equation P (I, y) = 0 for r.
22 1
y='p(x), E.,<x<E2.
c
QI.VIII.
rherefore
BIFURCATIONS OF DYNAMIC SYSTEMS
P ( X ~~ ) = A ( f + f(x)){xr~[(5-x*)(x-5~) @-4-zr1+
+a(x-x*) (x-xz) ... (2-5*)}.
If the numbers X i , i = 1 , 2, ..., k , and a a r e sufficiently s m a l l , the function
p ( z , y) in a finite interval is a r b i t r a r i l y close to z e r o with i t s derivatives,
and s y s t e m ( 1 2 ) is therefore a r b i t r a r i l y c l o s e to r a n k r to s y s t e m (A).
Moreover, f o r s m a l l xi, a l l the points 0,lie i n U , (0).
We will now show that the equilibrium s t a t e s Oi (21,cp ( x i ) ) of s y s t e m ( 1 2 )
a r e a l l simple. 'Indeed, f r o m the r e l a t i o n s P"(q ' p ( s ) ) = g ( x ) ,Q ( x , ' p ( x ) ) = O it
follows that , ,
Therefore
I
c
~(0,) =x ( x i , 'P (zi))= -e' (xt) QI(W, 'P ( X I ) ) (i = 1, 2 , ...,k).
But QI # 0 by a s s u p p t i o n , and ~ ( x does
( x l , rp (q)) J not vanish, since ZLis
a simple root of the function 9(x)(see (14)). Hence, h(O1)#0, i.e., the
..
points O1 ( i = i , 2, ., k) a r e simple equilibrium s t a t e s of s y s t e m (12).
If the points OI a r e s t r u c t u r a l l y stable equilibrium s t a t e s , the proof is
completed. If some of these are s t r u c t u r a l l y unstable equilibrium s t a t e s
( i . e . , multiple foci or c e n t e r s ) we can adopt the s a m e technique a s i n
L e m m a 1 and change over to a n a r b i t r a r i l y close analytical s y s t e m which
h a s in U,,(O) p r e c i s e l y k equilibrium s t a t e s , a l l of which a r e s t r u c t u r a l l y
stable and lie in U . ( O ) . This completes the proof of the theorem.
R e m a r k . Theorems 32 and 34 naturally complement one another
and completely determine the number of equilibrium s t a t e s of a
sufficiently c l o s e system which may lie i n U, (0)if they a r e a l l s t r u c t u r a l l y
stable. Theorem 32, however, h a s been proved f o r a general c a s e ,
w h e r e a s in m e o r e m 34 we a s s u m e d condition ( 8 ) (or (7)). It is therefore
interesting to t r y to establish whether or not Theorem 34 is applicable to
the g e n e r a l c a s e , i.e., when condition (7) is not satisfied.
222
13. DECOkIPOS[TION OF A hlULTIPLE EQLitLtBRIUhl STATE th CO JTRVCTVR.%LLY ST.4BLE iTATES
223
Ch.VII1. RIWRCATIONS OF DYNAMIC SYSTEMS
In t h i s c a s e , s y s t e m ( A ) c a n be t r a n s f o r m e d by a non-singular l i n e a r
transformation to the f o r m
dz
Y),
-;ii-=~+&.(~ $=QS@. Y). (23)
3
dt =q* g=qz(E*q)
by the transformation
E=x, q=y+Pz(z, Y
)7
224
Since O ( 0 , 0) is by assumption a n isolated equilibrium s t a t e of
s y s t e m ( 2 4 ) , t h i s s y s t e m c a n be w r i t t e n in the f o r m
FIGURE 110
225
Ch. VIII. BIFURCATIONS OF DYNAMIC SYSTEMS
( s e e QT, ..
- . Amendix, l o ) .
In our c a s e , as we s e e f r o m (16), u = 1 and A = 0 . Let (A)be a dynamic
s y s t e m 8,-close to (A) to the r e q u i r e d rank, and 01, Op, . . ., 01,the equili-
brium s t a t e s of this s y s t e m lying in U,,(O),all of which a r e s t r u c t u r a l l y
stable. If the n u m b e r s 6, and e, a r e sufficiently s m a l l , the number q = u(O1)
.
i s c l o s e to 1 f o r e a c h of the equilibrium s t a t e s O i , i = I , 2, . ., k , and
Ai = A (Oi) is close to z e r o . Then, i f A (01)> 0, O iis a s t r u c t u r a l l y s t a b l e
-=
node, and i f A i (Oi) 0, Oiis a s t r u c t u r a l l y s t a b l e saddle point. Thus, in
o u r c a s e , all the s t r u c t u r a l l y s t a b l e equilibrium s t a t e s into which a
multiple equilibrium s t a t e 0 decomposes a r e s t r u c t u r a l l y s t a b l e nodes and
saddle points.
By Theorem 3 3 and r e l a t i o n s ( 2 0 ) and (211, the multiplicity of the
equilibrium state 0 (0, 0) of s y s t e m ( 1 6 ) is m . Evaluating the Poincard index
I = I A(0)of the point 0 f r o m (26), we obtain the following r e s u l t s :
1 ) If 0 is a topological node, I = 1 ( E = H = 0).
2 ) If 0 is a topological saddle point, I = - 1 ( E = 0, H = 4 ) .
3 ) If 0 is a saddle-node, I = 0 ( E = 0, H = 2).*'
On the o t h e r hand, we know ( s e e the proqf of Theorem 31) that
* Note that the Poincar6 index of the equilibrium state 0 (0,0 ) o f system (16)can be readily computed
without using Bendixson's formula (26). T o this end, we should count the number o f times the field vector
of the dynamic system crosses the direction of the y axis while moving along a circle of small radius
centered at 0. See Kranosel'skii et a l . /19/, 67.
226
I 03. DECOXIPOSITIOti OF A ,\IC'LTIPLE EQL'[LIBRIb,\l ST.4TE IKTO STRL'CTC'RALLY ST.4BLE STATES
and may be eqtml to any number satisfying these conditions. Each of the
points Oi ( i = i , 2, . . .,k ) is either a structurally stable node or a structurally
stable saddle point. Moreover,
1) i f 0 is a topological node, k is odd and the number of structurally
stable nodes among the points O i , 0 2 , . . ., okis 1 more than the number of
structurally stable saddle points;
2) i f 0 is a topological saddle point, k i s odd and the number of
structurally stable nodes among the points oi, 02, . . ., oh is 1 less than the
number of structurally stable saddle points;
3) if 0 i s a saddle-node, k i s even ami the number of structurally
stable nodes among the ,boints Oi,02.. . ., Or i s equal to the number of
structurally stable saddle points.
R e m a r k . Theorem 35 fully d e t e r m i n e s the types of the s t r u c t u r a l l y
stable equilibrium state!; which a r e obtained f r o m a multiple equilibrium
s t a t e 0 (0, 0) in the case IJ = P; (0, 0) +
QI (0, 0) + 0 . It follows f r o m t h i s
theorem, in particular, that the topological s t r u c t u r e of the equilibrium
s t a t e 0 in this case is uniquely determined by i t s Poincarg index, which is
equal to the difference between the number of s t r u c t u r a l l y stable nodes
and the number of s t r u c t u r a l l y stable saddle points obtained f r o m the
multiple equilibrium s t a t e .
has only simple equilibrium states and if the isocline P (3,y) = o(m
Q (2,y) = 0) has no singular points (Le., points at which both partial
derivatives P; and PI vaxish simultaneously), the equilibrium states with
A < 0, Le., saddle points, altemzate on this isocline with equilibrium
states with 6 > 0, Le., ntnies and foci.
P r o o f . Let O1 (q,y,) and O2(z2,yz) be two simple equilibrium s t a t e s of
( A ) and I a simple a r c of the curve P (2,y) = 0 between these points, which
contains no other equilibrium s t a t e s except the end points. We have to
show that A (0,)and A (02) are of different signs. Suppose that this is not
=-
so and l e t A (01)> 0 and A (0,) 0, say.
This number is defined before Lemma 1
227
Ch. VIII. BIFURCATIONS OF DYNAMIC SYSTEMS
FIGURE 111 I
To fix i d e a s , suppose that the tangent OITl a t the point Oi of the c u r v e I ,
corresponding to i t s direction f r o m Ol to 02,m a k e s a p o s i t i v e angle
with the n o r m a l n (0,). Then the tangent 0 2 T 2at the point O2 of the c u r v e 1 ,
corresponding to the d i r e c t i o n f r o m O2to O,, evidently m a k e s a n e g a t i v e
angle with the n o r m a l n (02).Computing the derivative of the function
Q (5, y) along the c u r v e I in the direction 0102 a t the point O1 (0,)and
10201)
r e m e m b e r i n g that this derivative is equal to the projection of the gradient
of Q (5, y) on the corresponding tangent, we find that this derivative is
negative a t the point0,and positive a t the point 02. This r e s u l t , combined
with the r e l a t i o n s
Q (01)= Q ( 0 2 ) = O
and with the definition of a derivative along a n arc shows that the function
Q ( x , y) is negative on the a r c I n e a r the point Ol and positive on this a r c
n e a r the point 0,. But then Q ( x , y)=O a t s o m e i n t e r i o r point of the a r c 1,
i . e . , this point is a n equilibrium s t a t e of (A), c o n t r a r y to the original
assumption. Q. E . D.
Let u s now consider the equilibrium s t a t e 0 (0, 0) a s s u m i n g that
+
I P; (0, 0) I I P; (0, 0) I tlQ;
(0, 0) I +I Q;(o, 0) I
f0 (7)
228
r h i s m e a n s that the paints 0,may i n general include s t r u c t u r a l l y stable foc
and not only s t r u c t u r a l l y stable saddle points of nodes. Second, the
Poincare' index of the equilibrium s t a t e 0 no longer d e t e r m i n e s the topologi
cal s t r u c t u r e of this equilibrium s t a t e (as i t w a s in the previous c a s e ) .
Indeed, by proposition I1 of the previous subsection, if the multiplicity r of
O i s odd, this point may be
a ) a topological saddle point ( E = 0. H = 4 ) ;
b j a topological node ( E = 0, II = 0);
c ) a n equilibrium s t a t e with a n elliptical region ( E = 1, H = 1);
d ) a focus or a c e n t e r ( E = 0. H = 0).
If the miltiplicity r of 0 is even, the equilibrium s t a t e 0 niay be
e ) a degenerate equilibrium s t a t e ( H = 2 , E = 0 ) ;
f ) a saddle -node (II : 3, E = 0) .
By Bendixson's formula, the Poincard index of the point 0 h a s the
following values:
I - --I in case a;
I = + I in cases b, c , d;
I = u in cases e , f . _ii
229
Ch. VIII. BIFURCATIONS OF DYNAMIC SYSTEMS
e i t h e r b = 0,
or b # 0 and n > m . (29)
W e draw up a polynomial
b ( s )= b x ( z - - z 1 ) ( x - z 2 ) . . . (s-zn-J = b ~ ~ + b , s " - ~.+. +bn-15,
. (31)
whose r o o t s a r e the numbers 0, xl, r2, .... xn-!.
230
5 ?3. DECO!.IPOSLTION OF A AlL'LTIPLE EQUILIBRIUA! STATE INTO S TRVCTL'R.4LLY STABLE STATES
-
By (291, m - I .:n-l. Let y,, &. . . ., x , be any n u m b e r s satisfying the
inequalities
- - -
0 < s1<2,- :
2-2 <x* < .. . <x!n-t <z m - 1 < Z,-l< gm<q. (32)
and
u (0')= g
b (T', 0) b (z*)[f + g (z')].
L (37)
A (O*) [ 1 + h (z')].
= -O' (i) (38)
23 I
I
Ch. VIII. BIFURCATIONS OF DYNAMIC SYSTEMS
where
232
and
1
<eo;
( b / 6 2 s ~ " + ~ 1 ( z ) > 0f o r z - e i and f o r z = - E ~ ;
(47)
(h)!
ba
(c ) I ~ ; z n (2)
) 1< f o r -eI <J <e2.
K'e now choose a number ai. U < A , < d o ,
satisfying the following condition:
i f the function q ( z , y) is & - c l o s e to r a n k 2m--1 to z e r o , then
I
1 ) ?.(-,)>O, i*(E,):'0;
2 ) p<?nn, (Sn)! bz
, (2) <- for --E~<Z--IE~; (481
3 ) all the equilibrium s t a t e s Oi, i = I,?, . . ., 2m, lie in L T e , ( 0 ) .
Condition (48,l)c a n be satisfied i n v i r t u e of (44)and (47,b). Condition
(48,2)holds t r u e f o r a sufficiently s m a l l 6 , in virtue of (46)and the
inequality 2n +
1 .<2m-- 1. Finally, (48, 3) is automatically satisfied f o r a
sufficiently s m a l l ~ 5 ~ .
Let now (A) b e 6,-close to (A) to r a n k 2 m - 1, i.e., the function q ( J , y) is
&-close to z e r o to r a c k 2 m - 1. Consider the function
and f r o m (47,~)
and (48,2) it follows that on this s e g m e n t
I 'p'*"' I <(Zn)!ba.
(I) (51)
' If the function has N root: on some segment (counting their multiplicities), itc derivatire has at least
,J -1 roots. This iollor*.s irom the Eolle theorem and from the fact that e a c h multipie root o fa function
IS a rOat of the derivative of inultiplicity smaller than 1.
233
Ch.VIII. BIFURCATIONS OF DYNAMIC SYSTEMS
FIGURE 112
-_
dX --Y,
dt
%=Q(X, Y).
* Convexity in y indicates that if the end points of a segment parallel to the axis Oy l i e in G , the entire
segment lies in G.
234
f 23. DECOllPOSITION OF .4 :.!LLTIPLE EQUILIBRILhl ST.4TE INTO STRUCTLR.4LLY ST.4BLE ST.4TES
dz (A )
;iT=y. $=O(t, y),
defined in E .
Transformation ( 5 3 ) is 6-close to rank 2m to the identity transformation
.V L t, Y = y ( s e e $3.2). Let E , be a closed region, such that G 13,3 Cco(0).
If 6 is sufficiently s m a l l , w e see by L e m m a 1 , 2.2 that s y s t e m (A) is
defined in F , and is a r b i t r a r i l y c l o s e to s y s t e m (A), and hence to
s y s t e m (A), t o r a n k 2 m, - 1 . To e v e r y equilibrium s t a t e O,,- i =
= 1, 3 , . . .. 2m,of systern ( A ) c o r r e s p o n d s a n equilibrium s t a t e 0, of
s y s t e m (A). Since ( 5 3 ) is a r e g u l a r mapping, 0, are s t r u c t u r a l l y s t a b l e
equilibrium s t a t e s by L e m m a 2, $6.1, and the corresponding p a i r s 0, and
0, are e i t h e r both nodes, or both foci, o r both saddle points. Finally, f o r
a sufficiently s m a l l 6, all the equilibrium s t a t e s 0, Of s y s t e m (A) lie in
Cre, (0) and t h e r e are 30 other equilibrium s t a t e s of (A) in this neighborhood.
But then s y s t e m (A) s a t i s f i e s all the conditions of proposition a (see
p. 2 3 2 ) , i . e., among that points O,, and therefore among O r , t h e r e is a t
l e a s t one s t r u c t u r a l l y stable node. This completes the proof of the
theorem.
In T h e o r e m s 37 and 38 w e considered cases when the P o i n c a r e index of
the original equilibrium s t a t e 0 (0. 0) is -1 o r 0. L e t u s now proceed to the
l a s t c a s e , when the Po-ncark index is f 1. The equilibrium s t a t e 0 (0, 0) of
s y s t e m (A), as w e have noted before (see (28)), is then one of the following:
b ) a topological node;
c ) a n equilibrium s t a t e with a n elliptical region;
d ) a focus or a c e n t e r (see p. 229).
In $23.2 w e s a w that the relevant s y s t e m c a n be reduced to the f o r m (25):
where a < 0, m > 1, h , g , and f are analytical functions, and h (0) = f (0) = 0.
Then (see QT, Theorem 6 6 )
b ) 0 (0. 0) is a topological node if
o r if
235
or if
d ) O ( 0 , 0) is a focus or a c e n t e r if
b=O,
or i f
b g O a n d n>m,
or if
236
5 '23. DECOhIPOSITION OF .A hlL'LTIPLE EQL'ILIBRIL'hl ST.ATE IKTO STRUCTUR.ALLY ST.4BLE STATES
237
C h a p t e r IX
C R E A T I O N OF L I M I T C Y C L E S FROM A
M U L T I P L E FOCUS
IN TRODUCTION
a t the point po = 0.
In J24 we prove that if n e x i s t s such that
238
$24. FOC.-\L VALL'ES
1. S o m e p r o p e r t i e s of the s u c c e s s i o n function
239
Ch.IX. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLES FROM A MULTIPLE F O C U S
w e define the s u c c e s s i o n f u n c t i o n
I Po I < 87 (11)
240
$24. FOC.AL L.AL['ES
P roof . By definition
24 1
riiith the initial covuiitiows
k is an odd izuwibeu.
Proof. By ( 3 ) and (4),p E 0 is a solution of equation ( 4 ) . Therefore
f (0) = d ( 0 ) = 0. (23)
243
ch.IX. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLES FROM A MULTIPLE FOCUS
and
Since we will be dealing with multiple foci only, we take in what follows
a = 0, i . e . , we will c o n s i d e r s y s t e m (1). It follows f r o m the r e s u l t s of
Chapter N (910.1, (9), and 9 1 0 . 2 , (23)) that in this c a s e
* See 5 10.1. For 0 < 0, d (po) > 0 in the stable case and d (po) < 0 in rhe unstable case.
** Logically, this term is not quite adequate, since every multiple focus has a single Lyapunov value. It is
convenient, however, in that it directly identifies the running number of the focal value which is the
Lyapunov value.
244
924. FOC;\L L'ALL'ES
Q* (I,
Y),
Y), I (35)
245
Ch.1X. CREATION OF LlMIT CYCLES FROM A MULTIPLE FOCUS
4- I5+]p=0
~ R ( P e)
)> and R * ( p , 8 ) is a continuous function of p and 8 which
vanishes a t p = 0.
Inserting the functions and $ f r o m (35) in (37), we obtain
k
where
P, ==P , (cos 8, sin e), Qm= Qm (cos e, sin e),
P% = P& (p cos 8, p sin e), Qz = Q& (p cos 8, p sin 8).
(39)
W e write u, (cos 8, sin e) and u, (cos 8 , sin O), respectively, f o r the factor
a f t e r pm in the n u m e r a t o r and the factor a f t e r pm-' in the denominator.
Moreover, by (36),
+-
P* (p cos 0, p sin e) cos 0 Q" (p cos 8, p sin 0) sin e = phu* (p, cos 0, s i n e),
Q*(p cos 8, p sin 8 ) cos 8--P* (p cos 0, p sin 0) sin 8 = p*u* (p. cos e, sin e), (40)
where U* (p, cos 0 , sin e) and u* (p, cos 0 , sin e ) are continuous functions of p and
e which vanish a t p = 0.
F r o m ( 3 8 ) through ( 4 0 ) we find
246
934. FOC.AL \'ALCES
I
U Z z= pR,,
~3 e fiR, f v ~ R ? .
l l k = p ~ ~ h - V : R ~ - 1 i . . . -kt'a-1R2.
I t now follows that
where
-
-R~nt-t iR .
~ m - z + .. - i - R m - ~ v ~
(44)
B
Evidently, iV,,4 is e x F r e s s i b l e in t e r m s of the functions u i ( c o s 8 . sine) and
with the indices i not exceeding n2-I.
J . , ( c o s ~s. i n e )
inserting f o r u , and u i in (43)and (44)t h e i r e x p r e s s i o n s in t e r m s of Pt and
f j , , we obtain
HZ (e) = RZ (e).
( b ) F r o m (31) i t follcws that, fQr m = 3 , 4 , . .., S ,
247
Ch.IX. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLES FROM A MULTIPLE FOCUS I
( e ) F r o m (45) and (d) it follows that
where the functions and $I are expressed by equations ( 3 5 ) and (361, with k
equal to one of the numbers 2 , 3, . . . ,N. Then the focaZ value dim) (0), m =
d,m' (o) = m!
2n
P, (cos 8 , sin 8 ) cos 8 + Q , (cos 0, sin 0) sin 8
2%
Evidently,
3L>LlI (U)=('s?-f)!h.2;(.
B
T h i s completes the proof of the l e m m a .
4. The c a s e of a n analytical s y s t e m
Note that the function R (p. 0 ) and hence the functions Ri (e), i = 1, 2, . . .,
a r e periodic functions of 6 with period of 2 n . It follows f r o m the standard
p r o p e r t i e s of analytical functions that t h e r e e x i s t s ri > 0 such that the
s e r i e s ( 5 4 ) converges for a l l 8. O < B 4 2 n , and f o r all p . 1 p I d r , .
By QT, Appendix, 58.3, Theorem C, the solution
P = f (0; 0, Po) (55)
249
Ch.lX. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLES FROM A tvIULTIPLE FOCUS I
of the equation
2 - R (P? e)
--
(4)
(56)
I
f (0;0, Po) 3 Po
is a n analytical function of the a r g u m e n t s . Let u s expand this solution in
p o w e r s of the "initial value" po. Since H (0, e) 0, we s e e that p E 0 is a
solution of equation (4), so that f (0; 0, 0) E 0. The expansion of f (e; 0, po) in
p o w e r s of po t h e r e f o r e h a s the f o r m
U ; (0) =
U;
Ri (e)us (e),
u (e)=: R~(e)u2 (6) + f i 2 (e)U: (e),
(e)==R,(0) u 8 w + 2
. . . . . . . . . . .
4 (6) u1(e) u2 (e)-I-1 3 ~(e) u: (e),
, . . . . . ,
1 (59)
I
I
Relations ( 5 8 ) may be considered a s the initial conditions f o r the
functions (8) satisfying differential equations (59).* Using these initial
conditions and successively integrating equations (59) as l i n e a r differential
equations for the corresponding functions, we obtain
250
5 "c. FOCAL L'ALC'ES
Let
ui (23) =ai, i = 1, 2, . . .
Then
where
and (661
P, (e) =
o R ( o H)
[A Of, 3 p=o -0. (67)
The series expansion o2 the function R ( p . e) is t h e r e f o r e given by
1: (P, 6 ) = R?( 8 )p2 +- RJ(e)p3 + .. . (68)
25 1
Ch.lX. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLES FROM A MULTIPLE FOCUS
uz == BRz,
~3 + Rzvz,
= B R3
u4 + +R2~3,
BE4
............
H 3 ~ 2
Hence
d" ( 0 )= 31 aJ= 6
I 12R2 (e) u2(e) +- R~(e)]d e .
Using the e x p r e s s i o n s f o r R Z (e) and R 3 (e) in t e r m s of the polynomials
P z , Q 2 , P 3 . Q3 and writing these polynomials (of second and third d e g r e e ,
r e s p e c t i v e l y ) in the f o r m
[3(a30+bo3)-t (aiz-tbzdl-
-- G2 (71)
1 2 ~ ~ 2 0 ~ 2 0 - ~ 0 2 ~ 0 2 ~ - ~ 1 1 ~ ~ 0 2 $ ~ 2 0 ~ + ~ ~ 1 ~ ~ 0 2 T ~ 2 0 ~ 1 .
252
6"4. FOCAL <;ALL'ES
$=n=
+v-z=Ti. (74)
*=-&+pZ
dt %? q)+F3(&q)+ * f . t
aa= --
468
% +
{ [ a t( 4 1i attboz +aonbti)t a b (bi, f azobti + atibzo) +
+ c2 (aliao2+ 2aG2b02)-2ac (bX -a w d -2ab (a:-- bzoboz)-
- b2 ( 2 a d 2 0+ btlbZd + (bc-2a9 (bttbo2--aItapo)l-
-(a2f be) 13 (~bo3- bum) + 2a (a21 + biz) -(can-
i bbzdl} (76 )
(see /18/, p . 2 9 ) .
Equation (71) is a p a r t i c u l a r case of (76), and c a n be obtained f r o m the
l a t t e r f o r a = d = 0 , b = - p, c = i3.
Note that (76) actually gives a n e x p r e s s i o n - in t e r m s of the coefficients
of s y s t e m (75) - f o r the focal value of s y s t e m (75) and not the original
s y s t e m (72). This is i m m a t e r i a l , however, f o r the investigation of the
* For dynamic systems with quad.atic polynomials in the right-hand sides, i.e., systems of the form
as,a, in terms of the coefficients ai, and b,, have been derived in / l B / .
the expressions for as,
253
ch.IX. <;REA'I'ION OF LIblIT CYCLES FROM A MULTIPLE FOCI!S
where 'p and II, a r e functions which vanish together with their first d e r i v a -
tives a t the point 0 (0, 0).
Consider the function d (po) = f ( 2 x , 0, PO) - po corresponding to s y s t e m (A)
( s e e 924.1). L e t this function be defined f o r all po. I po I < r o , where ro is
s o m e positive number. A s we know (see 124.2, c o r o l l a r y f r o m L e m m a 3),
' The transformation E==, q= -aB=--!B.y is non-singular, since by (73) b # 0.
* * W e mean here conditions each o f which requires computation of one number. All these conditions are
of course equivalent to the single condition d (po) = 0, but the latter requires computation of a
function, and not of numbers.
254
d (p,) is a function of c l a s s N or (respectively) a n analytical function. By
assumption, the point 33 is a root of multiplicity 2k 4- 1 of the function d ( p o )
(see 524.2, Definition 2 6 ) . Consequently, t h e r e e x i s t numbers E , > Oand
uo > 0 such that any function a (p,) defined f o r p o , I P O I < r o , which iso,-close
to rank 2k +
1 to the function d (p,) h a s a t m o s t 2k 1 r o o t s in the interval +
(- Ea. eo).
Consider modified s y s t e m s (A), which are given in canonical f o r m and-,
f o r which the point 0 (0, 0) is a focus. Let 2 (p,) be the analog of d ( P O ) for-(A).
By Theorem 3 in Appendix, 1, t h e r e e x i s t s tio> 0 suclh that if s y s t e m (A)
is &,-close to rank 2k $- 1 to s y s t e m (A), the function d (po) is defined f o r
a l l p 9 , I po I -=
roI and fo- these po the functions d (p,) and d" (po) are u,-close to
each other to rank 2k $. 1. W e w i l l now prove that the n u m b e r s aG and E ,
satisfy the f i r s t proposition of the theorem. Suppose that this is not so,
i.e., suppose that t h e r e e x i s t s a modified s y s t e m (A) of canonical f o r m which
is Cio-close to r a n k 2% +
1to s y s t e m (A) and yet h a s m o r e than k closed paths
in U,, (0). Each of these paths c r o s s e s e v e r y r a y issuing f r o m 0 p r e c i s e l y
at one point (see QT, J8.4, L e m m a 1). L e t p , and p z be the a b s c i s s a s of the
intersection points of a. path with the r a y s 0 = 0 and 0 = x I respectively.
Then pt and p2 a r e respectively r o o t s of the functions a ( p ) = 2, (p) and & (p),
By ( 1 3 ) i n 524.1, 6 ( - p 2 ) = - a n @ 2 ) .Therefore
,-
i.e., d ( p l ) = O , & ( p Z ) = O .
a (- p2) = 0, i.e., - p z is a l s o a root of the function 3. Evidently pI and
- p2 a r e d i f f e r e n t n_umbr?rs, s m a l l e r than &,inabsolutevalue. Thus, to e v e r y
closed path of (A) lying in U,,(0)correspond t,"o r o o t s of the function 2 ( p )
f r o m the interval (- E , , E , ) . Hence, i f s y s t e m ( A ) h a s in Us, (0) m o r e than k
closed paths, the tunction B ( p ) h a s a t l e a s t 2k +
3 different r o o t s '.- in (- E O , E O ) .
This c l e a r l y contradict,s the choice of the n u m b e r s 6 , and E* W e hzve thus
proved the f i r s t proposition of the theorem f o r modified s y s t e m s (A) given
in canonical f o r m .
Let u s now consider a g e n e r a l modified s y s t e m (A) (not n e c e s s a r i l y
canonical). Suppose that the f i r s t proposition of the theorem is not satisfied.
Then, for any el > 0 and a1 > 0, t h e r e e x i s t s a s y s t e m (A$:) 6,-close to rank
2k + 1 to (A) which h a s m o r e than k closed paths in Ue1(0). If el and 61 are
sufficiently s m a l l , t h e r e e x i s t s a l i n e a r transformation, as c l o s e a s
d e s i r e d to the identity t_ransformation, which t r a n s f o r m s the s p t e m ( A )
to the canonical f o r m ( A ) . x ik For sufficiently s m a l l el and 6,, (A) is a l s o
6,-close to ( A ) and h a s m o r e than k closed paths in U,,(0), which are obtained
from the closed paths of (A:; ) in U e l ( 0 by ) the s a m e l i n e a r transformation.
This, however, contra'dicts the previous r e s u l t . The f i r s t proposition of
the theorem is thus completely proved.
2 ) W e can now proceed with the proof of the second proposition.
Consider a modified s y s t e m of a s p e c i a l f o r m
dz -
x = p ( x , y, xo, AI? .-a, hh-1)=
255
Ch.lX. CREATION OF L I M I T CYCLES FROM A MClLTlPLE FOCUS
'
(
P
O
? LO, i t , ... 7 Ak-1)
F o r any e > 0 and 8 > 0, t h e r e exist h* > 0 and r* > 0, r* < ro,* such that
for
lAtl<A*, i = O , 1, 2. ..., k-1, (2)
1 ) system (A) is
8-close to r a n k 2k 1 to (A); +
.
. ., Ak-l) is defined f o r all po, I po I < ro, and
2 ) the function a ( p o , A,, h l ,
e v e r y root satisfying the inequality I po I < r* c o r r e s p o n d s to a closed path
of (A) e n t i r e l y contained in U,, (0).
It is henceforth a s s u m e d that the n u m b e r s A i , i = 0, 1, 2, . ., k - 1 , s a t i s f y .
condition (2).
We w i l l show that f o r a: a p p r o p r i a t e choice of the p a r a m e t e r s
.
Lo, Al, L2, . ., Ak-, s y s t e m (A) h a s k closed paths in U. (0).
F r o m Maclaurin's f o r m u l a , f o r all sufficiently s m a l l po,
Let now
... = r ~ ~ - ~ = oA, ~ - ~ + o ,
and consider the modified s y s t e m corresponding to these p a r a m e t e r s
* By definition, r, > 0 is a number such that t h e function d (po) is defined for I po I < ro.
256
$25. CRE4TION OF LIhlIT CYCLES FROhl A hLILLTIPLE FOCI'S
(0) = . . . = d-(?k-2)
c
& (O)=d; I (0) = O , 6 ( 2 k - ' ) ( 0=) ( 2 k - l j ! k 2 ~ ,
B
(5)
257
By ( l l ) , &(po)>O f o r all sufficiently s m a l l positive po, and t h e r e e x i s t s
r3 such that
O<r3<rz
and
d", (ra) >0.
Continuing a s before, we eventually obtain a s y s t e m
d+ -
= P ( x , Y, 0, ai, . . ,, ak-l)=
= P (I,y) + h, (sa + ye) z+ . ..+a b l (2+ yZ)k-12,
x-= Q-
dy
(I,Y, 0,h,, . . ., hk-i) =
==Q (I,Y) + a, (I2+ye) Y + ... +L,(s* +
and
Continuing to the s y s t e m
we choose L, s o s m a l l that
and
i f k is odd,
(0
1 0 if k is even. I
By (25), S24.2, we have f o r the f i r s t focal value
2x "0
&(O)=e B -i.
(0 i f k i s odd,
'k(rk+d )>O if k is even.
258
$ 9 5 . CREATIOS OF LI:,IIT CYCLES FROhf A X'bLTIPLE FOCLS
259
Ch.IX. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLES FROM A MULTIPLE FOCUS I
and
-
d", (r,) > 0, & ( r z )< 0, . . ., d, (ra+l) I >U
(0
i f s is even,
if s is odd. (21)
260
$ 2 5 . C R E A \ f O N OF LI\IIT CYCLES FRO!,! .4 LILLTIPLE FOCCS
f, 1, 1, 0, 1, 0, o...o, 1, 0 ,
26 I
Ch.IX. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLES FROM A MULTIPLE FOCUS
Then
262
$95. CREPIOb OF LIhlIT CYCLES FRU!,I h hlCLTIPLE FOCUS
.;
Conversely, if u (k) 0, 0 is a n unstable focus of (Al). Then, reasoning
a s before, we conclude that t h e r e is a single limit cycle LAof (AA)inside V ,
and this is a simple sta'5le cycle. It is readily s e e n that if X is sufficiently
s m a l l , the cycle L A is a r b i t r a r i l y c l o s e to 0.
W e thus obtain the following r e s u l t s . If a3< 0 and (I' (0) > 0, s y s t e m (A,)
h a s no l i m i t c y c l e s in 1'for s m a l l negative X and h = 0, and 0 is a stable
focus. A s the s y s t e m c r o s s e s the bifurcation value of the p a r a m e t e r X (i.e.,
for h>O). the focus becomes unstable, and a stable l i m i t cycle develops
inside the neighborhood Y ( F i g u r e 116).
a b
FIGURE 116. ax< 0, 0' (0)> 0. a) X <O. stable
focus: h = 0. stable multiple focus; b) X > 0 , un-
stable tocus, stable cycle.
26 3
Ch.IX. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLES FROM A MULTIPLE FOCUS
a b
FIGURE 117. U S 32 0 , u' (0)> 0. a) h -=
0,stable
focus, unstable cycle; b) h = 0,multiple unstable
focus: h > 0, unstable focus.
264
$25. CRE.4TION OF LIhlIT CYCLES FROLI .4 PIIL'LTIPLE FOCLIS
r h i s gives a 3 = n/4 @ (y -L6). F r o m the inequality u' (0) > 0 and the table
above w e conclude that if fi ( y +6) < 0. the focus 0 (0, 0) is stable f o r ?.GOand
t h e r e are no limit cycles in i t s neighborhood. A s we move to positive i . ,
the focus c r e a t e s a stable l i m i t cycle, and itself becomes unstable.
If @ ( y -+ 6) > 0, the focus 0 (0, 0) is stable f o r 1. < 0 and t h e r e is a n unstable
limit cycle in i t s neighborhood. A s ). i n c r e a s e s , the cycle c o n t r a c t s to a
point and d i s a p p e a r s f o r 2. = 0 . A t this instant, the focus 0 becomes unstable.
The topological s t r u c t u r e in the neighborhood of 0 for 2. > 0 is the s a m e as
for 1. = 0.
265
Chapter X
C R E A T I O N OF C L O S E D P A T H S F R O M A M U L T I P L E
L I M I T C Y C LE
INTRODUCTION
266
506. I)ERIV.ATIVES CY T H E SLCCESSIOS FCNCTIOS
Let
the motion corresponding to this path, T > O the period of the functions p and
$-
Consider the neighborhood Q of the path Lo d e s c r i b e d i n Chapter V (B13.1)
with the c u r v i l i n e a r c o o r d i n a t e s s and n , defined by the r e l a t i o n s
-
z=cp(s, n). y=3(s, n), (21
where
where
361
ax. CREATION OF CLOSED PATHS FROM A MULTIPLE LIMIT'CYCLE
which is obtained when the second equation in (5) is divided through by the
f i r s t equation. This division is p e r m i s s i b l e by $13.2, (11). We w i l l
r e i t e r a t e h e r e the p r o p e r t i e s of the function R (s, n) and of equation (7).
R (s, n) is defined in the s t r i p (4), w h e r e i t is a continuous function,
periodic in s with a period of T . If (A) is a dynamic s y s t e m of c l a s s N
(analytical s y s t e m ) , R (s, n) is a l s o a function of c l a s s N (analytical function).
Moreover,
R ( s , 0 ) = 0. (8)
s
I
268
The derivation of t h e s e e x p r e s s i o n s is analogous to the d e r i v a t i o n of the
e x p r e s s i o n s for the focal v a l u e s in S24.3.
Since the right-hand s i d e R (s. n) of the differential equation ( 7 ) is a
function of c l a s s -V, the solution
n - f ( s ; 0. no)
Therefore,
269
ch.X. CREATION OF CLOSED PATHS FROM A MULTIPLE LIMIT CYCLE
( s e e 513.3, (25)).
1
Multiplying the k-th equation i n (14) by and integrating, w e find
Rl(*)d&
f(O)=eO , (23)
w e obtained a f t e r s o m e manipulations
270
using the symbolic power notation,:'. we obtain, as is readily verified,
ud is used as I n
If f ( x , y) is a function of two variables, the symbolic binomial power
(u xI'Jy)
a h h e v i a r e d nofarLon for the operator defined by the cquallty
271
Ch.X. CREATION OF CLOSED PATHS FROM A hlULTIPLE LIMIT CYCLE
s
T
[&-?(a), Ws))+Q&W, $(.))la*
f' (0) = e a (30)
2. Multiplicity of a l i m i t cycle
272
926. Dl~RIV.\TIVES CY T H E SUCCESSlON FLXCTIOX
Q e footnote on p. 108.
'I
If ( A I is a n analytical system, L p i s a closed path of ( A ) , and a l l the derivatives vanish, d ' k )(0)=
:= 0 tk = i . 2. . . .), we have (I ( n o ) 0 and a l l the paths clcse t o L o are closed paths. i.e., L o is no
longer a limit c y c l e . See 12.:3.
273
Ch.X. CREATION OF CLOSED PATHS FROM A MULTIPLE LIMIT CYCLE
(41)
5438 274
where 1er<S, and let m be an integer,
i<m::r, (43)
and 3. a nonzeYo veal nvtnbev. Then the closed path Lo is a tntiltiple littiit
cycle of mdtiplicity m .for the system Le., (xi,),
2 (0) =d""(O) =. . . =a(m-')(0) =o. (441
and
Also
a ( " ' ) ( o ) = ~ . m[ q! ' ( 0 ) 2 + ~ ' ( O ) 2 1 " - 1 ~
'
(m-1) [p.&(s), t ( s ) ) f Q ( w ) , WS))~ dr
r e O ds. (46)
P r o o f . Since L o is a path of s y s t e m (Kk),
the d e r i v a t i v e s gi)(O),
i = 1, 2 , . . .. m, may be found using (30) and ( 3 1 ) (for the d e r i v a t i v e s d(i) (0)).
In t h e s e equations, P (2,! I ) and Q (I,y) and t h e i r d e r i v a t i v e s should be r e p l a c e d
with (3, y) and Q ( x , y) and t h e i r d e r i v a t i v e s ( t h e functions v, 9, q', rt;' c l e a r l y
r e m a i n a s before).
& e recall that i n computations using (30) and (31), the v a l u e s of the
functions P" and p and t h e i r d e r i v a t i v e s should be taken for x = (p (s), y = $ (s).
o,<S,<T.
F r o m the r e l a t i o n s
275
Ch.X, CREATION OF CLOSED PATHS FROM A MULTIPLE LIMIT CYCLE
u=*(s) u=W)
+
Y'W.)
1
}
( i = O , 1, 2, ...,m). J I
L e t fii (s), pi (s), etc., be the functions of (x,)
which are analogous to the
functions R i ( s ) ,H i @ ) , etc., of (A). Relation (25), the analogous relation
for R, (s), and equations (48) lead to the equality
(s) = R* (s). (50)
Thus, using (231, we s e e that
P (0)= f' (01,
and t h e r e f o r e
-d' (0) =a' (0).
F u r t h e r m o r e , using (21), (28), (29), (31), the analogous r e l a t i o n s f o r (xA),
and also equations (48), (50), and (51), we conclude that
@k (s) = Wa (s) .(53)
for k 6 m - I ;
&k (s) = @h (s) (54 1
for k x m ;
fi, (S) = H k (s) (55)
for k g m - 1 , and finally,
d
"(k) ( 0) = d'k' (0) (56)
I f o r l i - 2 . 3, ..., m - I .
From (42), (43), (52), and (56) i t follows that
- (0)= . . . -
I W e have thus proved relation (44).
d' (0)= d - P-i)
(0) = 0.
1 R,,,
Ri(a)d8
\
5 (k-i) T
(0) = f' (0) (s) e 0 ds+m!f' (0) @ k ( s ) e O ds. (57)
1
0 0
'The_ expression f o r 6f"(s) c a n be found using (28). Replacing P and Q with
p a n d Q and using (49), we obtain
227. CRE;ITIO\; OF L i h i i r CYCLES mox A MCLTIPLE Liwr CYCLE
im-ib 5 jF;qs~s).*(*)I e Q L f ~ ! s ) ,+ i s l i ] d ~
,. e u ds.
i . e .., eaualitv
. (46)holds true.
Inequalit; (45) follows directly f r o m (46)and inequality ( 3 7 ) . This c o m -
pletes the proof of the l e m m a .
R e m a r k . M'e have a s s u m e d in the l e m m a that r>.)(an_d thus ,V>2) and,
imposing conditions (212:', considered the modified s y s i e m (A,) with m > 2 .
Cinder these conditions, the closed path Lo of s y s t e m (A,) is a multiple lim2t
cycle of multiplicity m . The case m = 1, i . e . , when the modified s y s t e m (A,)
h a s the f o r m
277
(3.X. CREATION OF CLOSED PATHS FROM A MULTIPLE LIMIT CYCLE
1 ) there exist E , > 0 and 6, > 0 such that any s y s t e m (A) 6,-close to
rank k to (A) has at most k closed paths inUQ ( L o ) ;
2) f o r any positive e < e , and 6 < 6,, there exists a system (A) of class N
(of analytical class, respectively) which is 6 -close to rank k to (A) and
I
has k closed paths in U,, (Lo).*
P r 0 0 f . 1 ) Let u s prove the f i r s t proposition of the theorem. A s i n the
previous section, consider a n a r c without contact I , which is a normal to the
path Lo ( s e e 26.1), and the succession function f (no) of s y s t e m ( A ) on the
a r c 1 , together with the function d (no) = f (no) - n o . Let these functions be
I
defined for a l l no, I no I<.*, where n* is s o m e positive number. A s we have
noted in 526, d ( n o )is a function of c l a s s N.
Since Lo is a limit cycle of multiplicity k of s y s t e m (A), we s e e that
FIGURE 118
* The closed paths of Theorem 42 are clearly isolated, i.e., they are limit cycles.
278
where i ; a r e p a r a m e t e r s , and F (I,y) is a function of c l a s s h + 1,defined in
7; and satist'.ving conditions ( 3 5 ) and ( ~ 3 6of ) the p r e v i o u s section j S 2 6 . 2 ) .
fiy \ 3 3 / , the function F (2.y) \ranishes at the points of tlie l i m i t c y c l e L o ,Of
s y s t e m ( X Jand t h e r e f o r e L o is a l s o a path of s y s t e m ( X i . Evidently, !A)
i s also a s y s t e m of c l a s s .V.
F o r sufficiently s m a l l A,, t-q) is a r b i t r a r i l y c l o s e to ( A ) to any ( p o s s i b l e )
rank, and by S4, Leninias 1,2, and 11, the function
. . .. A+!).
I
d ( ~ , , .i.!. >.?,
f'or any E > 0 and 6 >0, there exist I* > 0 anit i &
s u c h~
that +
if
then
!a) systcni (x) is 6 -close to r a n k k to s y s t e m ( A ) ;
',b) the function d(n,,. i.!. i,:.,. ., I.*-,) is defined f o r a l l R ~ 1,no 1<n*, and any
root of this function satisfying the inequality I no 1 < k c o r r e s p o n d s to a
c l o s e d path of tLXJcompletely contained in 1 I E ( L o ) .
Let F and h be fixed positive n u m b e r s , e < e g . 6<:6,. Let f u r t h e r , i.* and
t i b e the n u m b e r s corresponding to e and 6 ( i . e . , s u c h that i f (3) is satisfied,
conditions t a ) and ( b ) hol-t t r u e ) . i V e Ixill show that by a n a p p r o p r i a t e choice
. . ., kS-,, s y s t e m (A) c a n be made 6-close to r a n k k
of the p a r a m e t e r s i I ,i.-,
tu { A ) and ,will have k closed paths in C', (Lo).
Lf'e :vi11 a s s u m e that the n u n i b e r s
).; henceforth s a t i s f y condition (3).
F r o m M a c l a u r i n ' s fo.rmula we conclude that, in v i r t u e of r e l a t i o n s ( 1 ),
t'ur a l l sufficiently s m a l l no,
h o w suppose that
Ch.X. CREATION OF CLOSED PATHS FROM A MULTIPLE LIMIT CYCLE
I
and consider the n o d i f i e d system corresponding to these values of the
parameters,
dz
;i7- = P
- (5, y, 0, 0, .. s, 0, hk-1) = P (5, Y) +hk-lFk--'F;,
dy=
dt
-
Q ( 2 3 Y, 0, 0, .. . t 0, hk-1) = Q (5, Sr) +hi-iP-'FL, (A,)
+h", (no)nt-1,
I
dl (no) =
1 hk-11 <A*, hk-i <0, d", (ni) = a(ni, 0, 0, . - 9 0, Lk-1) >0. (8)
280
927. CRMTIOh OF LIhlIT CYCLES FROhI .4 hlULTPLE LIAlIT CYCLE
and
W e have seen in Chapter V (915.21 that such a function may be connructed in the neighborhood of the
path L o This is not sufficient, h,wever, since ig should be defined in the entire d .
28 i
Ch.X. CKEATION OF CLOSED PATHS FROM A MULTIPLE LIMIT CYCLE
the a r c 1 again with increasing t a t point M:, s o that the a r c M:M: of the
path L* is entirely contained in U , (Lo).:.
(c*) T h e r e e x i s t s a closed path L: of (A:) which lies entirely in U , ( L o )
and c r o s s e s the a r c without contact 1 a t point M : corresponding to the
value n: of the p a r a m e t e r , where n: < n, (condition (e:) is satisfied for
sufficiently s m a l l 1 because Lo is a s t r u c t u r a l l y stable limit cycle of (A)).
F r o m (a.), (b), and (c.) i t c l e a r l y follows that (A*) is a n analytical
system, 6 -close to rank k to s y s t e m (A), which h a s a t l e a s t k closed paths
in U , (Lo),i.e., i t s a t i s f i e s the second proposition of the theorem. This
completes the proof of the theorem.
R e m a r k . If (A) is a system of c l a s s E , the condition - in the second
proposition of r h e o r e m 4 2 - that s y s t e m (A) is 6 -close to rank k to (A)
may be replaced by requirement of 6 -closeness of rank N . If (A) is a n
analytical system, we can find a n analytical s y s t e m (A) satisfying the
second proposition of the theorem and yet close to (A) to rank m , where m
is a n a r b i t r a r y natural number. The validity of this r e m a r k follows directly
from the proof of Theorem 4 2 .
2. Supplements
O n t h e c r e a t i o n o f l i m i t c y c l e s f r o m a f o c u s of f i n i t e
m u 1 t i p 1 i c i t y . Theorem 4 2 and the r e m a r k following the theorem enable
u s to strengthen the second proposition of Theorem 41. Indeed, the
following theorem obtains :
T h e o y e m 41 . Let 0 (0, 0 ) be a multiple focus of multiplicity k of a
dynamic system (A) of class N > 2k + 1 (or analytical), and let e, and 6o be
sufficiently small positive numbers (introduced in the f i r s t proposition of
Theorem 40 and the remark to that theorem). If system (B) i s 6,-close
to yank 2k f 1 to system ( A ) , the sum of the multiplicities of the focus
and the limit cycles of (B) lying in U,, (0)is at most k .
P r o o f . Let the s u m of the multiplicities of the focus and the limit
cycles of (B) lying in U,, (0)be k* > k. Then, using the construction of
L e m m a 2, 815.2, and T h e o r e m s 4 0 and 42, together with the r e m a r k to
Theorem 42, w e can modify ( B ) in the neighborhood of each of these l i m i t
c y c l e s and the focus, to obtain a s y s t e m (B.) which is a r b i t r a r i l y close
to rank 2k + 1 to s y s t e m (B) and h a s k* > k closed paths in U , (0). The
existence of this s y s t e m (B ), however, contradicts the condition that
0 (0, 0 ) i s a focus of multiplicity k . If only analytical s y s t e m s are considered,
the limit cycles of (B;:) lying in U,,(0)should f u r t h e r be made s t r u c t u r a l l y
stable (see $15.2, L e m m a 2 ) and (B;:) should be approximated with a n
analytical s y s t e m . The theorem is thus proved. It is clear that the second
proposition of Theorem 4 1 follows f r o m Theorem 41.
B i f u r c a t i o n s of a d y n a m i c s y s t e m i n t h e n e i g h b o r h o o d
of a l i m i t c y c l e o f f i n i t e m u l t i p l i c i t y . W e will f i r s t consider
a proposition which is analogous to Theorem 4 1 and strengthens the second
proposition of Theorem 42. This proposition, together with Theorem 42,
plays a fundamental role in the e n t i r e topic of bifurcations of dynamic
s y s t e m s in the neighborhood of a limit cycle of finite multiplicity.
* For a s m a l l q , condition (b*) is satisfied because of condition (b) and Lemma 11, 04.2.
282
$27. CRE.ATIO?: O F LI?,!If CYCLES FRO!.: .A ALC'LTIPLE LI.\!IT CYCLE
283
0.X. CREATION O F CLOSED PATHS FROM A MULTIPLE LIMIT CYCLE
We will now show that the path Lo is a cycle of multiplicity k for (Bk).
This follows d i r e c t l y f r o m L e m m a 1, 5 2 6 . 2 . For the s t a r t i n g s y s t e m (A)
of the l e m m a we take the s y s t e m
dz
-=
and s e t
284
527. CRE.1TLOX OF LIhlIT CYCLES FROhl A hIULTIPLE LUIIT CYCLE
285
C h a p t e r XI
INTRODUCTION
00 (zo. Yo) = P
z (% Yo) +Qk (% Yo)
is positive (negative), the loop Lo is unstable (stable) from inside, i . e . ,
all the paths passing through points i n t e r i o r to the loop which a r e sufficiently
c l o s e t o the loop g o t o t h i s loop f o r t + - 00 ( t + +00).
286
$28. AUXILI.4RY hlATERIAL
FIGURE 122
;I 2 8 . AUXILIARY MATERIAL
281
Ch.XI. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLES FHOM THE LOOP OF A SADDLE-POINT SEPARATRIX
and -
z=gz(i), y=h,(G), a<iig6
b e the solution of ( D ) which p a s s e s through the point (zo, yo) for t = to. Let
'P ( t ; t o , gi (u), hi (u))= Q, (C u), 9 (ti to, gi (u),hi (u))= 'f' (1, u)- (2)
Then
@ ( t o , U)E gi (u), 'y (to, U ) hi (u). (3)
On the other hand, i n view of the above assumptions,
Q, u) = gz (0 (@I),
( x (4, 'y ( x (u). u ) = hz ( 0( u ) ) . (4)
Since 1, and I , a r e a r c s without contact, each of the determinants
FIGURE 123
288
Also note that
@i ( t , u)= P (@ (t, u ) , Y ( t , u ) ) , Y; ( t , u ) = Q (av. u), Y ( t , 4). (5)
T h i s f o l l o w s f r o m ( 2 ) a n d f r o m t h e f a c t t h a t ( 1 ) is a s o l u t i o n of s y s t e m ( D ) .
L e in rn a 1 . The junctions
= cp ( t ; t o , 20, Yo), Y = 9 ( t ; t o , zo. Yo) (1)
P roof . From t h e d e f i n i t i o n of a n d y, if
E q u a t i o n s ( 6 ) follow from t h e l a s t r e l a t i o n s a n d f i
L e m m a 2. Let
where 'p = 'p ( t ; to, x0, yo), 9 =\I,( t ; to. xO, yo). Then
aJ
Proof . Let u s evaluate x.
289
Ch.XI. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLES FROM THE LOOP OF A SADDLE-POINT SEPAKATRIX
aJ
-=
at
-=
at [Pi (9,9 +Q; ('p. 4 1 J. (12)
Therefore
L e m m a 3.
290
T h e a b o v e l e m m a s e n a b l e u s to d e r i v e a n e x p r e s s i o n for t h e d e r i v a t i v e
of t h e c o r r e s p o n d e n c e f u n c t i o n . T h i s e x p r e s s i o n w i l l p r o v e t o b e of c o n -
s i d e r a b l e i m p o r t a n c e i n w h a t f o l l o w s , a n d i v e w i l l now p r o c e e d tvith i t s
derivation.
We have a l r e a d v introduced the d e t e r m i n a n t s
As w e h a v e s e e n , t h e t w o d e t e r m i n a n t s c a n be t a k e n p o s i t i v e w i t h o u t loss
of g e n e r a l i t y . From (21, (4), a n d ( 5 ) w e h a v e
AI (3)=
A, (3) =
L e m ma 4 . The deriu,
expressible in the forin
T h e l a s t r e l a t i o n s c a n b e c o n s i d e r e d a s a l i n e a r s y s t e m i n ~ ' ( u ) ~, ' ( u ) .
I t s d e t e r m i n a n t i s e v i d e n t l y e q u a l to A z ( u ) , so t h a t w e a r e d e a l i n g w i t h a
C r a m e r s s y s t e m . Its s o l u t i o n is
T h e d e t e r m i n a n t i n t h e l a s t f r a c t i o n is A ( ( x ( u ) ,u ) . B y (14)
291
Ch.Xf. CREATION OF LlMIT CYCLES FROM THE LOOP OF A SADDLE-POINT SEPARATRIX
I.
I
FIGURE 124
rdinates of a,,.
(22)
292
so that
Ch.XI. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLES FROM THE LOOP OF A SADDLE-POINT SEPARATRIX
I
-
v =f(v) = f* (0(u))=0 (f (u))= o (C).
Then there exists at most one closed path crossing the segment of 1 c m -
responding to the above v a b e s of U , and i f such a closed path does exist,
it will be a stable (cmrespondingly unstable) structurally stable limit
cycle.
P r o o f . Suppose that t h e r e a r e two points on the a r c I , MI (u,)and M Z(uz),
through which p a s s closed paths, where u, and uz belong to the segment [ a , b ] .
Then f (4 = U I , f (uz) = ~ 2 ,
f (UJ -f (4= ui-u2. I
F r o m Lagranges formula, f (u,)- f (uz) = f (u) (u, - u 2 ) , where is a value
of the p a r a m e t e r f r o m the i n t e r v a l ( u t , u 2 ) and hence f r o m the segment l a , b ] .
But then f (j) (u, - uz) = u, - U Z , i.e., f (i)= 1, at variance with (29). The
f i r s t proposition of the l e m m a is thus proved. The fact that a closed path
f o r whichf (u)< 1 (f( u ) > 1 ) i s a stable (unstable) s t r u c t u r a l l y stable limit
cycle was established in Chapter V (s 12.4, and also 9; 14, T h e o r e m 18).
T h i s completes the proof of the l e m m a .
W e w i l l give without proof two f u r t h e r l e m m a s which deal with (D) and
other close systems.
Let I , and 1, b e two a r c s without contact of s y s t e m (D) without common
points, and let a correspondence function = o (u)between the a r c s I, and l2
b e defined on t h e a r c I , for a l l values of the p a r a m e t e r u , a , < u , ( b , s o that
the values = o ( a ) and %=a ( b ) of the correspondence function r e p r e s e n t
i n t e r i o r points of the a r c I,.
L e m m a 7. F m any e > 0 there exists 6 > 0 such that fm every (6)
6 -close to (D) , I , and I2 are arcs without contact and there exists a COT-
resbondence function between these arcs
-u = o- (u),
294
S 26. A IrX I LIAR Y \ I AT ERI .U
w h i c h a r e a n a l o g o u s to e q u a t i o n s (4). L e m m a 8 m a y be c o n s i d e r e d a s a
p a r t i c u l a r case of Lemma 7 .
2 . S o m e p r o p e r t i e s of a s a d d l e point a n d
its s e p a r a t r i c e s
S i m p l e e q u i l i b r i u m s t a t e s c l a s s i f i e d as s a d d l e p o i n t s a r e c o n s i d e r e d i n
d e t a i l i n QT, C h a p t e r I V , 8 7 . 3 , a n d also i n C h a p t e r IV of t h e p r e s e n t book
( 5 9 ) . W e w i l l now g i v e those p r o p e r t i e s of s a d d l e p o i n t s a n d s e p a r a t r i c e s
w h i c h w i l l be n e e d e d i n what f o l l o w s .
L e t 0 (E,,, yo) b e a s a d d l e p o i n t of t h e d y n a m i c s y s t e m (D), w h i c h is a n
i n t e r i o r p o i n t of %.
L e in ni a 9 . (a) There exist E~ > 0 and a0 > 0 such that any s y s t e m (5)
S,,-close in C to ( D ) has single equilibrium state 6 in U e e ( 0 ) ,uihich is
moreover a saddle poini.
(b) F m euery E , 0 < E < E ~ ,there exists 6 . 0 < 6 == 6,, such that if (6)
is 8-close to ( D ) , it has a saddle point 0" lying in U , (0).
P r o o f . T h e v a l i d i t y of L e m m a 9 f o l l o w s d i r e c t l y from t h e d e f i n i t i o n
of a s i m p l e e q u i l i b r i u m s t a t e (see $ 7 . 3 , D e f i n i t i o n 15, a n d also 32.1,
n e f i n i t i o n 5) a n d from t h e f a c t t h a t A < O f o r a s a d d l e p o i n t .
R em ark . C o n s i d e r a dynamic s y s t e m whose right- hand s i d e s are
f u n c t i o n s of t h e p a r a m e t e r p, i . e., a s y s t e m
w h e r e (E,,,,) is i d e n t i f i e d w i t h the o r i g i n a l s y s t e m ( D ) .
T h e n t h e r e e x i s t e,, > 0 a n d a > 0 s u c h that if1 p-po I<a, (8,) h a s i n U, (0)
a s i n g l e e q u i l i b r i u m state, w h i c h i s a s a d d l e p o i n t , and its c o o r d i n a t e s
zo (p) a n d yo (p) are c o n t i n u o u s f u n c t i o n s of p; i n p a r t i c u l a r
295
Ch-XI. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLES FROM THE LOOP OF A SADDLE-POINT SEPARATRIX
+-=l
MO(UO) r e m a r k to L e m m a 3, 59.2, and i t is given h e r e
without proof. Let 0 be a saddle point of (D),
L+i t s a -s e p a r a t r i x , I a n arc without contact
c r o s s i n g the s e p a r a t r i x L+ a t a single point M o .
"I which does not coincide with either end point
of the a r c I , without c r o s s i n g the second
FIGURE 126
o - s e p a r a t r i x of the saddle point ( F i g u r e 1 2 6 ) .
Let, f u r t h e r m o r e , x = g(u),y = h (u) be the
p a r a m e t r i c equations of the a r c 1, the point
-
M , corresuondina t o the value u nof the u a r a m e t e r u.
-By L e m m a 9, any modified s y s t e m (%) sufficiently close to (D) h a s a
single saddle point 0" sufficiently c l o s e t o 0 in s o m e fixed neighborhood
ue, (0).
L e m m a 10. Forany E > O , there exists s > o s u c h that v ( 5 )i s 8 - C l O S e
to (D), then:
I
(a) One of the o-separatrices of the saddle point 0" (which we denote %+)
c r o s s e s the a r c 1 at a single point Mor c o r v e s p d i n g to the value Zo of the
parameter, such that R,E U. (M,,), and the second a-separatrix of the saddle
point 0" does not cross the a r c 1.
(b) If motion i s defined on the separatrices L* and E+ so that the points
M oand ~2~ correspond to the same time t = t o , then for any t > t o , the point
i@ ( t ) of the separatrix 3 cmresponding to the time t lies in an e-neighbm-
hood of the point M ( t ) of the separatrix L + c o r r e s p d i n g to the same time.
A s i m i l a r proposition is t r u e for the a - s e p a r a t r i c e s of the saddle point 0.
R e m a r k . A s in the r e m a r k to L e m m a 9, let (DP)be a s y s t e m whose
right-hand s i d e s a r e continuous functions of p and which coincides with
the original s y s t e m (D) for-p=po. Then by L e m m a 10, t h e r e e x i s t s a > O
such that i f I p - po I < a, (D,,) h a s a single saddle point 0 (p) in U , (0)one
z:
of whose o - s e p a r a t r i c e s a0
c r o s s e s the a r c I at a single point (p), and
the o t h e r s e p a r a t r i x h a s no common point with 1. Moreover, the value
Go(p) of the p a r a m e t e r u corresponding t o the point G0(p) is a continuous
function of p. A s i m i l a r proposition applies t o the case when the right-
hand s i d e s of the s y s t e m are continuous functions of s e v e r a l p a r a m e t e r s .
Still another useful proposition c a n be derived f r o m an analysis of
the behavior of paths in the neighborhood of a saddle point (QT, 3 7 . 3 ) .
T h i s proposition is formulated in the f o r m of a l e m m a , without proof.
Consider a c i r c l e C centered a t the saddle point 0; t h e r e a r e
no equilibrium s t a t e s of s y s t e m (D), except 0, either inside the a r e a
enclosed by the c i r c l e o r on the c i r c l e . Let L: and L; be o- and a-
s e p a r a t r i c e s of the saddle point 0. Suppose that each of t h e s e s e p a r a -
t r i c e s h a s points lying outside C , and let M i and M z be the l a s t common
points of t h e s e s e p a r a t r i c e s with C (so that the segments OMi and OMz
of the semipaths 15: and L; contain no points of C ; Figure 1 2 7 ) . The
s e g m e n t s O M , and O M z of the s e p a r a t r i c e s L: and L; divide t h e c i r c u l a r
a r e a enclosed by the c i r c l e C into two (curvilinear) s e c t o r s , one of
296
528. AUXILIARY LIATEWAL
which c o n t a i n s t h e o t h e r t w o s e p a r a -
t r i c e s of t h e s a d d l e point 0. L e t t h e
o t h e r s e c t o r b e d e s i g n a t e d K. L e t d
and B b e t w o points o n t h e s e g m e n t s
OM, a n d OM,of t h e s e p a r a t r i c e s L:
a n d L; w h i c h d o not c o i n c i d e w i t h .If1
and.MM., a n d L l , h2 a r c s without c o n t a c t
p a s s i n g t h r o u g h A a n d B which h a v e
no c o m m o n points.
L e n i tn a 11. There exist seg-
ments A.-ii and RBI of the arcs iaithotit
contact I., and I., which are entirely
contained (with the exception of the
FIGCRE 121 end points A and B ) in the sector K and
haue the follouiing property: every
path L of ( D ) which fm t = tI passes through a point M of the arc .-id1 other
than A , will cross f m t 2 ) ti the arc X 2 at some point .V other than R;
moreover,
(a) all the points of'the path comespanding to t , ti< t ( t 2 , lie iaside
the sector K ;
(b) a path passing through the point A i of the arc .-idlcrosses the arc
BB, at the point B,:
(c) the point -V goes to B when -If goes to .i;
(6, for any T > 0, there exists a point -If*of the arc Aril such that f o r any
path which f m t = ti crosses the segment -\f*.-i of the arc . l A I we have the
inequality t2 - tl > T.
R e t a i n i n g t h e n o t a t i ? n of t h e p r e v i o u s l e m m a , let u s c o n s i d e r a m o d i f i e d
s y s t e m (6).
F r o m t h e t h e o r e m s of t h e c o n t i n u o u s d e p e n d e n c e of t h e s o l u t i o n o n t h e
i n i t i a l c o n d i t i o n s a n d o n t h e r i g h t - h a n d s i d e and f r o m the p r e v i o u s l e m m a s ,
i t f o l l o w s t h a t t h e r e e x i s t e , > 0 a n d 8,>0 w i t h t h e f o l l o w i n g p r o p e r t i e s : i f
( A ) i s &,-close t o (D), :hen
1 ) U,,(O) c o n t a i n s o n e a n d o n l y o n e equili_brium s t a t e , t h e s a d d l e point 6:
2 ) hi a n d & are arcs w i t h o u t c o n t a c t of ( D ) ;
3) t h e r e e x i s t s e p a r a t r i c e s x:and z; of t h e s a d d l e point 6 of (6)w h i c h
cross t h e a r c s Ai a n d L! a t t h e p o i n t s a n d E , r e s p e c t i v e l y , t h e point
l y i n g o n hl i n t h e same d i r e c t i o n f r o m Al as t h e p o i n t A , and t h e point
lying on in t h e same d i r e c t i o n f r o m B1a s t h e point B ;
4 ) t h e p a t h of ( b ) p a s s i n g t h r o u g h A, c r o s s e s t h e a r c hz a t s o m e point E,
w h i c h lies on 4 i n t h e s a m e d i r e c t i o n from B a s t h e point Bl.
T h e f o l l o w i n g t w o l e m m a s a r e now s e l f - e v i d e n t .
L e m m a 12. Far any e > 0 ( E < E,) there exists 6 0 (6 <ao) such that =.
if ( E ) is 6-close to ( D ) , then
(a) ZEL'~(A), B E U ~ ( B ) BIG
, L', ( B J ;
(b) the path of ( 6 )which fm t = ti passes through some point .If of the
arc XA, icill cross the arc 12, at the point f o r t = & > t , ; -v
(c) the point R goes to E when ,M goes to x.
L e m m a 13. F o r ( I fixed T>O, let M* be a point of the arc 1, satisfying
condition (d) of L e m m a 11. Then there exists a>o such that if ( 6 )is
6 -close to ( D ), the point lies on the arc XI in the same direction f r o m
I ch.XI. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLES FROM THE LOOP OF A SADDLE-POINT SEPARATRIX I
M b a s the point A , and fm every path of (fi) crossing
the a r c h, we have the inequality z 2 - t , > T .
I
In what follows, we w i l l often r e q u i r e the p a r a m e t e r
298
S2a.CREATION O F LIMIT CYCLES F R O M THE
SEPARATRIS LOOP OF A SIhIPLE S-ADDLE P O I N T
/ $ 7
"3 Lr
and t h e point 0. T h e c u r v e Cowill b e called a
l o o p o f t h e s e p a r a t r i s Lo o r s i m p l y a
loop.
E e s i d e s the path L o , the saddle point 0 also
h a s two o t h e r s e p a r a t r i c e s L ; and L; ( e i t h e r dif-
ferent o r coincident) which both lie e i t h e r inside
t h e c u r v e C o o r outside t h i s c u r v e . \Ve will
henceforth a s s u m e , without loss of generality,
FIGC'RE 128 that t h e s e p a r a t r i c e s L; and L; lies outside t h e
c u r v e C o ( F i g u r e 1 2 8 ) . T h e c a s e when they
l i e inside the c u r v e C o is e n t i r e l y analogous.
L e ni ni a 1 . A septzvatrix forming a loop may have ot most one cowiition
point with an arc without contact.
P r o o f , Suppose a s e p a r a t r i x Lo forming a loop h a s two common
points A and B with s o m e a r c without contact 1 ( F i g u r e 1 2 9 ) . Then the
saddle point 0 should evidently lie both inside the c l o s e d c u r v e formed
b y the s e g m e n t s AB of :he path L o and t h e a r c without contact 1 and outside
t h i s c u r v e , which i s cll2arly i m p o s s i b l e . T h i s p r o v e s t h e l e m m a .
L e t z = 'pa ( t ) , y = ( t ) b e a solution c o r r e s p o n d i n g t o t h e s e p a r a t r i x
I.,,. Moancl .Vi the points of the s e p a r a t r i x c o r r e s p o n d i n g t o the times 1,
and t , . We m a y t a k e to < ti. A r c s without contact 1, and I , , without
common points, a r e drawn through the points N o and MI ( F i g u r e 130).
* 6y Theorem 23 ($18.2). 3 separ,iaix forming d loop may exist only in ri ,tructurally unstable system.
299
Ch.XI. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLES FROM THE LOOP OF A SADDLE-POINT SEPARATRIX
300
$23. CRE.4l'lOS OF L I h ! I r CYCLES FROh! A SEP.4RATRIX LOOP
h e t h e p a r a m e t r i c e q u a - i o n s of t h e arc I , . A s in t h e p r e v i o u s s e c t i o n , w e
a s s u m e t h a t g, a n d hO a r e f u n c t i o n s of class 2 . :
S u p p o s e t h a t t h e p o i n t s .!Io, A,, Bo, B c o r r e s p o n d t o t h e v a l u e s u o , a,, bo, b
of t h e p a r a m e t e r , w h e r e a, < uo < h < bo.
Let
-
zf = f ( u ) (2)
b e t h e s u c c e s s i o n f u n c t i o n o n t h e a r c M O B . In v i r t u e of t h e a b o v e a s s u m p -
t i o n , f (u)is d e f i n e d f o r all u , uo < u < b ( w e s h o u l d s t r e s s t h a t w e are d e a l i n g
w i t h a s u c c e s s i o n f u n c t i o n i n t h e d i r e c t i o n of i n c r e a s i n g t , i . e . ,
e a c h " s u c c e e d i n g " p o i n t c o r r e s p o n d s t o a l a t e r t i m e t h a n t h e t i m e of t h e
"preceding" point).
In \ + h a t f o l l o w s , w e w i l l also c o n s i d e r t h e f u n c t i o n
If a c l o s e d p a t h L* p a s s e s t h r o u g h t h e point hf* ( u * ) of t h e a r c M O B , w e
h a v e d (u*) = 0 .
If t h e r e e x i s t s u t , u, ( u , , < b , s u c h t h a t for all u , u , ( u < u l , d ( u ) #O, i.e.,
if t h e r e a r e n o c l o s e d p a t h s c r o s s i n g the a r c M O B , a t t h e p o i n t s u , u , < Z G U , ,
then
t h e l o o p i s s t a b l e ifd(u)<O,
t h e l o o p i s u n s t a b l e ifd(u)>O (5)
(for uo<ugul).
In w h a t f o l l o w s w e w i l l c o n s i d e r t h e l i m i t of t h e d e r i v a t i v e of t h e
s u c c e s s i o n f u n c t i o n f' ( ( 1 ) for u -+ u,.
Let
2 = (P.H (% Y = *.\a ( t ) (6)
b e t h e s o l u t i o n c o r r e s p o n d i n g t o t h e p a t h L p a s s i n g t h r o u g h t h e point M (u)
of t h e a r c M O B . A s b e f ' 3 r e , w e a s s u m e t h a t t h e s o l u t i o n ( 6 ) p a s s e s t h r o u g h
t h e point X for t = to a n d t h r o u g h t h e s u c c e s s o r IG (i)of M for t = T > t o .
T h e c o o r d i n a t e s of t i e p o i n t s M 0 ,M , # a n d t h e s a d d l e point 0 are
( E o . qo), ( E , tl), (E, 6), a n d (z0,y o ) , r e s p e c t i v e l y . Let, a s b e f o r e ,
00= CJ (zov YO) K YO)
(20, +QC (207 YO). (7)
[I, in particular. I o is a segment of the normdl to the pdth L,at the point M a ,rhe functions go a n d h a c a n
be t&cn in the form
go (u:.= To ( t e ) - % ( t o ) U? ho (u) = $0 ( t o ) 4-Ti 0 0 ) u.
30 I
Ch.XI. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLES FROM T H E LOOP OF A SADDLE-POINT SEPARATRlX
I
FIGURE 131
302
929. CRMTION OF L I h f f T CYCLES FROhl A SEPARATRIX LOOP
where
and
- _ _
When U - + U O , both d e t e r m i n a n t s A ( & q, u ) and A(E, q, u ) g o t o t h e s a m e non-
qo,u o ) , so that
z e r o l i m i t 4(E0,
lim -= 1.
u-uo A(:. q. u)
Clearly,
T :; T
5
10
1
1.
1
( J ( c p ~ ( t1l ,S ~ ( ( t ) ) d t = (J(T.M, $ . \ ~ ) d f f (J(T.M~$.w)dt,
1;
(13)
Lowhich p a s s e s
y = q 0 ( t ) is the solution c o r r e s p o n d i n g t o the s e p a r a t r i x
through t h e point Mo f o r t = t o . T h e f i r s t i n t e g r a l o n t h e right in (13) t h u s
g o e s t o a finite limit.
Let u s c o n s i d e r t h e second integral, i . e . ,
5
1;
(J (TM (0, $M ( t ) )dt.
303
Ch. XI. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLES FROkl THE LOOP OF A SADDLE-POINT SEPARATRIX
lim
M+Mo
i u (9.M( t ) , +Ar ( t ) )d t = - oo, T. e. f (u)40.
t h e l o o p i s s t a b l e ford(u)>O,
t h e l o o p i s u n s t a b I e ford(u)<O (14)
=-
( f o r uo u > u i ) .
W e a r e now in a position to d e r i v e a sufficient condition of stability
(instability) of a s e p a r a t r i x loop.
T h e o r e m 4 4 . Let 0 ( x 0 , yo) be a saddle point of the dynumic system
xd r= P ( z , v), $-=QQz,Y),
(D)
and L, its separatrix which together with the saddle point 0 f o m s the
loop C , . Then, if u, = P; ( x o , yo) + Q; (x,, yo) > 0, the loop is unstable, and if
u0 < 0, the loop is stable.
P r o o f . Let u s f i r s t consider the c a s e when the succession function is
defined for u c l o s e to u,, but g r e a t e r than u,. Let u o > 0 . In virtue of (4),
lim d (u) = 0.
UUO
lim f ( u ) =
U-tUO
+ 03.
304
T h e r e f o r e , t h e r e e x i s t s u t s u c h t h a t for all u , u a < u < u l ,
a
o n e i n s i d e t h e o t h e r , F i g u r e s 132 a n d 1331, t h e n for n,:,O b o t h l o o p s a r e
u n s t a b l e , a n d for oo < 0 b o t h l o o p s a r e s t a b l e .
/
-
R e m a r k 2 . T h e o r e m 44 is c o n c e r n e d w i t h t h e case uo = Pi (zo.go) +
A Q&(ro.yo)# 0 . We w i l l now s h o w t h a t if oo = 0, t h e r e m a y b e cases w h e n
a n a r b i t r a r i l y s m a l l n e i g h b o r h o o d of t h e l o o p c o n t a i n s c l o s e d p a t h s , as
w e l l as cases w h e n t h e l o o p is s t a b l e o r u n s t a b l e .
E x a m p 1e 11. C o n s i d e r t h e s y s t e m
-d -i 2 g = P , ( z , g), $=i123-39=Q1(*, Y),
dt (D1)
305
Ch-XI. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLES FROM THE LOOP OF A SADDLE-POINT SEPARATRIX
2 = 6sz-2 + C,
which can b e constructed without difficulty. C u r v e s ( 1 7 ) a r e shown i n
Figure 134. C = 0 corresponds t o the curve with a loop. For C > 0,
curve ( 1 7 ) c o m p r i s e s a single branch
located outside the loop. For O>C>-32,
the curve c o n s i s t s of two branches.
One of these b r a n c h e s lies to the left
of the y axis, and the other branch is
an oval enclosed inside the loop. For
C = - 3 2 , the c u r v e c o m p r i s e s a branch
I lying in the left half-plane and the
point O1 ( 4 , 0). Finally f o r C < - 3 2 ,
the c u r v e h a s a single branch in the
left half-plane. Each of the c u r v e s
-
( 1 7 ) is either a path of s y s t e m (D1)
(for C; 0 and C < -32). o r c o n s i s t s
I (I! I
of two (for O > C>-32) o r f o u r ( f o r
C = 0) paths. System (D1) h a s two
equilibrium states: 0 ( 0 , O ) and
Oi(4,O). The f i r s t of these equi-
FIGURE 134 librium s t a t e s is a saddle point, with
two of i t s s e p a r a t r i c e s forming the
loop L , , and the second is a c e n t e r .
H e r e uo (0, 0) = Pi= (0, 0)+Qiu (0, 0) = 0, i . e., we a r e dealing with the
c a s e u,, = 0, and any neighborhood of the loop contains closed paths.
Together with s y s t e m (Dl), let u s now consider the s y s t e m
It is directly verified that the four paths of the s y s t e m (D1) making the
curve
2?-6s* + ya= 0 (20)
307
Ch.XI. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLES FROM THE LOOP OF A SADDLE-POINT SEPARATRIX
FIGURE 135
308
LIhlIT CYCLES FRO:,I A SEPMRATFUX LOOP
L ern m a 8. There exist eo > (3 and a,, > 0 which satisfy the following
conditions: i f ( 6 )is&-close to(D),and;; < 5,(L; >E,), all the paths of (8)
crossing the segment .+i& of the arc I , w i l l leave the e,-neighbmhood of
the loop L o as t increases (decreases).
P r oof .T h e validitv of L e m m a 8 follows d i r e c t l y f r o m the p r o p e r t i e s
of the paths of s y s t e m (fi) which c r o s s the segment -@,.qiof the a r c without
contact & ( s e e F i g u r e s 135 and 137), if w e u s e L e m m a 3 of t h i s section and
a l s o L e m m a s 9 and 10 of 5 2 8 . 2 .
We c a n now prove one of the fundamental t h e o r e m s , t h e so-called
t h e o r e m of c r e a t i o n o f a c l o s e d p a t h f r o m a s e p a r a t r i x
Zoo p . It e s t a b l i s h e s sufficient conditions f o r the appearance of a closed
path when a s e p a r a t r i x loop d i s a p p e a r s ( b r e a k s ) .
Let 0 be a saddle point of a dynamic s y s t e m (D), L o i t s s e p a r a t r i x which
f o r m s a loop. H e r e , 1,. 2;. L;-,u,,&, A , . B o . a,, bo, b , etc., have the s a m e
meaning a s before; m o r e o v e r , a , -== bo and the point Bo lies i n s i d e the
loop ( F i g u r e 135 o r 1 3 7 ) .
T h e o r e m 45. Let the loop fmtned by the separatrix L o of the saddle
point 0 be stable (unstable). Then, f o r any F > 0 , there exists 8 > 0 such
that i f ( 8 )is 8-close to ( D ) and if 5,< Z ; (Z0 > L;), then in the e-neighbm-
hood of the loop there exists at least m e closed path E* of (8)
uhich crosses
the arc without contact L,, at the point .\f* (u*), where
- <u'<
ug (ii<u* < b).
b
309
CheXI. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLES FROM THE LOOP OF A SADDLE-POINT SEPAKATIUX
-
T ( n , ) = nz < n,.
310
f2Q. CRE.ATI@X OF LIhlIT CYCLES FROLI A SEPARATRIX L O O P
31 I
Ch.XI. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLES FROM THE LOOP OF A SADDLE-POINT SEPARATIUX
312
$'7?. CRE.4TI31. OF LI!,fIT CYCLES FRO>,I .A SEP.IR;\TRIX LOOP
J= I, o(cfo(t), *to(t))dt.
10
T o g e t h e r w i t h t h e s y s t e m ( D ) , w e w i l l now c o n s i d e r m o d i f i e d s y s t e n i s ( 6 ) .
L e t 6 , > 0 b e a n u m b e r s a t i s f y i n g the f o l l o w i n g c o n d i t i o n : if (6)is
6 , - c l o s e t o ( D ) , t h e n at e v e r y p o i n t .\I@, y) of r , , ( O ) we h a v e
b) 1s 6(4;*(t).
1:
to
$*(t))dll<:2x;
lo TIC
J*= \ o ( ( ~ * ($ f* )( t.) ) d t .
;0
We h a v e
t: toLr
J*= G ( t p * ( t ) ,$ * ( f ) ) d t f j o ( & * ( t )$, * ( t ) ) d f .
:0 1:
313
Ch.XI. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLES FROM THE LOOP OF A SADDLE-POIN'I SEPARATRIX
By condition (b), the first integral on the right is g r e a t e r than -22. The
second integral is g r e a t e r than 9 (to+z--t:) by inequality ( 2 6 ) . Therefore
I
or, by condition ( a ) I
314
52'. CRE.'ITIOE; OF LLh'LT CYCLES FROhl A SEP.4RATMX L O O P
T h e o r e m 46, t h e r e e x i s t s a s y s t e m ( D ) a r b i t r a r i l y c l o s e t o ( E ) w h i c h h a s
a . c l o s e d p a t h io i n a n y a r b i t r a r i l y small n e i g h b o r h o o d of t h e l o o p &,. If
i s s u f f i c i e n t l y . c l o s e to ( E ) , t h e n i n v i r t u e of t h e s t r u c t u r a l s t a b i l i t y
ol t h e c y c l e E l , ( D ) may' h a v e a l i m i t cycle e,. which is a r b i t r a r i l y close t o
t h e c,ycle El, w h i l e t h e two c y c l e s e, a n d il d o not c o i n c i d e a n d a r e b o t h
c o n t a i n e d i n t h e e - n e i g h ? o r h o o d of t h e l o o p L o . B u t t h i s a g a i n c o n t r a d i c t s
T h e o r e m 45.
We w i l l p r o v e a n o t h e r p r o p o s i t i o n Lvhich, i n a s e n s e , s u p p l e m e n t s
T h e o r e m 15,
T h e o r e m 49. If the separatrix L , of the saddle point 9 ( x , , yo) of
systein ( 0 )forms a looi? and U, (I,, yo) > 0 (4), there exist e > oand 6 > 0
with the folloiringpropc~rty: any system ( 6 )which is 6-close to ( D i and
f o r which iTo < G; (cowespondingly, Lo> Lo)has no closed paths in r J e (Lo).
P r o n f . To fix i d e a s , l e t u s c o n s i d e r t h e case uo (to,yo) < 0 . In t h i s
c a s e , t h e l o o p f o r m e d b y t h e s e p a r a t r i x L,, i s s t a b l e (s29.1, T h e o r e m 44).
Let e , > 0 a n d 6, > 0 b e t h e n u m b e r s d e f i n e d b y T h e o r e m 4 7 .
I . C o n s i d e r a point .!I1 (u,)of t h e a r c l o , w h e r e u t > u o . If t h e point M I
is s u f f i c i e n t l y close t o .lIo, t h e p a t h L 1 p a s s i n g t h r o u g h t h i s p o i n t for 1 = to
w i l l c r o s s t h e a r c l o a g a i n a t point .Yl a s t i n c r e a s e s . Let Cl b e a s i m p l e
c l o s e d c u r v e f o r m e d b y t h e s e g m e n t JI,.Y, of t h e p a t h L1 a n d t h e s e g m e n t
.\.IJfIof t h e a r c I , . U'e c h o o s e u, i n s u c h a w a y t h a t t h e f o l l o w i n g c o n d i t i o n s
are satisfied:
( a ) t h e c u r v e C1, a n d t h e r i n g r e g i o n e n c l o s e d b e t w e e n t h e l o o p of t h e
s e p a r a t r i x L o a n d t h e c u r v e CI a r e c o n t a i n e d i n C.?,(L0);
!bJ d ( u , ) < o .
R n t h c o n d i t i o n s are c l e a r l y s a t i s f i e d i f u I is s u f f i c i e n t l y close to u,(the
s e c o n d c o n d i t i o n h o l d s t r u e i n v i r t u e of o u r a s s u m p t i o n t h a t t h e l o o p is
stable).
11. W e c h o o s e 61 > 0 s o small t h a t if s y s t e m (6)is 6 , - c l o s e t o ( D ) , t h e
following conditions are s a t i s f i e d :
i c ) d"(u,)<O;
( d ) t h e c u r v e El a n d t h e r e g i o n b e t w e e n t h i s c u r v e a n d t h e l o o p of
s e p a r a t r i x Lo a r e c o n t a i n e d i n ( L o ) ( t h e f u n c t i o n d" is a n a l o g o u s t o d ,
a n d C?, i s t h e c u r v e p a s s i n g t h r o u g h M iw h i c h i s a n a l o g o u s t o Cl; F i g u r e 140).
FLCCQE 140
(e, E,<?:
315
Ch.XI. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLES FROM THE LOOP OF A SADDLE-POINT SEPARATRIX
(f) i f(a) is &-close to (D), the curve i?, and the region enclosed by
t h i s c u r v e do not i n t e r s e c t with U s 2 ( L o ) .
IV. We choose e3 > 0 and 63> 0 s o that the following conditions a r e
satisfied :
(g) e3<%;
(h) i f (0)is 6,-close t o (D), and xis a closed path of (b) contained in
U e 3( L o ) , the pathzc r o s s e s the a r c without contact lo a t point M ( L ) , where
<> La(&is the valce of the p a r a m e t e r corresponding t o the point Ma).
T h e existence of the numbers e3 and 8,follows f r o m the fact that i f (b)
is sufficiently c l o s e to (D) and moreover u< Loo, the closed path should
enclose the saddle point 6 and, with it, all of i t s s e p a r a t r i c e s . But then
i t cannot b e contained in a sufficiently s m a l l neighborhood of the loop.
We will prove that the n u m b e r s
and which h a s a closed path in U.(L,). Let this path c r o s s the a r c without
contact I , at point h?(ii).
F r o m ( 2 9 ) and conditions ( f ) and ( h ) it follows, a s is readily seen, that
;l(u2)< 0 (34)
in virtue of inequality ( 3 0 ) .
It follows f r o m ( 3 2 ) , (33), and ( 3 4 ) that e i t h e r the function d (u)h a s at
l e a s t one m o r e root ;*, u p <*; < u,, b e s i d e s the root E, o r z(ii)
= 0 . If
the first alternative is t r u e , a closed path z* of (b) will p a s s through the
point a* (;*); in virtue of condition (d), t h i s path is contained in U, (La),
i . e., t h i s neighborhood contains a t l e a s t two closed paths. T h i s c l e a r l y
contradicts the choice of eo > 0 and 6o > 0 .
If the second alternative is true, the closed path z
is not a s i m p l e
liAmitcycle. But then, by T h e o r e m 19, 5 15.2, t h e r e e x i s t s a s y s t e m
(D) a r b i t r a r i l y c l o s e t o (E), and in p a r t i c u l a r &-close t o ( D ) , which h a s
a t l e a s t two closed paths in U, (La), and t h i s again contradicts the choice
of 8o and eo. Q. E. D.
316
929. CREATION OF LIhlIT CYCLES FRO41 .4 SEPARATMX LOOP
317
Ch-XI. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLES FROM THE LOOP OF A SADDLE-POINT SEPARATRIX
dx
x=Pa-pQa = v x + P ~ (I,Y)- u r - (Y -a) Y+ Qz (z,Y)I =Paw ( ~ v),
9
(Dab)
$ = Qa + p p a = -( v - a ) Y +~z,I( Y) + P ~ ~ z + p z Y)I =Vow
(2, ( ~ Y)*
7
ug (a*,0) = u; (a*,
O), (37)
i . e., the s e p a r a t r i c e s Lf.0 and L&.o m e r g e into a single s e p a r a t r i x of ( D o * )
which f o r m s a loop. Clearly, f o r any e > 0 and 6 > 0 and f o r a sufficiently
s m a l l a*, (D,,) is & c l o s e t o ( D ) , and t h i s loop is contained in U,(L,), which
proves the l e m m a .
2 ) T h e r e e x i s t s f3> 0, such that f o r all a, 0 < a < p, e i t h e r
318
$29. CREATION OF LIkIIT CYCLES FRO!.' .4 SEP.%R.\TRIX L O P
uo(a*,p*) = u; (a*.p').
T h i s m e a n s that the s y s t e m
ddtl
-= VZ+-~Z(Z, Y)-p*I-(v-aa*)yr42(J, Y)I,
(Dr;t&A*)
2
-= -( v - a * ) y+Qa (I, Y) + P* I v z f P , Y)I
(1,
(0,0)iQn+p+u(0, 0 ) =a*.
T h i s completes the proc>f of the l e m m a .
T h e o r e m 50. Let o(to.yo) be a saddle point of dynamic system (D),
and L , its separatyix f o m i i n g a loop. if oo ( x 0 , yo) = 0, then for any e oand =-
6 > 0 there exists a modified system ( 6 )which i s 6-close to ( D ) and which
has at least two closed paths in the e-neighbmhocd of the loop L o .
Proof . For simplicity, l e t I,
= yo = 0 . If any neighborhood of the
loop Lo contains closed paths, ( D ) itself may be chosen as (6). It thus
suffices t o consider the c a s e when s o m e neighborhood of the loop Locon-
t a i n s no closed paths, i.e., the loop Lo is e i t h e r stable o r unstable. Let
lo b e a n a r c without contact passing through the point M o of the loop Lo, u
a p a r a m e t e r defined on I , , ~0 the value of t h i s p a r a m e t e r corresponding
t o hio. W e a s s u m e , a s before, that the points of the a r c lo which lie
inside the loop correspond to u , u0 < u g b o , and the succession function
319
Ch-XI. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLES FROM T H E LOOP OF A SADDLE-POIhT SEPARATRIX
-
u = f (u) of ( D ) on the a r c lo is defined for all u ,u,, < u Q 6, where b < b o .
Since b y assumption the loop Lo of (D) is unstable, w e s e e that f o r u g r e a t e r
than u,, and sufficiently c l o s e t o u0 the following inequality is satisfied:
FIGURE 141.
11. Let q be the distance between the c u r v e C, and the s e p a r a t r i x loop Lo.
We choose 6 , > 0 so s m a l l that the following conditions a r e satisfied:
tl
(a)
(b) If (B) is 6,-close to (D), then
and c u r v e -
- t h e analog of C, is contained i n U,,,'(C)and a l s o in UE,' (0.
( c ) If ( 6 )is 6,-close t o (D) and fi, (Lo)is the intersection point of the
corresponding s e p a r a t r i x z, with t h e a r c without contact io, we have < ut
and_the s u c c e s s i o n function F(u) of (b) on the a r c lo is defined f o r all
ur ~ o < U < u f .
111. We choose p* and a* s o t h a t the following conditions are satisfied:
(a) T h e s y s t e m (D&,,,,) considered i n L e m m a 10 is 6-close to (D).
(b) T h e s e p a r a t r i x Eo of the saddle point 0 of (De,,,*) f o r m s a s t a b l e
loop, which is e n t i r e l y contained both in U t / , (Lo)and i n UnlC(Lo).
T h e existence of t h e n u m b e r s p* and a+ satisfying conditions (a) and (b)
h a s been established i n t h e proof t o L e m m a 10, In p a r t i c u l a r , f o r the
loop z, t o b e stable, we should have a*< 0 .
320
$2'). CREATION OF LIhlIT CYCLES FROhl A SEP.AR-1TfUX LOOP
d (u*)= 0,
32 1
C h a p t e r XII
INTRODUCTION
322
5 :30. CRI:\TION OF L I l l I T CYCLE FROhl SEPAR.4TRIX LOOP
c n n r a c t w a s d e f i n e d i n C h a p t e r VI11 ( s 2 2 ) . In $31, a d e f i n i t i o n of t h e s e
s y s t e m s is g i v e n for a n y b o u n d e d r e g i o n , a n d t h e n e c e s s a r y a n d s u f f i c i e n t
c o n d i t i o n s a r e e s t a b l i s n e d f o r t h e s y s t e m t o be of t h e first d e g r e e of s t r u c -
t u r a l instability in that region ( T h e o r e m 67). T h e s e conditions are then
a p p l i e d t o i n v e s t i g a t e t i e b i f u r c a t i o n s of s y s t e m s of t h e f i r s t d e g r e e of
s t r u c t u r a l i n s t a b i l i t y . A11 t h e s e b i f u r c a t i o n s t u r n o u t t o b e p a r t i c u l a r cases
of t h e b i f u r c a t i o n s c o n s i d e r e d i n t h e p r e v i o u s c h a p t e r s a n d i n 5 30.
930. C R E A T I O N O F A L I M I T C Y C L E F R O M T H E
LOOP O F A S A D D L E - N O D E S E P A R A T R I X
We c o n s i d e r a n a n a l y t i c a l d y n a m i c s y s t e m
Lvhich h a s a n e q u i l i b r i u m s t a t e yo) of m u l t i p l i c i t y 2 of t h e s a d d l e - n o d e
t y p e , w i t h o n e of t h e c h a r a c t e r i s t i c n u m b e r s d i f f e r e n t f r o m z e r o . Without
l n a s nf g e n e r a l i t y , w e m a y a s s u m e t h a t t h i s e q u i l i b r i u m s t a t e is at t h e
o r i g i n , i . e . , JO = y o = 0 . T h u s ,
and
Q;( 0 , 0 )# 0.
Is (0, 0)= P; (0, 0 ) i-
E q u i l i b r i u m s t a t e s of t h i s t y p e w e r e c o n s i d e r e d i n C h a p t e r 1.111 ( $ 2 3 ,
1 and 2 ) . X c a n o n i c a l n e i g h b o r h o o d of s u c h a s t a t e c o n s i s t s of o n e p a r a b o l i c
sector a n d t w o hypet+bol.ic s e c t o r s . S u p p o s e t h a t t h e p a t h s of t h e p a r a b o l i c
s e c t o r g o t o 0 for t -r f 00. T h e n t h e e q u i l i b r i u m state 0 h a s o n e a - s e p a r a t r i u
L; a n d t w o a - s e p a r a t r i c e s L ; a n d L ; .
S u p p o s e r h a t t h e p a t h L o , f r o m w h i c h t h e s e p a r a t r i x L; i s
c u t o u t , g o e s t o t h e e q u i l i b r i u m s t a t e 0 for t - + - ~ ,
a s w e 1 1 a s f o r t -+ -- m , i . e ,, i t f o r m s a loop. W e m o r e o v e r a s s u m e
t h a t n o n e of t h e s e p a r a t r i c e s L ; a n d L; forms p a r t of t h i s l o o p ( i . e ., t h e
s e p a r a t r i x L; d o e s not merge i n t o a single p a t h e i t h e r w i t h L : o r with L f ,
see F i g u r e 1 4 2 ) .
S i n c e 0 i s a n e q u i l i b r i u m state of m u l t i p l i c i t y 2, t h e r e e x i s t 6*>0 a n d
cd= 0 s u c h t h a t i f s y s t e m (6)is &,-close t o ( D ) t o r a n k 2 , i t h a s a t m o s t t w o
e q u i l i b r i u m s t a t e s i n U,,(O) (see D e f i n i t i o n 15, $ 7 . 3 a n d D e f i n i t i o n 5, $ 2 . 1 ) .
T h u s , t h r e e cases are p o s s i b l e a p r i o r i :
1) S y s t e m (6)h a s o n e e q u i l i b r i u m s t a t e d i n U,,(0).
2 ) S y s t e m (A) h a s t w o e q u i l i b r i u m s t a t e s G, a n d G2i n U., (0).
3 ) S y s t e m ( 6 )h a s n o e q u i l i b r i u m s t a t e s i n U,, (0).
A11 t h e t h r e e cases a r e a c t u a l l y o b s e r v e d in pr_actice: cases 2 a n d 3 i n
v i r t u e of T h e o r e m 3 4 , $ 2 3 . 1 ; case 1 o b t a i n s i f ( D ) is i d e n t i f i e d w i t h ( D )
itself, say.
323
a.XU. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLE FROM LOOP OF SADDLE-NODE SEPARAIRIX
FIGURE 144
324
$ 30. CREATION OF LLhlIT CYCLE FROhI SEP.4R.ATRIX L 3 0 P
t h e a r c w i t h o u t c o n t a c t I , , t h e s e g m e n t JItAI;of t h e a r c w i t h o u t c o n t a c t 1 ,
a n d t h e a r c s Ml+%I; of r h e p a t h s Lol a n d Lo? is a n e l e m e n t a r y
a n d JIlc-1I.~
q u a d r a n g l e c o n t a i n e d i n t h e e / 2 - n e i g h b o r h o o d of t h e l o o p Lo. S i n c e t h e
p a t h L o crosses t h e a r c s without c o n t a c t lo a n d 1 a t t h e i r i n t e r i o r p o i n t s
.\To a n d So, t h i s c o n d i t i o n is s a t i s f i e d w h e n e v e r the a r c lo is s u f f i c i e n t l y
small.
L e t 6: 0 b e so s m a l l t h a t i f (6) is 6 - c l o s e to (D), t h e n
( a ) t h e a r c s lo a n d 2 are a r c s w i t h o u t c o n t a c t for (6);
(b) the paths zol and of (b) w h i c h f o r t = fo p a s s t h r o u g h t h e p o i n t s 11.11
and r e s p e c t i v e l y , cross, w i t h i n c r e a s i n g t , t h e a r c t a t t h e p o i n t s JY;
a n d .%?;, and t h e r e s u l t i n g q u a d r a n g l e a ( t h e a n a l o g of A ) i s a n e l e m e n t a r y
q u a d r a n g l e of (fi) c o n t a i n e d i n U, ( & ) ( F i g u r e 145);
( c , as t d e c r e a s e s , t h e paths zol a n d Eo*c r o s s t h e a r c 1 a t p o i n t s g , a n d
Et,a n d t h e n e i g h b o r h o o d of t h e point 0, d e l i m i t e d by t h e a r c without
c o n t a c t lor t h e s e g m e n t Elk2 of t h e a r c I , and t h e a r c s of p a t h s WIMl a n d
i?J12> i s c o n t a i n e d i n U ,( L o ) .
FICLiRE 145
C o n d i t i o n s ( a ) , ( b ) , a n d ( c ) are s a t i s f i e d for a s u f f i c i e n t l y s m a l l 6 in
v i r t u e of L e m m a s 1 a n d 5 of 3 4 . 1 a n d L e m m a 7 of 3 4 . 2 .
W e w i l l s h o w t h a t t h e n u m b e r 6 s e l e c t e d in t h i s w a y f u l f i l l s t h e p r o -
p o s i t i o n of t h e t h e o r e m .
L e t (6)b e a s v s t e m 6 - c l o s e to (D) w h i c h h a s no e q u i l i b r i u m states i n
U, (0). L e t 6' b e t h e u n i o n of t h e s e t s and ( t h e s e s e t s are a s s u m e d t o
b e closed). Evidently, i s a c l o s e d n e i g h b o r h o o d of the l o o p L o , a n d i n
rv
v i r t u e of ( b ) a n d ( c ) c U, ( L o ) . W e d e f i n e a p a r a m e t e r u o n t h e a r c lo,
s o t h a t t h e e n d p o i n t s Mr a n d MI of t h e arc c o r r e s p o n d to t h e v a l u e s ul a n d
u: o f t h e p a r a m e t e r , u1 < L:~. C o n s i d e r a n y point hi fu) of t h e a r c lo (ul4 u g u - )
and t h e path of s y s t e m (8)t h r o u g h t h a t p o i n t . As t i n c r e a s e s , t h i s p a t h
crosses t h e a r c w i t h o u t c o n t a c t 1 a t some point $of t h e a r c I a n d e n t e r s
into t h e neighborhood v. Since t h e r e are n o e q u i l i b r i u m s t a t e s , and t h u s
n o l i m i t c o n t i n u a of (E), in P, t h e p a t h should leave v a s f f u r t h e r i n c r e a s e s .
325
Ch-XII. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLE FROM LOOP OF SADDLE-NODE SEPARATRIX
u* = r(u)
e c iii c u, (Lo).
T h i s proves the t h e o r e m .
We shall saythat t h e c l o s e d p a t h i i s c r e a t e d f r o m t h e
l o o p o f t h e s e p a r a t r i x Lo o f t h e s a d d l e - n o d e O .
R e m a r k . T h e o r e m 5 1 and the above proof r e m a i n valid i f the point 0
is a n y e q u i l i b r i u m s t a t e o f m u l t i p l i c i t y 4 ( a n d not only 2 )
f o r w h i c h c o n d i t i o n s 1 a n d 2 a r e s a t i s f i e d (thisequilibrium
s t a t e is a l s o a saddle-node, see $23.2, a ) .
2. T h e uniqueness t h e o r e m
W e will prove the uniqueness of the closed path created f r o m the loop of
a saddle-node s e p a r a t r i x . As in the previous subsection, w e consider an
equilibrium s t a t e 0 (0, 0) of multiplicity 4 which satisfies conditions 1 and 2,
i . e . , a saddle-node, and the path Lo f r o m which the a - s e p a r a t r i x L; is cut
out f o r m s a loop, without merging with either of the o - s e p a r a t r i c e s L: and L:.
L e m m a . Let M o be a point of the path Lor and lo an arc without contact
through M o for which Mois not an end point. There exist E, > 0 and bo > 0
such that if(b) is 8,-close to (D), and L is a closed path of (6)contained in
u., (to),t mosses the arc I , at one and only one point.
P r o o f . It is readily s e e n that i f the proposition of the l e m m a is t r u e
f o r any sufficiently s m a l l a r c I , cut out f r o m s o m e fixed arc without contact
which c r o s s e s the path Lo, it is a l s o t r u e f o r any fixed a r c without contact
I,(see L e m m a 7, 8 4.2). By assumption, u (0.0) = P; (0,O) +
Q; (0,O) # O .
T o fix ideas, let
u(O,O)=uO>O.
Let e > 0 b e s o s m a l l that f o r any point ( x , y), (2, y) c U, (0), u (z, I/) > 0.
Consider the canonical neighborhood V and the e l e m e n t a r y quadrangle A of
(P) described in the previous subsection (in o u r proof of Theorem 51), and
a l s o the canonica1 neighborhood f and the quadrangle of t h e c l o s e s y s t e m
(fi), alongside with t h e i r union i?. Let V c U ,(0).A s Io we choose the a r c
without contact M i M z entering the boundary of V ( F i g u r e s 144 and 145).
Choose b o > 0 and^,> 0 so that i f (6)is bo-close t o ( D ) , the following
conditions a r e satisfied:
(a) I o i s an a r c without contact for (b);
(b) f o r any point ( x , Y)EW) ,
(c) rcc',(0!(
Id) re0(Lo)cli'.
T h e s e c o n d i t i o n s a r e e v i d e n t l y s a t i s f i e d f o r s i i f f i c i e n t l y small e, a n d 60.
L e t E b e a c l o s e d pE.th of s y s t e m ( D ) w h i c h i s 6 0 - c I o s e t o ( D ) , a n d l e t
i c C'&* ( L o ) . T h e n , b y ( c ) , L c lT'.
If t h e p a t h is e n t i r e l y c o n t a i n e d i n r?, it is c o n t a i n e d i n U , (0). Ey
c o n d i t i o n ( b ) a n d F e n d i . s s a n ' s c r i t e r i o n (QT, 5 12.3, T h e o r e m 31, c o r o l l a r y ) ,
s v v t c r n (PI h a s no closed pat& w h i c h a r e e n t i r e l y c o n t a i n e d i n U, (0).
T h e r e f o r e , t h e c l o s e d [path L h a s p o i n t s w h i c h l i e i n t h e q u a d r a n g l e 3 .
T h e n , b y t h e p r o p e r t i e ; of e l e m e n t a r y q u a d r a n g l e s , t h e p a t h crosses
t h e a r c lo (at o n e a n d o n l y o n e point, b y c o n d i t i o n ( a ) ) . T h e a r c without
c o n t a c t In clearly c a n b e c h o s e n as small as d e s i r e d i n t h i s case.
T h p p r o o f of t h e 1 e r . m a is c o m p l e t e .
T h e o r e vi 52. Let 0 (0. 0 ) be a saddle-node of a dynamic system ( D )
for which cl0 = o (0. 0)+ 0 , and Lo a separutrix of this saddle-node foviriing
a loop.
Tnere exist ttco nuwbers e > Oand 6 > 0 such that i f ( f i i , is 6-close to ( D ) ,
it may have at most ont? closed path in U e ( L ~ ) . If this closed path exists, it
is a stable strrtctiirally stable limit cycle for 0, < 0 and an unstable struc-
turally stable limit cycle f o r (J>,0.
P r o o f . C o n s i d e r t h e case o o > O .
L e t E" > 0 b e so s m a l l t h a t f o r e v e r y point (I,y) E U q (0)w e h a v e
.,
L e t I , I o . i - , A , it', F, e c h e t h e a r c s w i t h o u t c o n t a c t , t h e c a n o n i c a l
n e i g h b o r h o o d s , t h e e l e m e n t a r y q u a d r a n g l e s , e t c ., c o n s i d e r e d i n t h e p r e -
v i o u s s u b s e c t i o n ( F i g u r t t s 114 a n d 1 4 5 ) . Let t h e c a n o n i c a l n e i g h b o r h o o d 1'
h e SO s m a l l t h a t
a n d l e t A b e t h e c o r r e s F o n d i n g e l e m e n t a r y q u a d r a n g l e of (D) ( F i g u r e 1 4 6 ) .
C h o o s e 6 , > 0 so s m a l l t h a t if (b) i s &-close to (D), t h e f o l l o w i n g c o n d i -
t i o n s are s a t i s f i e d :
( a ) The a r c s L a n d 1, ,ire a r c s without c o n t a c t for the p a t h s of s y s t e m (6).
( b ) T h e c a n o n i c a l n e i g h b o r h o o d F c o r r e s p o n d i n g t o (6)l i e s i n U 4 (LO)
t o g e t h e r with i t s c l o s u r e .
( c ) T h e p a t h s of (fi) p a s s i n g t h r o u g h t h e p o i n t s of t h e a r c I , cross t h e
a r c 1 w i t h t h e i n c r e a s e i n t , a n d t h e s e g m e n t s of_these p a t h s c o n f i n e d b e t w e e n
t h e arcs I, and 1 form an e l e m e n t a r y quadrangle A
( d ) For all (3, Y) E U,(O). z(z, Y) > 3 .
L e t iP be t h e u n i o n of t h e s e t s a n d 5 . W e c h o o s e e l , 0 < el < so
s m a l l t h a t for a n y set FF c o r r e s p o n d i n g t o a s y s t e m (B) 8,-close to ( D ) ,
we have
T h e e x i s t e n c e of t h e a p p r o p r i a t e 8 , a n d el i s s e l f - e v i d e n t .
L e t k h e a c l o s e d p a t h of s y s t e m (E) w h i c h i s 6 , - c l o s e to (D!: a n d l e t
c U,, ( L o ) . Then, b y (5), E c iv = FU 5 . We w i l l s h o w t h a t the p a t h
327
Ch.XII. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLE FROM LOOP OF SADDLE-NODE SEPARATRIX
FIGURE 146
Let
x = Po ( t ) , Y = $0 (4 (6)
J= $'
11
(cpo ( t ) , $0 ( t ) ) +Q;(To (t), $0 (tNl d t . (7)
328
5 30. CRE4TIO?: OF LlhlLT CYCLE FRO\I SEPIR-\TRIX LOOP
t t +c< ti A T (11)
( w e recall t h a t 7 is t h e p e r i o d of t h e p a t h E).
3)
tr
T h e l a s t e q u a l i t y is s a t i s f i e d for s u f f i c i e n t l y small 6 a n d E i n v i r t u e of ( 8 ) .
Let 8 and e b e c h o s e n so that conditions 1 t h r o u g h 3 are s a t i s f i e d . L e t
u s e s t i m a t e the number
'? -
By ( 1 2 ) , \ odt>-2~. Tt f o l l o w s from c o n d i t i o n 1 t h a t all t h e p o i n t s of t h e
i,
path 2 corresponding t o t2<t<t,+? a r e c o n t a i n e d i n CeO(O). T h e r e f o r e , b y
( 5 ) a n d (11).
H e n c e a n d f r o m i n e q u a l i t y ( 9 ) it f o l l o w s t h a t h ; 0, i . e., t h e c l o s e d p a t h
of (6) i s a n u n s t a b l e s t r u c t u r a l l y s t a b l e l i m i t c y c l e (913.3, Theorem 1 7 ,
214, T h e o r e m 18).
W e h a v e t h u s e s t a b l i s h e d t h a t a n y c l o s e d p a t h of s y s t e m (6)6 - c l o s e
to ( D ) w h i c h lies i n U ,(Lo) is an u n s t a b l e limit c y c l e . B u t t h e n , (6)c a n
h a v e a t m o s t o n e c l o s e d p a t h i n U, ( L , ) ( s e e t h e e n d of t h e p r o o f t o
T h e o r e m 47, 9 2 9 . 3 ) .
T h e case oo< O i s c o n s i d e r e d a l o n g t h e same l i n e s . T h e t h e o r e m
i s proved.
329
Ch.XI1. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLE FROM LOOP OF SADDLE-NODE SEPARATRIX
330
531. aisrtvs OF T H E FIRST DEGREE OF ~ T R L ~ C T L RI ~N LT ~ B I L I T I
T h e m e a n i n g of thiz s o m e w h a t c l u m s y d e f i n i t i o n c a n b e e l u c i d a t e d as
f o l l o w s : (.A) i s a s v s t e m of t h e f i r s t d e g r e e of s t r u c t u r a l i n s t a b i l i t v i n f i . if
i t i s s t r u c t u r a l l y u n s t z b l e i n W , w h e r e a s a n y s u f f i c i e n t l v close s y s t e m (XI
i s e i t h e r s t r i t c t u r a l l y s t a b l e i n W , o r (41 and ( A , h a v e p a t h p a r t i t i o n s of
t h e s a m e ? o p o l o g i c a l s t r u c t u r e i n c e r t a i n n e i g h b o r h o o d s of Ii', a n d t h e
t r a n s f o r m a t i o n f r o m o n e p a r t i t i o n to a n o t h e r c a n b e i m p l e m e n t e d b y a n
at,bir r a r i l v small t r a n s l a t i o n .
W e n-ill now deriL-e t h e n e c e s s a r y c o n d i r i o n s s a t i s f i e d b y a n y s y s t e m
of chc f i r s t d e g r e e of s t r u c t u r a l i n s t a b i l i t y . T h e i r d e r i v a t i o n i s b a s i c a l l y
a n a l o g o u s t o t h e d e r i v a t i o n of t h e n e c e s s a r y c o n d i t i o n s of s t r u c t u r a l
s t a b i l i t y o f a s y s t e m : t h i s is a n a t u r a l a n d r e l a t i v e l y s i m p l e d e r i v a t i o n ,
but it r e q u i r e s a n e x a m i n a t i o n of n u m e r o u s a l t e r n a t i v e s .
T h r o u g h o u t t h e r e m a i n i n g p a r t of t h i s s e c t i o n , ( A ) i s a s y s t e m o f
t h e f i r a t d e g r e e o f s t r u c t u r a l i n s t a b i l i t y i n it- i n t h e
3 f ? n s e of P e f i n i t i o n 30.
33 I
Ch.X[I. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLE FROM LOOP OF SADDLE-NODE SEPARATRIX I
Then they c a n be written in the f o r m
P*=Pi(%,~ ) . R ( IY),
, Q*=Qi(st Y).R(I, g),
and
p(G Y) = PiRi =P* (2,Y) 4-Pi (2,Y) (w+ (Pi% .. . (Pk.
F r o m ( l ) , (2), (3) it follows that ( R l , Q i ) = 1. Since ( P i , Ql) = 1, we have
(F,Ql) = 1. It is further evident that i f the numbers a and f~a r e sufficiently
small, and r is sufficiently large, the polynomials and P* a r e 6/2-close
t o rank N and coincide at the point ( 0 , 0 ) , together with t h e i r derivatives t o
o r d e r n , inclusive. We have thug constructed a polynomial P" which is
irreducible with Qi.
Now consider the polynomials and Q* = Q,R. If (P", R ) = 1, then
(P" Q * ) = 1 and we may take Q ( I ,y) = Q* (5,y ) . If, however, a and R a r e
reducible, using the s a m e construction a s f o r R1 (I,y), we c a n construct
a polynomial R z (x,y) which will be i r r e d u c i b l e with P" ( E , y) and such that
the polynomial
Q (5,Y) =Qi ( ~ Y) R2 (I,V)
3
332
531. SYSTEhIS OF THE FIRST DEGREE OF STRUCTURAL LKSTABLLITY
R e m a r k 3 to T h e o r e m 5 (52.2),
where is s o m e region.
Consider a dynamic s y s t e m
Ciof (A1an.d the equilibrium states Oi and haue the same topological
structure. The number eo > 0 may
be taken as small as desired.
P roo f . Let H be a region s a t i s -
fying t h e condition of Definition 30,
', H 3 W ( F i g u r e 1 4 7 ) . Without l o s s
of generality, w e may a s s u m e that
Hcontains no o t h e r equilibrium s t a t e s
1
I
of ( A ) , except O,,Ox,. . ., 0, ( t h i s is
\ so if H is a sufficiently s m a l l neighbor-
hood of the closed region Wj. e , > 0
is chosen a s a number satisfying the
following conditions:
(a) T h e neighborhoods U,, ioi), i =
= 1,2, .. . , s, a r e contained in H and no
FIGifRE 147 two of t h e s e neighborhoods i n t e r s e c t .
333
Ch.XII. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLE FROM LOOP OF SADDLE-NODE 8EPAKATRIX
z)2 ( H ,
(8, A), (7)
whet-e f7 is s o m e region.
It follows f r o m ( 7 ) that contains precisely s equilibrium s t a t e s of (A),
-
which we designate 6,, 62, .. ., 0,.
Let f be the mapping of onto H implementing the relation (7), (i. e.,
f is an eo-translation moving d into H and conserving the paths, see 84.1,
Definitions 8 and 9). Let, further, f (ai) = O t , i = 1, 2, . . ,s. Then .
6i c u,, (Oi). (8)
334
4 91. SYSTEL!:; CF THE FIRST DEGREE OF STRLfCTL'RAL INSTABILITY
-
dr
dt
- y. * dt
= >x2. ax2 + ...
11 Th(.r)l
where
335
Ch.XII. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLE FROM LOOP OF SADDLE-NODE SEPARATRIX
(13)
I
Direct computations show that
336
6 :?l. YYSTE.\!S OF T H E FIRST DEGREE OF STRLrCTC'R.AL INSTIBILITY
and
c
$(I
= ); ( I , Cp(4). (231
ILIoreover, $ ( x ) c a n n o t b e i d e n t i c a l l y z e r o , I n d e e d , i f $(x) = 0, t h e n f o r a l l
s u f f i c i e n t l y s m a l l x , t h e point (5. k ( x ) ) i s a n e q u i l i b r i u m s t a t e of ( A ) , so
t h a t 0 is n o l o n g e r a n i s o l a t e d e q u i l i b r i u m s t a t e . T h u s , n e a r t h e point
x = 0, t h e f u n c t i o n $(z) is e x p r e s s i b l e in t h e l o r m
-' p ( x ) - ~ ~ + & * z " - ' i ..., (26)
, & h e r e a d t o a n d n\,3.
C o n s i d e r t h e dynamic: s y s t e m
or
w h e r e h (p, x) = p -,-cuc+a,z'+ . . . .
S i n c e h (0, 0)= 0, h; (0, 0) = a + O., the t h e o r e m of i m p l i c i t f u n c t i o n s
s h o w s t h a t t h e e q u a t i o n ,h ( p , 3) = 0 h a s a s o l u t i o n x = x, n e a r t h e point
O!O, 0 ) w h i c h goes t o z e r o for p -+ 0. C l e a r l y , if p P O , t h e n I,, # O .
T h e point 0, (I,,. ' p ( x , ) ) is a n e q u i l i b r i u m s t a t e of t h e s y s t e m(x,) which
i s d i f f e r e n t f r o m 0 2nd lies a s close a s d e s i r e d to 0 , w h e n p is s u f f i c i e n t l y
small.
We h a v e t h u s e s t a b l i s h e d t h a t i f p:. ( 0 , O ) = 0, t h e r e e x i s t s a svstem (A,)
&-close t o ( A ) w h i c h is s t r u c t u r a l l y u n s t a b l e in W' a n d y e t h a s tWG e q u i l i b r i u m
s t a t e s i n a n y a r b i t r a r i l y s m a l l n e i g h b o r h o o d of 0 , n a m e l y 0 a n d 0,. T h i s
c o n t r a d i c t s L e m m a 2. 'Thus, p:x (0, 0) # 0, i . e . , t h e e q u i l i b r i u m s t a t e 0 h a s
a m u l t i p l i c i t y of 2 . Q. E . D.
T h e o r e r)t 56. I f ( A ) is a system of the fi.rst degree of structural
iristability in i t ' , any ntriltiple equilibrium state of this system in itr is
a saddle-nede.
337
Ch.XII. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLE FROM LOOP OF SADDLE-NODE SEPARATRIX
I
P roof . Theorem 56 follows directly f r o m T h e o r e m s 54 and 55 because
of the following g e n e r a l proposition: a m u l t i p l e e q u i l i b r i u m s t a t e
of m u l t i p l i c i t y 2 f o r w h i c h u # O i s a s a d d l e - n o d e . If(A)
is an analytical s y s t e m , t h i s proposition is contained in I, $23.2 ( o r ,
equivalently, in QT, $ 2 1 . 2 , Theorem 65). For a non-analytical s y s t e m ,
the proof can be obtained by the s a m e method a s the proof of Theorem 65
in Q T .
T h e o r e m s 54, 55, and 56 show that a n y m u l t i p l e e q u i l i b r i u m
s t a t e of a s y s t e m of t h e f i r s t d e g r e e of s t r u c t u r a l
instability is a saddle-node with u # O and a multiplicity
o f 2.
Let u s now consider simple equilibrium s t a t e s , i . e., those with A # 0.
We have s e e n (Chapter IV) that a simple equilibrium s t a t e is stable, except
i f i t s c h a r a c t e r i s t i c numbers a r e pure imaginary. It is readily s e e n
that a s y s t e m of the f i r s t d e g r e e of s t r u c t u r a l instability may have a
s t r u c t u r a l l y stable equilibrium state of any type. W e w i l l t h e r e f o r e con-
c e n t r a t e on equilibrium s t a t e s with p u r e imaginary c h a r a c t e r i s t i c n u m b e r s .
Each of t h e s e equilibrium s t a t e s , a s w e know, is e i t h e r a multiple focus,
o r a center, or a center-focus ( a center-focus i s possible only f o r a non-
analytical s y s t e m , r e m a r k at the end of $24.4).
Without l o s s of generality, we a s s u m e that the equilibrium s t a t e is the
point O ( 0 , 0) and that (A) is given in the canonical f o r m
dx
x= --BY+cp(Z, Y), ~ = B 2 + W tY)? (28)
54.38 338
$ 3 1 . SYSTEhlS OF THE FIRST DEGREE OF S l R U C T C R A L IKSTABILITY
A) 2 (7%
(U,(0), B), (33)
where is s o m e region.
339
Ch.XK. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLE FROM LOOP OF SADDLE-NODE SEPARATRIX
w h e re -
~ ( s n, ) = = q(s)+-n.*' (s), $(s. n)=$(s)-nncp'(s). (34)
S y s t e m ( A ) is d e s c r i b e d i n t h e s e c o o r d i n a t e s by t h e d i f f e r e n t i a l e q u a t i o n
dn
-&
dS
R (s, n ) , (35)
w h e r e R ( s . n ) i s a f u n c t i o n of class S ( o r an analbytical f u n c t i o n ) * h i c h is
p e r i o d i c i n s with t h e period T and s a t i s f i e s t h e i n i t i a l condition
R ( s , 0 ) = 11.
i s a s u c c e s s i o n f u n c t i o n o n t h e a r c without c o n t a c t I d e f i n e d b y t h e e q u a t i o n s
w h i c h is n o r m a l to t h e p a t h L, at t h e point s = 0 . Alongside x i t h t h e
s u c c e s s i o n function, we c o n s i d e r e d t h e function
d ( n o )= f ( n o ) - no.
34 1
Ch. XU. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLE FROM LOOP OF SADDLE-NODE SEPARATRIX
where the values of the functionsp;, Q;, p , and q are evaluated at the
+
Point (cp (s), (s)).
P r o o f . In Chapter V we rewrote the differential equation (35) c o r -
responding t o s y s t e m (A) i n the form
where the functions P, Q, p , q a r e evaluated at the point (G(s, n), $(s, n)).
Let n = F ( s ; no, p) be the solution of equation (37) satisfying the initial
condition 7 (0, no, p) s no. Then identically
342
I ?I. SYSTEhI3 O F T t I E F R S T DEGREE OF S T R C C I ' I P ! INST-\HIL[I'Y
and t h e s u c c e s s i o n f u n c t i o n of ( 3 )on t h e n o r m a l 1 is d e f i n e d bv t h e r e l a t i o n
3-13
(:h. XII. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLE PROM L O O P OF SAI)IILE-NOI>t bEI'ARATRIX
-f;
i . e . , if t h e v e c t o r f i e l d of t h e s y s t e m is a r o t a t e d f i e l d of ( A ) , t h e n
(0, 0 ) f 0 .
P r o o f . T h e v a l i d i t y of t h e l a s t i n e q u a l i t y f o l l o w s d i r e c t l y f r o m (36)
s i n c e i n t h e p r e s e n t case
I -= s
T
0
[(F;((P(s), rl, (s)))* + (F1('P (s), $ (s)))'l ds,
344
. f ::I. SYSTEhIS OF r t i E FiKST DEGQEF O F S T R C f C T I ' R 4 L [hSTABIL[TY
T!ius, IC,: Lo be a l i n i - t c y c l e of m u l t i p l i c i t y 3 of t h e s y s t e m ( A ) . T h e n
d (11)= I ) . d' (0)= 0, d" (0)= 0 , d" ( 0 )# 0. (-17)
~ I 1-18'
Y and ~ ' 4 7~) it F o ! i c ~ u i ihar d;,(O,
345
Ch.XI1. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLE FROh.1 LOOP OF SADDLE-NODE SEPARA'I'RIX
Consider the s y s t e m
w e have U c P .
CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLE FROM LOOP OF SADDLE-NODE SEPARATRIX
348
9 31. SYSTEXIE OF THE FIRST DEGREE OF STRLrCTUR4L INSTABILITY
* 0 is a c o n s t a n t i n -
d e p e n d e n t ofy. If t h e s i g n of y is c h o s e n as m i n u s t h e s i g n of 0, a n a d d i - ,
tional condition i s satisfied:
3 ) k (0) = yfi < 0 .
By L I a c l a u r i n ' s f o r m u l a d (no).=d+ n2 +- o (ni), a n d f o r s u f f i c i e n t l y s m a l l
no, d (4< 0 .
L e t nk') > 0, < n;'' b e s u f f i c i e n t l y small. T h e n
4) a (nb")< 0 .
F r o m c o n d i t i o n s 2 arid 4 it f o l l o w s t h a t t h e r e e x i s t s nf), n:) < nap < n i l ) ,
s u c h t h a t 2 ( n p ) = 0 . T h e n u m b e r n:" c o r r e s p o n d s t o a c l o s e d p a t h of
s y s t e m ( A ) w h i c h d o e s riot c o i n c i d e with L o . If n:' a n d p a r e s u f f i c i e n t l y
s m a l l , w e h a v e E c i - . T h u s , for a S u f f i c i e n t l y s m a l l p of a n a p p r o p r i a t e
s i g n , (A) h a s a t l e a s t t w o c l o s e d p a t h s Lo an: L i n tr a n d h e n c e i n 0 .
S i n c e Lo i s a l i m i t c y c l e of m u l t i p l i c i t y 2, ( A ) is s t r u c t u r a l l y u n s t a b l e .
T h i s c o n t r a d i c t s r e l a t i o n (54), w h i c h i n d i c a t e s t h a t d c o n t a i n s o n l y one
c l o s e d p a t h of ( A ) . T h e t h e o r e m is p r o v e d .
R e m a r k . W e c o n s i d e r e d s y s t e m s of class 3, i. e . , s t r u c t u r a l
i n s t a b i l i t y of t h e f i r s t d e g r e e w a s t r e a t e d i n r e l a t i o n t o t h e s p a c e R : J p ( s e e
:5.1). T h i s p r o o f is i n a p p l i c a b l e t o t h e class of a n a l y t i c a l f u n c t i o n s , s i n c e
t h e a n a l y t i c a l f u n c t i o n F (z, y) w i t h t h e d e s i r e d p r o p e r t i e s i n g e n e r a l c a n
b e c o n s t r u c t e d o n l y i n a n e i g h b o r h o o d of t h e p a t h L o . a n d not i n t h e e n t i r e
r e g i o n 6. To p r o v e t h e t h e o r e m i n t h e a n a l y t i c a l case, w e m a y p r o c e e d
as follows: c o n s t r u c t , as b e f o r e , a s y s t e m (.?) of class 3 w h i c h has a
riGuble c y c l e Lo a n d a c l o s e d p a t h i n V . E y Lemma 2, S 1 5 . 2 , t h e r e
e x i s t s a n a r b i t r a r i l y clclse s y s t e m of class 3 , ( A l ) , w h i c h c o i n c i d e s w i t h
(A) e v e r y w h e r e e x c e p t E. s m a l l n e i g h b o r h o o d of t h e p a t h a n d w h i c h h a s
i n t h a t n e i g h b o r h o o d , arid t h e r e f o r e i n V also, a s t r u c t u r a l l y s t a b l e l i m i t
c y c l e E,. B y Lemma 9, o n t h e o t h e r h a n d , t h e r e e x i s t s a n a n a l y t i c a l
s v s t e m ( A 2 ) a r b i t r a r i l y close to (A,) w h i c h h a s a d o u b l e l i m i t c y c l e i n
a n e i g h b o r h o o d of t h e p a t h L o . If (A*) is s u f f i c i e n t l y close to (A1), i t h a s
a s t r u c t u r a l l y s t a b l e l i m i t c y c l e E2 i n t h e n e i g h b o r h o o d of t h e c y c l e z,.
T h u s , t h e a n a l y t i c a l s y s t e m (Az) h a s t w o c l o s e d p a t h s i n V , a n d w e a g a i n
end up with a c o n t r a d i c t i o n t o identity ( 5 4 ) .
A s a d d l e - t o - s a d d l e s e p a r a t r i x w a s c o n s i d e r e d i n d e t a i l i n C h a p t e r s IV
a n d XI. In C h a p t e r IV (!I 11) w e e s t a b l i s h e d t h a t a s t r u c t u r a l l y s t a b l e
s y s t e m c a n h a v e n o s u c h s e p a r a t r i c e s . In C h a p t e r XI w e c o n s i d e r e d a
s e p a r a t r i x f o r m i n g a locip a n d d e r i v e d some of i t s p r o p e r t i e s .
In t h i s s u b s e c t i o n w e w i l l d e a l w i t h a s a d d l e - t o - s a d d l e s e p a r a t r i x of
a s v s t e m of t h e f i r s t d e g r e e of s t r u c t u r a l i n s t a b i l i t y . The case of a
s e p a r a t r i x b e t w e e n t w o d i f f e r e n t s a d d l e p o i n t s is of n o i n t e r e s t for o u r
p u r p o s e s , since these s e p a r a t r i c e s are not c h a r a c t e r i z e d by a n y a d d i -
t i o n a l n e w p r o p e r t i e s i n systems of t h e f i r s t d e g r e e of s t r u c t u r a l i n s t a b i l i t y .
W e w i l l t h e r e f o r e c o n s i d e r t h e case w h e n a s a d d l e - p o i n t s e p a r a t r i x goes
to t h e same s a d d l e point for b o t h t + - 00 a n d t - + + 00, i . e., i t f o r m s a
l o o p . T h e r e s u l t s follow almost d i r e c t l y f r o m t h e f i n d i n g s of C h a p t e r X I .
349
Ch.XI1. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLE FROM LOOP OF SADDLE-NODE SEPARATRIX
FIGURE 149
350
5 31. SYSTEMS CY THE FIRST DEGREE OF STRUCTC'RAL iNST.4BILITY
35 1
Ch.Xl1. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLE FROM LOOP OF SADDLE-NODE SEPARA'I'KIX
T h e p a t h s of t h e s e f i v e t y p e s w i l l b e c a l l e d t h e s i m p 1e s t s t r u c -
t u r a l l y u n s t a b l e p a t h s . T h e e x i s t e n c e of t h e s e p a t h s i n s y s t e m s
of t h e f i r s t d e g r e e of s t r u c t u r a l i n s t a b i l i t y d o e s not c o n t r a d i c t T h e o r e m s 53
t h r o u g h 60. @n t h e o t h e r h a n d , a d y n a m i c s y s t e m ( A ) of t h e f i r s t d e g r e e
of s t r u c t u r a l i n s t a b i l i t y i n W s h o u l d h a v e i n t h i s r e g i o n a t l e a s t o n e s i m p l e s t
s t r u c t u r a l l y u n s t a b l e p a t h ( o t h e r w i s e , it would b e s t r u c t u r a l l y s t a b l e i n W ) .
We w i l l s h o w i n t h i s s u b s e c t i o n t h a t a d y n a m i c s y s t e m of t h e f i r s t
d e g r e e of s t r u c t u r a l i n s t a b i l i t y i n W c a n n o t h a v e m o r e t h a n o n e s i m p l e s t
s t ~ ~ u c t u r a l ul ynstable path i n t h i s region.
F i r s t w e s h a l l p r o v e a n u m b e r of l e m m a s .
L e m m a 1 1 . Let Lo be a separatrix of the saddle point 0 of a dynamic
system (A) of class N which extends to another saddle point O1. There
flXl
exists a simple closed curve of class k ( k being a
given number<N +
1) which passes through the
points 0 and 01, encloses L ~ and , does not enclose
,.; 2: 4" \, 5; any other separatrix o r any equilibrium state of
system (A).
P r o o f . We s h a l l f i r s t s h o w t h a t a n a r c 1 of
a p a r a b o l a c a n b e p a s s e d t h r o u g h t h e point 0 ,which
h a s n o c o n t a c t s w i t h t h e p a t h s of s y s t e m (A) e x c e p t
at t h e point 0 ( F i g u r e 150). Without loss of g e n e r a l i t y ,
8p.' A p ,' w e m a y p l a c e t h e point 0 a t the o r i g i n a n d r e p r e s e n t
P"
t h e s y s t e m ( A ) i n t h e c a n o n i c a l form
dz
-=
dt X,z+Cp(z, Y), $=-2y+wz, Y). (57)
FIGLIKE 15U
w h e r e 'p and $ a r e f u n c t i o n s w h i c h v a n i s h at t h e
point O ( 0 , 0 ) t o g e t h e r w i t h t h e i r f i r s t o r d e r d e r i v a t i v e s
(see s 8 . 1 , ( l ) , ( 2 ) ) , a n d I l l z < O .
B y a s s u m p t i o n , all o u r s y s t e m s , s y s t e m (A) i n c l u d e d , a r e s y s t e m s of
c l a s s 3 . T h e f u n c t i o n s 'p and +,
b y T h e o r e m 5 of t h e Appendix (see
A p p e n d i x , s u b s e c t i o n 2), m a y t h e r e f o r e be w r i t t e n i n t h e f o r m
w h e r e P: a n d Qg a r e c o n t i n u o u s f u n c t i o n s , w h i c h v a n i s h at t h e point O ( 0 , 0 ) .
C o n s i d e r t h e p a r a b o l a y = C x 2 , w h e r e t h e v a l u e of the c o e f f i c i e n t C w i l l
b e c h o s e n a t a l a t e r stage. T h e c o n d i t i o n t h a t t h e p a r a b o l a I/ = Cxp is
t a n g e n t to a p a t h of s y s t e m (57) c a n b e w r i t t e n at t h e p o i n t of c o n t a c t i n
t h e form
2cx [hlx + 'p (I,!/)I - I1zY +9 (G Y)I = 0.
352
4 .I. 5YSTEh S OF THE FIRST DEGREE OF STRUCTCRjL IhST4BILIT'i
o f t h e p a r a b o l a y = L'Z' is without c o n t a c t w i t h t h e p a t h s of s y s t e m ( 5 7 ) ,
e x c e p t a t t h e point 0 . if'e d e s i g n a t e t h i s a r c 1 .
T h e a r c 1 c l c a r l v c a n b e d r a \ v n so t h a t t h e s e p a r t r i x L o of t h e s a d d l e
point 0 lies o n o n e s i d e of t h e a r c 1 (on t h e c o n c a v e s i d e of t h e p a r a b o l a } ,
and t h e p t h e r t h r e e s e p a r a t r i c e s l i e on t h e o t h e r s i d e of t h e a r c . An
a n a l o q o u s a r c I t of t h e p a r a b o l a c a n b e d r a w n t h r o u g h t h e s a d d l e point 0,
iF'iqu r e 1 5 0 1 .
[.et 0 b e a n a - l i m i t point of t h e p a t h Lo, a n d 0,i t s a - l i m i t p o i n t . T h e
p n i n t s 0 and 0,r e s p e c t i v e l y d i v i d e e a c h of t h e a r c s 1 a n d 11 i n t o t w o p a r t s :
1' a n d l ' , i, a n d 1 ; . It i s r e a d i l y s e e n t h a t a n y p a t h c r o s s i n g t h e arc 1 s u f -
f i c i e n r l v close t o t h e [point 0 w i l l also c r o s s t h e a r c 1;. a n d a n y p a t h
c r f l s s i y t h e arc 1" u - i d c r o s s 1 ; . C h o o s e o n e arc of e a c h of t h e s e p a i r s .
i Y e o b t a i n a s i m p l e pieccLr-ise-smooth c l o s e d c u r v e m a d e up of t h e s e g -
m e n t s P ' P " and Q'Q" of t h e a r c s 1 a n d it and t h e a r c s P'Q' and P"Q'of p a ? h s .
T h i s closed c u r v e evidently e n c l o s e s t h e s e p a r a t r i s Lo.
O n t h e a r c OP' we '2hoose a point d w h i c h d o e s not c o i n c i d e e i t h e r w i t h
0 01' with P ' , and o n t h e a r c P'Q' of a p a t h w.e c h o o s e a p o i n t B . S i n c e 1 i s
at? a r c without c n n r a c c , we c a n a l w a y s j o i n t h e point d to t h e point B b y a n
arc ( w i t h o u t c o n t a c t ) , w h i c h at t h e point .1 a n d a t t h e point B h a s a p o i n t of
r w ~ f a c c.f r a n v d e s i r e d o r d e r k < N L 1 with t h e a r c 1 a n d r e s p e c t i v e l y w i t h
t h e a r c nt' t h e p a t h ( t h i s i s r e a d i l y p r o v e d u s i n g QT, 5 3 . 5 , L e m m a 8).
P r a u i n q t h r e e o t h e r analogous arcs ( F i g u r e 150) we obtain a s i m p l e
c l o s e d curve of c l a s s k w h i c h c o m p l e t e l y e n c l o s e s t h e s e p a r a t r i s Lo a n d
clfies not e n c l o s e o t h e r s e p a r a r r i c e s o r a n y e q u i l i b r i u m s t a t e s of t h e
s y s t e m . Q. E . D.
R Fm a r k . T h e n u m b e r k , i n g e n e r a l , s h o u l d b e GLV+ 1, s i n c e t h e
p a t h s of s y s t e m s of c l a s s :V a r e c u r v e s of class A'+ 1, and acelording t o
the. c o n s t r u c t i o n u s e d i n t h e p r o o f of t h e l e m m a , s e g m e n t s of t h e s e c u r v e s
are included i n t h e c l o s e d c u r v e .
L e t n tti a 12. Let L o be a separatrh of system (A) of class N which
originates atul ends in the saddle point 0 Cfmtning a loop L ) , and let there
be a neighborhood of L which does not contain any closed paths (so that
the loop is stable os unstable). Then there exist two sittiple closed curces
N + 1 , ane of which
C' and C" of class k , iohere k is any fixed integer, k -:
encloses the loop L a d the other is enclosed b y the loop L, such that the
annular region bcticem C' and C" contains no equilibrium states, no closed
citrues, and no separatrices (except L ) of systetn (A).
P r o o f . S u p p o s e t h a t t h e o t h e r t w o s e p a r a t r i c e s of t h e s a d d l e - p o i n t 0
( d i f f e r e n t from L o ) l i e o u t s i d e t h e l o o p f o r m e d b y t h e p a t h L .
!I'e c a n a I w a v s p a s s t h r o u g h t h e s a d d I e point 0 a s e g m e n t of a s t r a i g h t
l i n e which w i l l b e without c o n t a c t at all p o i n t s s u f f i c i e n t l y close t o 0 ( o t h e r
Than 0 i t s e l f l (see QT, 37.3, p . 1 5 5 j . L e t I be s u c h a s e g m e n t w h i c h c c n -
r a i n s 0 a n d i s withou- c o n t a c t w i t h t h e p a t h s of ( A ) a t all p o i n t s o t h e r t h a n
0 (Cigure 151).
L e t 1' a n d I" b e t h e t w o s e g m e n t s i n t o w h i c h 1 is d i v i d e d b y t h e s a d d l e
p(kinr 0 . It i s r e a d i l s s e e n t h a t a n y p a t h c r o s s i n g t h e s e g m e n t I' a t a
point P' sufficient1.y close t o 0 w i l l c r o s s 1" a t s o m e point P " .
\Ye t h u s o b t a i n a s i m p l e c l o s e d p i e c e w i s e - s m o o t h c u r v e e n c l o s i n g
t h e l o o p L , s u c h t h a t t h e r e g i o n b e t w e e n t h i s c u r v e a n d L c o n t a i n s no
e q u i l i b r i u m s t a t e s , no c l o s e d p a t h s , and no s e p a r a t r i c e s ( t h i s i s r e a d i l y
353
Ch.XI1. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLE FROM LOOP OF SADDLE-NODE SEPARATRIX
n = p ( s , y),
where F is a function of class k - 1 which vanishes on y , is positive on one
side of y and negative on the other side of y , and on y s a t i s f i e s the relation
F;'+F;+O. W e c a n choose the direction of the normals so that the function
F ( x , v) is positive inside the c u r v e y and negative outside this c u r v e . Con-
s i d e r any two closed c u r v e s y , and y 2 defined by the equations n = n, and
n = nL, respectively, i. e ., F (2, y) = n, and F ( x , g) = n2, where the numbers
n, and n2 are sufficiently s m a l l and 0 < n, < n2 (Figure 152).
Let f = f (n)be a function of class k- 1 defined for O < n < 00, which
s a t i s f i e s the following conditions:
1) f (n) 3 n f o r O < n < n , ;
2 ) f (n)E n2 f o r n > n 2 ;
3) n , < f (n)<n2 f o r ni < n < n2 (a specimen graph of the function f (n) is
shown in Figure 153; a s i m i l a r function was constructed in 4 15.2
354
s 31. SYSTELIS CF THE FlRST DEGREE OF STRUCTlrR.4L WSTABILITY
( r , y) = f (n)= f (F (f,y));
2) i n s i d e y ~ ,
Q, (3, y) = n*.
Q, (I, y) i s s i m i l a r l y d e f i n e d o u t s i d e t h e c u r v e y . T h e f u n c t i o n 0 c o n -
s t r u c t e d i n t h i s w a y e v i d e n t l y m e e t s a11 the c o n d i t i o n s of t h e lemma. Q . E. D .
L e m m a 14. Let
+-+%
of t h e s e p a r a t r i x L. H e n c e i t fol-
R7zy p l o w s , a s is r e a d i l y s e e n , t h a t a
n u m b e r q > 0 e x i s t s with t h e f o l l o w i n g
p r o p e r t y : i f (A) is q - c l o s e to (A),
0' L' t h e n i n a s u f f i c i e n t l y small n e i g h b o r -
hood of t h e s a d d l e p o i n t 0' (0") there
e x i s t s a s i n g l e s a d d l e p o i n t @ (8') of
the system (x) and t h e s e p a r a t r i x
FIGURE 154 ?j (E') of the s a d d l e p o i n t 6' (6.") crosses
t h e a r c w i t h o u t c o n t a c t 1 at t h e p o i n t
- .%' (1G") c o r r e s p o n d i n g to t h e v a l u e
u' (L") of t h e p a r a m e t e r u , s o t h a t t h e s e g m e n t ail?* of t h e s e p a r a t r i x
2' Gw)i s c o n t a i n e d i n s i d e a n a r b i t r a r i l y small n e i g h b o r h o o d of t h e s e g m e n t
O ' M (0"M)of t h e s e p a r a t r i x L ( F i g u r e 1 5 4 ) .
355
Let 8 , be a positive number, 8 , <%, a 1 C6T .
Consider the s y s t e m
dz
-=
dt P-hQ, s=Q+W.
u >0,
(L) u(2,) <0 ,
u <0
(b) u ( A Z ) >0,
(Figure 155).
Let P* and Q* be polynomials which provide a sufficiently c l o s e fit of
the functions P and Q s o that the following conditions be satisfied:
1) For a l l 1, lhl<A,,, the s y s t e m
is 6,-close t o rank r t o ( A ) .
2 ) The s e p a r a t r i c e s (h,) and c(Xt) of (Ah,) c r o s s the a r c without contact 2
at the points &(A,) and N ( h , ) corresponding t o the values ;(hi) and C(hl) of
the p a r a m e t e r which a r e so close t o the points N ; and N ; that
I
FIGURE 155
356
f. 31. SYSTELIS OF TtiE FIRST DECREE OF STRLCTL'fLlL IZSIABILITY
S i n c e 3 and t? a r e c o n t i n u o u s f u n c t i o n s of t h e p a r a m e r e r h , t h e r e e x i s t s
a nuniberX, h 2 < ~ < h l , s u c h that
T h i s i m p l i e s t h a t t h e s e p a r a r r i s of t h e s y s t e m ( 3 1 ) e x t e n d s f r o m s a d d l e
point a' to s a d d l e point 6". S i n c e (-xi)i s 6 - c l o s e to rank r t o (-4) and is a n
a n a l v t i c a l s y s t e m , i t s a t i s f i e s all t h e p r o p o s i t i o n s of t h e l e m m a . Q. E . n.
T h e o r e m 61. If (A) is a dyiminic systerti of the f i r s t degree of
structural itstability in W , it may hace at most one simplest stnicttrrally
unstable path in this region.
P r c) o f . S u p p o s e t h a t (A) h a s t w o s i m p l e s t s t r u c t u r a l l y i l n s t a b l e p a t h s
i n i i ' . In o u r p r o o f , w e d o not d i s t i n g u i s h b e t w e e n p a t h s of t y p e 4 and t y p e 5
I see p. 351), i . e ., a s a d d l e - to- s a d d l e s e p a r a t r i s m a y b e a s e p a r a t r i x b e t w e e n
t w o d i f f e r e n t s a d d l e p o i n t s o r a s e p a r a t r i x f o r m i n g a l o o p for a s a d d l e point
with o Z 0 . We m o r e o v e r a s s u m e t h a t all t h e s y s t e m s a r e a n a l y t i c a l , i . e . ,
s-e a r e d e a l i n g w i t h s t r u c t u r a l i n s t a b i l i t v of t h e f i r s t d e g r e e u-ith r e s p e c t t o
t h e s p a c e Rb", w h e r e r > 3 . O u t - p r o o f r e m a i n s i n f o r c e , a s i s r e a d i l y s e e n ,
i n i h e n o n a n a l y t i c a l cast? as w e l l ( i . e . , for t h e s p a c e R$),3 g r g . V ) , and
s o m e a r g u m e n t s c a n a c t u a l l y b e s i m p l i f i e d i n t h e nonanalq.tica1 case.
L F ~ C~S c o n s i d e r s u c c e s s i v e l y all t h e p o s s i b l e cases of t w o s i m p l e s t
structurallv unstable paths in ti-.
1 ) S y s t e m ( A , h a s tu.,? s a d d l e - n o d e s i n 15..
Let o n e of t h e s e s a d d l e - n o d e s b e t h e p o i n t O ( O , O ) , and t h e o t h e r O , ( a , b ) ,
a n d l e t t h e s y s t e m ( A \ h.ave the form
dr
;iT.=p(z,y). 2:
-= Y - r 4 ( 2 ? Y), (A)
C o n s i d e r t h e modified s v s t e m
dd xl
-= p @ . Y) +p I V - ~ lP ( 1 , Y),
(~~-b*)= =Y
; Q (t,Y) =Qtz, Y). (6)
u h e r e p3-0. For a n y p , t h e point O , ( a , b) is a m u l t i p l e e q u i l i b r i u m
s t a t e of (At, since x ( a , t ) = A ( a , b)= 0 . ( A ) is t h e r e f o r e s t r u c t u r a l l y
unstable.
Let y = q ( z ) b e a s o l u t i o n of t h e e q u a t i o n y + q ( z , y)= 0 i n t h e n e i g h b o r -
hoo-l of t h e point O ( 0 , 0 ) , a n d l e t $ (I) = P (2,q (3)) = p (I,9: (2)). S i n c e 0 is
a n e q u i l i b r i u m s t a t e of m u l t i p l i c i t y 2 for s y s t e m (A), t h e f u n c t i o n 9(2)h a s
the form
9 (1)=a&+ap3+. .., (65)
w h e r e a,+O ( T h e o r e m 3.3, s 2 3 . 1 ) .
357
Ch.XI1. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLE FROM LOOP OF SADDLE-NODE SEPARATRLX
p (a4+b4)+a&+. .. = O (66)
dt
= P - pQ =p, df
dll = Q+ pP = @, (A)
which is obtained f r o m s y s t e m (A) by rotating i t s vector field through
the angle tan-' p.
Since 0, (a, b) is a saddle- point of ( A ) , we have P (a, b) = Q ( a , b) = A (a, b) = 0.
-
F r o m t h e s e relations and f r o m the obvious equality 8 ( x , g) = A (3, g) (i+p*) we
conclude that P ( a , b ) = g ( a , b ) = A ( a , b ) = O , i.e., the point 0, is a s t r u c t u r a l l y
unstable equilibrium s t a t e of (A).
(8) is thus a s t r u c t u r a l l y unstable s y s t e m . Reasoning as in the proof
t o T h e o r e m 5 7 ($31.2, ( 3 3 ) and (34)), we can show that i f p i s sufficiently
s m a l l , (A) c a n have no closed paths in s o m e neighborhood V of 0 . By
R e m a r k 3 t o T h e o r e m 14, 9 10.3, f o r a sufficiently s m a l l p of an appropriate
358
4 31. SYSTEVS OF TliE FIRST DEGREE OF STRL'CTL'RAL L\STAEILITY
T h e modified s y s t e m is
359
Ch.XII. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLE FROM LOOP OF SADDLE-NODE SEPARATRIX
relation (U (L),A ) ZE
e
(v, A ) , where U (t)is a neighborhood of the s e p a r a t r i x L .
F r o m the l a s t relation i t follows that contains a saddle-to-saddle
s e p a r a t r i x of (A). On the other hand, in o u r proof t o Theorem 16, 9 11.2,
w e have s e e n that i f the neighborhood U (L)of the path L and the numbers e
and p a r e sufficiently s m a l l , may riot contain any saddle-to- saddle
s e p a r a t r i c e s of ( A ) . We have established a contradiction.
6 ) System (A) h a s a multiple focus and a limit cycle of multiplicity 2
in W , and
7 ) System ( A ) h a s a multiple focus and a saddle-to-saddle s e p a r a t r i x
in W .
The proof which r u l e s out c a s e s 6 and 7 is the s a m e . Let O ( O . 0 ) be
the multiple focus. The modified s y s t e m is taken in the f o r m
360
E 31. SYSTEVS OF THE FIRST DEGREE OF STRL'CTL'RAL ISST.-\BILITY
FIGL'RE 156
F v Lemma 9 of t h e p r e s e n t s e c t i o n , t h e r e e x i s t s an a n a l y t i c a l s y s t e m
( A ) as close as d e s i r e d to ( A I ) t o r a n k r w h i c h h a s a limit c y c l e of m u l t i p l i c i t y
2 i n a n y a r b i t r a r i l y s r n a l i n e i g h b o r h o o d of t h e c y c l e L I , a n d is t h e r e f o r e
s x r u c t u r a l l y u n s t a b l e . B u t ( A l ) is s t r u c t u r a l l y s t a b l e i n U . Therefore,
if (x) is s u f f i c i e n t l y ci.ose t o ( A l ) , c o n d i t i o n s ( b j a n d ( c ) a r e s a t i s f i e d for
(.xi. We h a v e t h u s e s t a b l i s h e d t h e e x i s t e n c e of a s t r u c t u r a l l y u n s t a b l e
s y s t e m (AI a r b i t r a r i l y close t o ( A ) w i t h o u t a n y s a d d l e - t o - s a d d l e s e p a r a t r i c e s
i n U . T h i s l e a d s t o t h e same c o n t r a d i c t i o n a s i n case 5.
IO) S y s t e m ( A ) h a s t w o s a d d l e - t o - s a d d l e s e p a r a t r i c e s L1 a n d L2 i n W .
T w o d i f f e r e n t case:; are p o s s i b l e :
( a ) a t l e a s t o n e of t h e a e p a r a t r i c e s Ll a n d L Z e x t e n d s b e t w e e n t w o
different s a d d l e points;
( b } each s e p a r a t r i r f o r m s a l o o p for i t s s a d d l e p o i n t .
L e t us f i r s t c o n s i d e r case ( a ) . L e t Ll b e a s e p a r a t r i x e x t e n d i n g f r o m
s a d d l e point 0 t o a n o t h e r s a d d l e p o i n t 01, w h i c h d o e s n o t c o i n c i d e with 0 .
T h e s e p a r a t r i x LZ e i t h e r p a s s e s a t a f i n i t e d i s t a n c e f r o m L l o r at l e a s t
o n e of t h e t w o e q u i l i b r i u m s t a t e s of t h i s s e p a r a t r i x c o i n c i d e s w i t h 0 or O1.
S i n c e n o n e of t h e p o i n t s of the s e p a r a t r i x Li i s a l i m i t p o i n t for L 2 , t h e
s i m p l e c l o s e d c u r v e of class k ( w h e r e k is a p r i o r i known to b e e q u a l to 4)
w h o s e e x i s t e n c e is e s t a b l i s h e d i n L e m m a 11 m a y b e c h o s e n s o t h a t i t
e n c l o s e s Ll without e n c l o s i n g L z .
In case ( b ) , s e v e r a l s u b c a s e s s h o u l d b e c o n s i d e r e d . S p e c i f i c a l l y ,
t h e d i s t a n c e b e t w e e n t h e l o o p s f o r m e d b y t h e s e p a r a t r i c e s L, a n d L z m a y
b e e i t h e r p o s i t i v e or z e r o , o n e of t h e t w o l o o p s m a y e n c l o s e t h e o t h e r
l o o p o r t h e y m a y lie o n e o u t s i d e t h e o t h e r ( F i g u r e s 1 5 7 a n d 158).
36 1
362
S '?I. S Y S T E L 5 C F THE FIRST DEGREE OF STRL'CTI RAL ISST.IBIL[TY
To fix i d e a s , s u p p o s e t h a t t h e s e p a r a t r i s Lz f o r m s a p o s i t i v e a n g l e
with t h e a r c without c o n t a c t 1 2 . T h e n , b y ( 6 7 ) a n d t h e lemma of B 11.1,
ci<c; if E, = 0, p > O ;
r+;>ro" i f h > O , p - 0 .
363
Ch.XI1. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLE FROM LOOP OF SADDLE-NODE SEPARATRIX
6 . T h e p r o p e r t i e s of the s e p a r a t r i c e s of a saddle-node
in s y s t e m s of the f i r s t d e g r e e of s t r u c t u r a l instability
x=f(u), Y=g(u)
364
5 31. SYSTEhlS OF THE F[RST DEGREE OF STRLrCTL'RAL INSTABILITY
$++
L
,l of the s e p a r a t r i x L . Consider a
s y s t e m (A,,). Since 0 i s a saddle-
f
node of (A,), (A,) is s t r u c t u r a l l y
unstable. L e m m a 16 and the c o r -
4 responding proposition f o r a saddle
point (9 11.1) then show that f o r a
FIGURE 161
sufficiently s m a l l p # 0 ( A d d o e s
not have in a sufficiently s m a l l neigh-
borhood of the path L a s e p a r a t r i x
which g o e s f r o m 0 t o 0,. T h e contradiction is now established by the
usual argument using t i e relation ( U ( L ) , A );(?,A,,). T h i s p r o v e s the
theorem.
T h e o y e ni 63. I f ( A ) is a dynamic system of the f i r s t degree of
structural instability in i f - , it cannot have in this r e g i a a path L which
is at the same time an a-separatrix and an a-separatrix of a saddle
point of ( A ) .
P r o o f of T h e o r e m 6 3 is analogous t o the proof of the previous
t h e o r e m . It is conducted by reductio ad absurdum, using a s y s t e m ( A J ,
L e m m a 16, and the fact that a path forming a loop may c r o s s a segment
without contact a t most in one point.
T h e o r e m s 62 and 63 show that c a s e s 4 and 5 listed at the beginning
of t h i s subsection are unfeasible.
Let u s now r e t u r n tcb closed paths of a s y s t e m of the f i r s t d e g r e e of
s t r u c t u r a l instability and d e r i v e a f u r t h e r property of t h e s e paths on the
b a s i s of the above theol-ems.
365
Ch.XlI. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLE FROM LOOP OF SADDLE-NODE SEPAKATRIX
point 0,.
Let u s f i r s t a s s u m e that the points 0,and 0 2 coincide, i. e., L* is a
saddle-point s e p a r a t r i x which f o r m s a loop.
Let (zO.yo) be the coordinates of the saddle point Oj. By T h e o r e m 60, in
t h i s c a s e u (zo, yo) = P ; (q, yo)+ Qb (q. yo) # 0. But then by Theorem 44,
s29.1, the loop L* is either stable o r unstable,
i . e., a sufficiently s m a l l neighborhood of the
+&f
loop may not contain points of closed paths.
We have thus established a contradiction.
Let now Ol and 0,be two different saddle
points, L* going t o Ol for t -+ - 00 and to 0,for
FIGURE 162
t+ + m ( F i g u r e 162). Consider that hyperbolic
s e c t o r of the saddle point 0,which contains an
infinity of points MI. Let L** be the o -continuation
of the s e p a r a t r i x L* on the side of t h i s hyperbolic s e c t o r . Clearly, L**
is analogous to the path L* in all r e s p e c t s , i. e., i t is a saddle-to-saddle
s e p a r a t r i x . But then (A) h a s two s t r u c t u r a l l y unstable paths L* and L**,
and t h i s contradicts Theorem 61. T h i s completes the proof of the
theorem.
' Theorem 64 is not a direct consequence of Theorem 58 (which states that the closed paths of a system of
the first degree of structural instability are isolated.
366
5 31. SYSTEhiS OF THE FIRST DEGREE OF STRL'CTLIRAL INSTABILITY
7. P r o p e r t i e s of s e p a r a t r i c e s of s a d d l e p o i n t s
of systems of the f i r s t d e g r e e of
s t r u c t u r a l instability
We h a v e a l r e a d y d e r : v e d some p r o p e r t i e s of s e p a r a t r i c e s of s a d d l e
p o i n t s of s y s t e m s of t h e first d e g r e e of s t r u c t u r a l i n s t a b i l i t y . I n d e e d ,
w e h a v e s e e n t h a t , first, t h e s e p a r a t r i x of a s a d d l e p o i n t 0 ( x o , yo) m a y
not form a l o o p if u (zo,y3)= 0 (Theorem 60) a n d , s e c o n d , a n w - s e p a r a t r i x
( a - s e p a r a t r i x ) of a s a d d l e p o i n t m a y n o t be a t t h e same time an a - s e p a r a t r i x
( o - s e p a r a t r i x ) of a s a d c l e - n o d e (Theorem 6 2 ) . In t h i s s u b s e c t i o n , w e w i l l
e s t a b l i s h t w o f u r t h e r p r o p e r t i e s of s a d d l e - p o i n t s e p a r a t r i c e s of s y s t e m s of
t h e f i r s t d e g r e e of s t r u c t u r a l i n s t a b i l i t y .
T h e o r e m 65. A system of the f i r s t degree of structural instabi2ity
in IV may not have in this region two saddle-point separatrices tchich go
to a limit cycle of multiplicity 2, me f m t -+ - 00 and the other fm
f+ t 03.
P r 00f . S u p p o s e t h a t s y s t e m ( A ) h a s a l i m i t c y c l e L o of m u l t i p l i c i t y 2
i n W' a n d t w o s a d d l e - p o i n t s e p a r a t r i c e s L , a n d L I , of w h i c h Ll goes t o L o
f o r t -+ +- co a n d L2 goes t o t h e same l i m i t c y c l e for t -+-a. O n e of t h e s e
s e p a r a t r i c e s e v i d e n t l y lies o u t s i d e Lo a n d t h e o t h e r lies i n s i d e L o .
L e t e o > O b e s u c h t h a t U,,(Lo) d o e s not c o n t a i n a n y e q u i l i b r i u m s t a t e s of
(A) a n d a n y c l o s e d p a t h s , e x c e p t L o .
An a r c w i t h o u t c o n t a c t 1 i s p a s s e d t h r o u g h some point 31 of t h e c y c l e L o .
L e t s b e t h e p a r h m e t e r o n t h e arc 1 , c h o s e n s o t h a t t h e point 31 c o r r e s p o n d s
t o s = 0. Let f u r t h e r
=
; f (s)
be t h e s u c c e s s i o n f u n c t i o n o n t h e a r c 1 d e f i n e d f o r all s, I s I < q, w h e r e q
is some p o s i t i v e n u m b e r . S i n c e t h e s e p a r a t r i c e s L, a n d L z b y a s s u m p -
t i o n g o to L O ( f o r t - + +- 00 a n d t - + - 0 0 ,
r e s p e c t i v e l y ) , t h e arc 1 c o n t a i n s a n
Z
i n f i n i t e n u m b e r of p o i n t s w h i c h b e l o n g
%'
to L2 a n d a n i n f i n i t e n u m b e r of p o i n t s
w h i c h b e l o n g to L l . Let .Vi (s:) a n d
-11;(si) b e t w o s u c c e s s i v e ( i n t e r m s oft)
p o i n t s a t w h i c h t h e p a t h L 1 c r o s s e s the
a r c 1 , a n d -11;(si) a n d -ri; (s;)two s u c c e s -
s i v e ( i n t e r m s o f t ) p o i n t s at w h i c h L2
crosses 1 . W e a s s u m e t h a t M ; a n d M i
a r e so close t o 111 t h a t t h e coils Jl&W;
a n d IMeM; of t h e p a t h s Ll a n d L z r r e s p e c -
t i v e l y , a r e c o n t a i n e d e n t i r e l y i n U,,( L o )
andIs;I<tl,ls;I<?, i = 1,2.
To fix i d e a s , l e t t h e p a r a m e t e r s
o n t h e a r c I b e c h o s e n so t h a t SA < 0, si > 0
( F i g u r e 163). T h e n
367
Ch.XI1. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLE FROM LOOP OF SADDLE-NODE SEPARATRIX
and let po> 0 be s o s m a l l that for all p, lpl<po, the following conditions
a r e satisfied:
1) 1 is an a r c without contact of (A,), and f o r a l l s , / s l < q , the succession
function ;=f,,(s) of t h i s s y s t e m is defined on the a r c .
2 ) U,(Lo)contains no equilibrium s t a t e s of (A,) and - either f o r all
p > 0 or f o r a l l p < 0 - it contains no closed paths of (A,) (the l a t t e r proposi-
tion is t r u e by T h e o r e m 71, 32.4).
3) T h e r e exist s e p a r a t r i c e s L,, and L , of (A,) which c r o s s the a r c 1 at
the points M;,, Mi,, M;,, M i , corresponding t o the values si,, si,, s&,, s;, of
the p a r a m e t e r s , such that
sb,<si, <s;,< s;,
and
si, = f, (sb,), s;, = f,
(sip).
4 ) The coils Afb,MiF and Mz,M;, of the paths Li,and L2, a r e contained
in (Lo)( F i g u r e 164).
FIGURE 164
and let
( k = 2,3, ... 1.
In virtue of o u r assumptions, i f p = 0, then for any k , 2 ,
Let Ci, and CZ,,be the simple closed c u r v e s formed respectively by the
c o i l s Mb,Mi, and M;,rMi, of the paths L,, and L Z pand the segments Mi,Mb, and
M;,M;,of the a r c 1 .
It is readily s e e n that in o u r c a s e the curve C,, is enclosed by C,,, and
i f po is sufficiently s m a l l , the region r,, between these two c u r v e s is
368
c o n t a i n e d i n L ' e o ( 0 ) . We a s s u m e t h a t t h i s c o n d i t i o n i s i n d e e d s a t i s f i e d . T h e
l i m i t cycle L o i s clearly e n c l o s e d b e t w e e n t h e c u r v e s C I Oa n d ( ' 2 0 .
P v c o n d i t i o n 2 , for all ci of a c e r t a i n s i g n (it' O < I ~ 1 -=cp0), C;,(L,)contains
n o c l o s e d p a t h s of (-A,,j. L e t t h i s b e s o Sur p o s i t i v e p . C n n s i d e r a p a t h L I P ,
r:;hcr.e o < p < p 8 , . As t i n c r e a s e s , t h e p a t h Lrll e n t e r s i n t o t h e r e g i o n r,,
between the c u r v e s and C'?, ( r , , c l : e o ( f . o )c) r, o s s i n g t h r o u g h t h e point N i b .
S i n c e CEO ( L , , ) c o n t a i n s n e i t h e r e q u i l i b r i u m s t a t e s n o r c l o s e d p a t h s of (Ap),
t h e p a t h L , , w i l l l e a v e L.e,,(L.o), a n d t h u s t h e r e g i o n ru, as t i n c r e a s e s f u r t h e r .
T h i ; m a y o c c u r o n l y i f L.,, c r o s s e s t h e s e g m e n t JI,JIi,. o f :he a r c without
r m t a c r 1 . C o n s e q l i e n t l y , t h e r e e s i s r s a natiAral n u m b e r A\
i . e., s u c h That
SS&* = siw*.
T h i s r e l a t i o n i s c l e a r l v u n f e a s i b l e , s i n c e (Afi.) h a s a s a d d l e - t o - s a d d l e
s e p a t - a t r i x and (-4) h a s n'3 s u c h s e p a r a t r i c e s i n t h e n e i g h b o r h o o d of W .
LVe h a v e t h u s e s t a b l i s h e d a c o n t r a d i c t i o n , w h i c h p r o v e s t h e t h e o r e t n .
T h e o v e m 66. A system of the f i r s t degree of strrictiiral instability
in If' cannot have in this region a saddle-point separatrix which goes (for
t 4 - 00 or f o r t -++- 00) lo a saddle-point separatrix forming a loop.
P r n n f . Again s u p p o s e t h a t t h e t h e o r e m i s not t r u e , i . e . , s y s t e m ( A )
n f t h e f i r s t d e g r e e of s t r u c t u r a l i n s t a b i l i t y h a s i n Lf? a s e p a r a t r i s Lo of t h e
s a d d l e - p o i n t 0 (q, yo) which forms a l o o p a n d a
s e p a r a t r i x L i of t h e s a d d l e point 0, (z,. yl) w h i c h
goes t o t h e l o o p L o for t + C 00 ( t h e s a d d l e p o i n t s
(3 and 0,a r e c l e a r l y d i f f e r e n t ) . By T h e o r e m 60,
[J (zo,yo) # 0 f o r t h e s a d d l e point 0 , a n d b y
'Theorem 44, s29.1,
(J ( Z O ? Yo) <0. (74)
To fix i d e a s , s u p p o s e t h a t t w o s e p a r a t r i c e s of
FIGURE 165 t h e s a d d l e p o i n t 0 w h i c h a r e d i f f e r e n t f r o m Lo l i e
369
Ch.XI1. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLE FROM LOOP OF SADDLE-NODE SEPARATRIX
FIGURE 166
is thus defined on the segment APof the a r c I , i . e., for a < s < O .
Moreover, f o r e v e r y integer N, t h e r e is an N-th successive point for
e v e r y point of the a r c A P ,
~ L=
V fN (s).
Consider two successive points M o and M 1 among the intersection points of
the s e p a r a t r i x Liwith the a r c A P . Let so and s, be the values of the p a r a -
m e t e r s corresponding t 3 these points, and to and ti the corresponding t i m e s
on the path L,. C l e a r l y to t l , and so <si. Moreover, l e t the point M obe
s o close to the loop Lo that the segment M a l of the path Lo is contained in
U,, (Lo)( F i g u r e 1 6 6 ) .
Consider the modified s y s t e m
dx
-dt
= P (2, Y) - PQ (ZVA), -$= Q Y)
(I, + PP (Z, V) t (Ad
which is obtained from (A) by a rotation of the vector field. For all suf-
ficiently s m a l l p # 0, (A,,) h a s no s e p a r a t r i c e s forming loops in U., ( L o ) ,
5438 370
S 31. SYSTELIS OF THE FIRST DEGREE OF STRUCTUR.4L INSTABILITY
bur i t h a s t w o d i f f e r e n t s e p a r a t r i c e s L; ( p ) a n d Li (p) c r o s s i n g t h e a r c 1 i n
t h i s neighborhood.
L e t Li (p) b e a n a - s e p a r a t r i x a n d Li (p) a n a - s e p a r a t r i x of t h e s a d d l e
point 0 .
L e t P' (p) and P" ( p ) b e t h e " f i r s t " i n t e r s e c t i o n p o i n t s of t h e s e p a r a t r i c e s
L, (p) a n d Li (p), r e s p e c t i v e l y , with t h e a r c I , so t h a t t h e s e g m e n t OP' (p)of
t h e p a t h L; (p) a n d t h e s e g m e n t OP"(p)of t h e p a t h L i ( p ) c o n t a i n s n o p o i n t s of
t h e a r c 1 , e x c e p t P' ( p ) a n d P" (p). L e t s ' ( p ) a n d S* ( p ) be t h e v a l u e s of t h e
p a r a m e t e r s c o r r e s p o n d i n g t o t h e p o i n t s P' (p)a n d P" (p). C l e a r l y ,
lims' (p) = lim s* (p)= 0. (75)
k-0 P-tO
s
a n d t h a t for p = 0 t h e futiction = f (s, p) r e d u c e s t o t h e s u c c e s s i o n f u n c t i o n
of t h e o r i g i n a l s y s t e m ( f (s,0) f (s)) d e f i n e d o n t h e s e g m e n t d P of t h e a r c I .
S i n c e for t h e o r i g i n a l s y s t e m , e v e r y p o i n t of t h e s e g m e n t -4P of t h e a r c I
h a s a n iV-th s u c c e s s o r f o r e v e r y i n t e g e r .V, t h e n for a n y g i v e n .V e v e r y
f i x e d p o i n t of t h e s e g m e n t A P of t h e a r c I w i l l h a v e a n N - t h s u c c e s s o r
for t h e s y s t e m A,, p r o v i d e d p is s u f f i c i e n t l y small. W e w i l l d e s i g n a t e t h i s
successor by
-
s.\- = f.r (s, p).
C l e a r l y , f X ( s , p) i s a c o n i i n u o u s f u n c t i o n of p ( f o r t h o s e v a l u e s of p f o r w h i c h
it i s d e f i n e d ) .
R v L e m m a 3, 3 9 . 2 , a n d t h e r e m a r k to t h i s lemma, w e c o n c l u d e t h a t if
p # O is s u f f i c i e n t l y s m a l l , (-43has a s e p a r a t r i x 51 (p) of t h e s a d d l e p o i n t O1
w h i c h crosses t h e a r c w i t h o u t c o n t a c t 1 a t t h e p o i n t s i%lo ( p ) a n d M , (p), w h e r e
-%Io ( p )-+ :Ifo a n d MI ( p ) -+ MI for p --t 0 . Let so (p) a n d si (p)b e t h e v a l u e s of
t h e p a r a m e t e r s c o r r e s p o n d i n g t o M 0 ( p ) a n d Mi (p). B y t h e l e m m a of 11 .I,
i f p 0, w e h a v e so ( p ) > s,, a n d s1 (p) > sI.
W e m o r e o v e r a s s u m e t h a t po is so s m a l l t h a t if I p 1 < po, t h e coil of t h e
p a t h LI (p)b e t w e e n t h e po:.nts -%Io(p) a n d Mi (p) is e n t i r e l y c o n t a i n e d i n U,, ( L a ) .
B y t h e r e m a r k t o Lemma 3 , 9.2, so (p),sl (p), s' (p), a n d s" (p) a r e c o n -
t i n u o u s f u n c t i o n s of p. -41~0n o t e t h a t t h e e q u i l i b r i u m s t a t e s of (A) a n d (AJ
c o i n c i d e , a n d t h e r e f o r e (A,) h a s no e q u i l i b r i u m s t a t e s , e x c e p t t h e s a d d l e
point 0 , i n o', (Lo).
It f o l l o w s f r o m the a b o v e t h a t if eo > O a n d pa >O a r e s u f f i c i e n t l y s m a l l ,
a n d Oe p Q po, t h e f o l l o w i n g i n e q u a l i t i e s a r e s a t i s f i e d
so @'I< si (p)<s' (I*) 0, s" (PI > 0
371
Ch.XII. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLE FROM LOOP OF SADDLt-NODE SEPAKATRIX I
and U,, (Lo)contains no closed paths of (A,,) and no equilibrium s t a t e s , except
the saddle point 0 .
Since M i(p) is the s u c c e s s o r of M o (p), we have
fN(SO(p)v p)Es(p),
FIGURE 167
372
9 31. SYSTELLS OF THE FIRST DEGREE OF STRCCTCRAL U'STABILITY
FIGURE 168
C h o o s e a f i x e d p* a n d t h e c o r r e s p o n d i n g X*.
For p = 0, f o r e v e r y . V , a n d i n p a r t i c u l a r f o r N = N * , t h e r e e x i s t s a
n e g a t i v e n u m b e r / X I (so (0), 0). P u t so (p), s' (p), s" (p), fw (sa (p), p) are c o n t i n u o u s
f u n c t i o n s of p . T h e r e f o r e , if p*+, 0 < p * * < p*, is s u f f i c i e n t l y s m a l l , t h e
n u m b e r f.v* (so (p**), p * ) is close t o f,v. (so (p*), p * ) , a n d t h e n u m b e r s' (p**) is
close to zero, so that
f s . ($0 (I***). p*) < s' (P**). (77)
373
I
Ch.X[I. CREATION OF LIhlI I CYCLE FKOhi LOOP OF SADDLE-NOUE S E P A R A T R I X
314
5 ?l. SYSTEhlS OF THE FIRST DEGREE OF STRL.CTL'R.AL IiiST.4YILITY
3 75
Ch.XI1. CREATION OF LIMIT CYCLE FROM LOOP OF SADDLE-NODE SEPAPATRIX
376
C h a p t e r XIII
IXTRODUCTIO?S
377
Ch.XIII. LIMIT CYCLES OF SYSTEMS DEPENDING ON A PARAMETER
I
a r e known as H a m i 1t o n i a n s y s t e m s , and they constitute a particular
c a s e of conservative s y s t e m s .
In s33.2, we consider s y s t e m s which a r e c l o s e t o the l i n e a r conservative
system
x= -y 9 y=x, (Bo)
i . e ., s y s t e m s of the form
378
5 2 % EFFECT OF S l I A L L CH.4NGES LK P.IR-Ih!ETOI
w h e r e q ( t ) a n d + ( t ) are p e r i o d i c f u n c t i o n s of p e r i o d T w h i c h c o n s t i t u t e t h e
s o l u t i o n c o r r e s p o n d i n g t o t h e p a t h Lo.
As i n 1 3 , we d e f i n e c u r v i l i n e a r c o o r d i n a t e s s, n i n t h e n e i g h b o r h o o d
of t h i s p a t h ,
-
z = ( P ( s . n). y = i ( s , n), (2)
w.here t h e f u n c t i o n s 6 a n d 3 h a v e t h e following p r o p e r t i e s :
I ) @ and 5 a r e defined i n t h e s t r i p
d o e s not v a n i s h e v e r b y w h e r e i n t h e s t r i p ( 3 ) , i . e . , it r e t a i n s a c o n s t a n t
sign in this strip.
T h e f u n c t i o n 'p(s. n) a n d q ( s + n) m a y b e t a k e n , i n p a r t i c u l a r , i n t h e s a m e
f o r m as i n 13
L e t u s c h a n g e o v e r t o t h e v a r i a b l e s s, n i n all t h e s y s t e m s (A,,) w i t h
s u f f i c i e n t l v s m a l l p . Differentiating ( 2 ) with r e s p e c t t o t and using t h e
e q u a t i o n s of (-Ip), w e fiqd
379
Ch.XIII. LIMIT CYCLES OF SYSTEMS DEPENDING ON A PARAMETER
.,
i . e because of the periodicity in s of the functions $ and for - 00 < s < + oc,
In I < n*, 1 pl <p* . Hence it follows that R (s, n, p) is a n analytical function f o r
--oo<s<+w, [ n ( < n * , lpl<p*. Therefore, i t can be expanded in a series
i n powers of n, p in the neighborhood of any point in t h i s region, and the
coefficients of this series w i l l be analytical functions of s. It is readily
s e e n that
R (s,0, 0) 3 0. (8)
f (s; 0, 0, 0) =0
and the expansion of the function f in powers of no and p h a s the f o r m
f (s; 0 , no,~ ~ = a l o ~ ~ + a o , ~ + a ~ o n ~ + a l , n. .d r + ~ ~ B (13)
+.
H e r e the coefficients aij=a,j(s) are analytical functions of I in the interval
- q < s <7 t q .
380
I32. EFFECT OF ShlALL CH.-\NGES IN P.4RALIETER
I n s e r t i n g ( 9 ) a n d ( 1 3 ) f o r R ( s , n, p) a n d n i n e q u a t i o n (R,) a n d e q u a t i n g t h e
c o r r e s p o n d i n g c o e f f i c i e n t s in t h e r i g h t - a n d t h e l e f t - h a n d s i d e s , w e o b t a i n
t h e f o l l o w i n g r e c u r s i v e d i f f e r e n t i a l e q u a t i o n s for t h e f u n c t i o n a,, (s):
. . . . . . . . . . . . .
F y ( 1 1 ) a n d ( 1 3 ) , f o r i := 1, j = 0, w e h a v e aij ( 0 ) = 1, a n d o t h e r w i s e ,
aij (0) = 0.
T h e equalities
a10 (U, = 1. ai j (U) =- u (15)
c n n s t i t u t e t h e i n i t i a l c o n d i t i o n s for e q u a t i o n s ( 1 4 ) . T h e f u n c t i o n s a i j (s)
t h e r e f o r e c a n b e found I l y s u c c e s s i v e l y s o l v i n g e q u a t i o n s (14) w i t h b o u n d a r y
c o n d i t i o n s ( 15).
Note t h a t t h e f i n a l e l p r e s s i o n s for t h e f u n c t i o n s ai,,(s), w h i c h a r e t h e
c o e f f i c i e n t s of t h e t e r m s free f r o m 11 in e x p a n s i o n (13), a r e t h e s a m e
e x p r e s s i o n s a s i n C h a p t e r S (s26.1). I n d e e d , t h e s e f u n c t i o n s m a y b e found
b y s e t t i n g p = 0 . B u t t h i s l e a d s u s t o s y s t e m (Ao) a n d e q u a t i o n (Ro) c o n -
s i d e r e d i n C h a p t e r S.
L e t t h e s u c c e s s i o n f u n c t i o n of (A,,) o n t h e a r c without c o n t a c t I b e f (no,p).
B y d e f i n i t i o n , it i s o b t a i n e d f r o m t h e f u n c t i o n (IO) f o r S = T , i . e . ,
T h i s a n d (13) s h o w t h a t t h e s e r i e s e x p a n s i o n of t h e s u c c e s s i o n f u n c t i o n h a s
the form
-
f (no,~ ) = " ~ O ( T ) ~ O T ~ O I ( . T ) ~ ~ ~ ~ O ( T ) ~ : I I. X I ~ ( T ) ~ (~1~7 ~) .
Setting
ai, (T)= U i j ,
we obtain
n = f (no, p) = 40no f uo1p +u*on: iu11nop f .. . (19)
H ( x , Y, p) = p (IY) +PPl
?(GI/) + P*P2 (5,Y) + . . ., (23)
B ( x , Y , c ~ ) = Q ( x , Y ) + c ~ Q ~ ( ~ , Y ) +...,
~*Q~(z,~)+
and
:ye c a n v e r i f v d i r e c t l y that
($1= P; (v (4.1:(SI)
-40 +Q I (q (4,$ (s)) - d
In hoo(s) =
d
= P ; ( ( P . ~ ) + Q ; ( F .$ ) - X l n A ( s , O ) , (32)
uo1=a01 (4=
T
(P;tVp, V)+U;te. W)da - 1( P ; 4 & s
= -e0 !e 11 (Pi (939cp' (4 ---Pi (cp? $1
0)
SAio(s)dr -jAlo(s)dr
a,, ( s ) = e 0 e +
(2A10a,oaol A,,alo) ds.
uio
u,,.~ 5
0
( g t ~ - 4 t h o - ~ i o h o ~+ 2A20a oi
hoo
ds. (39)
384
S 32. EFFECT OF SJI.-\LL CHAKGES IN PARAXIETER
where
E x p r e s s i o n s ( 3 3 ) f o l ~ d O ,(30)
, f o r h o i , and ( 3 5 ) f o r a,,,
show that if
= Q l (cp
PI (cp (s). $ (4) ($1, t (-9)= 1 ' . (14)
''.! [Pix ((P (s), 3 (s)) - q i V ('F ($1. 3' (s))JA- (-151
PI (2.Y) - F (I.
Y) F; (I.Y). Y1 12. Y) - F (I* Y) F ; (2,!I), (46)
2. Statement of t h e problem
385
Ch.XIII. LIMIT CYCLES OF SYSTEMS DEPENDING ON A PARAMETER
(see (34)), t h e r e e x i s t s n* > 0 and p*>O which satisfy the following condition:
if I p I < p*, equation (48) h a s one and only one solution no = no (p), such that
I no id I < I".*.
T h i s follows f r o m the t h e o r e m of s t r u c t u r a l stability of a simple limit
cycle (see 14, r e m a r k t o T h e o r e m 18). T h i s also follows directly f r o m
the t h e o r e m of implicit functions (s 1.2, Theorem 3 and r e m a r k t o
T h e o r e m 4 ) . Indeed, we s e e f r o m (47), (19), and (49) that i f L o i s a
simple limit cycle of (Ao), then
d (0, 0) = 0, dbo(0, 0 ) # 0,
d (no, P) = 0
h a s at most k r e a l roots which a r e s m a l l e r than n* in absolute magnitude.
Indeed, let n* and p* b e such that if InoI<n*, l p l < p * , we have
386
5 2 2 . EFFECT OF ShI.lLL Ctl.WGES Lh PARA!.LETER
i n t h i s i n t e r v a l , t h e s e c o n d d e r i v a t i v e h a s a t l e a s t X. - 1 r o o t s , e t c ., a n d
t h e k - t h d e r i v a t i v e h a s a t l e a s t o n e root, which c o n t r a d i c t s ( 5 1 ) . T h u s ,
for s m a l l n o a n d p , e q u a t i o n (18)c a n n o t h a v e more t h a n k real roots. T h e
q u e s t i o n of e x i s t e n c e r*f t h e s e r o o t s , if a n y , r e q u i r e s s p e c i a l a n a l y s i s ,
h o w e v e r . T h e a n a l y s i s is c o n v e n i e n t l y c a r r i e d o u t w i t h t h e a i d of
Y e w t o n s d i a g r a m or p o l y g o n , which i s d e s c r i b e d i n t h e next
section.
3. N e w t o n s p o l y g o n and s o l u t i o n of t h e e q u a t i o n F (u,.z ) = 0
A s i g n i f i c a n t point i n o u r a n a l y s i s of t h e roots of a f u n c t i o n is t h e
a s s u m p t i o n that t h e v a - i a b l e s are c o m p l e x - v a l u e d .
k5e w i l l t h e r e f o r e c o n s i d e r a n a n a l y t i c a l f u n c t i o n F (w,z ) , w h e r e u7
and. z a r e c o m p l e x v a r i a b l e s . T h e r e s u l t s w i l l t h e n b e a p p l i e d to t h e
c a s e of real u- a n d 2 .
Let F j O , 0 ) 0 . The e x p a n s i o n of F (m,z ) in p o w e r s of u a n d J a r o u n d
t h e point ( 0 , O ) h a s t h e form
We i n t r o d u c e o n e fur-ther a s s u m p t i o n r e g a r d i n g t h e f u n c t i o n F (u-,z ) ,
n a m e l v t h a t a t l e a s t one of t h e c o e f f i c i e n t s uil) a n d a t l e a s t o n e of t h e
c o e f f i c i e n t s u O jd o not v a n i s h , i . e . , t h e e x p a n s i o n ( 5 2 ) c o n t a i n s a t l e a s t
o n e t e r m w i t h o u t z a n d a t l e a s t o n e t e r m without IC. T h i s a s s u m p t i o n
does not c o n s t i t u t e a f u n d a m e n t a l r e s t r i c t i o n of o u r p r o b l e m ( t h e p r o b l e m
(i -
of s o l u t i o n of t h e e q u a t i o n F (u,,z ) = 0 for u,). I n d e e d , f o r all u , =~ 0
1,2, . . . ), t h e f u n c t i o n F (a*.z ) m a y be w r i t t e n i n the form
F (w,3) = zF,( w , 3)
a n d r h e p r o b l e m r e d u c e s t o t h e a n a l y s i s of t h e e q u a t i o n F , (u-.z ) = 0 . The
s i t u a t i o n is s i m i l a r w h e n all u o , = 0 ( j > 0).
T h e f o l l o w i n g a n a l v s i s i s b a s e d on a n u m b e r of t h e o r e m s from t h e t h e o r y
of ana1,ytical f u n c t i o n s , w h i c h are p a r t l y g i v e n h e r e w i t h o u t p r o o f .
T h e o r e tn 68 (the theorem of implicit functions). Let F (u,.z ) be an
analytical junction in the neighborhood of (0. 0 ) and let
F (0. 0 )= 0, F&( 0 , 0 ) + 0.
There exist 6 > 0 am! E > 0 such that f o r every 3 , I z I < 6, the eqiuztim
f iu.. z ) 11has one and only one root U = f ( 5 ) satisfying the inequality
I f ( z ) I < E . The junction f ( z ) can be expanded in positive integral powers
of z , and the series tcili be convergent for 1 z 1 < 6 , i . e., it will be a
single- valued analytical function of z which vanishes at 3 = 0 .
T h e o r e m 68 is the t h e o r e m of i m p l i c i t f u n c t i o n s i n t h e case of c o m p l e x
v a r i a b l e s . I t s p r o o f c a n b e found i n / 2 2 / , C h . IV, p . 354. T h e p r o o f
u s e s a m a j o r a n t series. Theorem 68 is also a d i r e c t c o n s e q u e n c e of
t h e following t h e o r e m .
387
Ch.XIII. LIMIT CYCLES OF SYSTEMS DEPENDING ON A PARAMETER
I
Then in some neighborhood 1 W I c E, I z I < 6 of (0, O), F (w, Z) may be represented
in the form
F (w, Z) = [wk + A , (2) W h - l + ... +Ah (Z)]0 (W,Z). (54)
F (w, Z) = 0 (55)
F(w. z ) = O
has precisely k roots (either different m coinciding) wit w 2 , . . ., wh, which
a r e smaller than E in absolute magnitude. Moreover, i f Z + O , each of the
roots w i also goes to z e r o .
P r o o f . T h e validity of T h e o r e m 70 follows directly f r o m the previous
t h e o r e m and f r o m the theorem of the continuous dependence of the roots of
a polynomial on i t s coefficients ( s e e 1291, 73). Indeed, T h e o r e m 69 shows
that the roots of the equation F (w, z) = 0 coincide with the r o o t s of equation
(56). By (57), equation (56) h a s k r o o t s a t z = 0, which a r e a l l z e r o . T h e r e -
fore, the roots of equation (56) go t o z e r o f o r z - t 0.
R e m a r k . The roots wl, w 2 , . . ., wh of equation (55) depend on z.
Suppose that f o r s o m e z = zo all t h e s e r o o t s are different. It is readily
s e e n that in t h i s c a s e the roots w,, w2, . . ., wIcan be defined in the neighbor-
hood of the point zo so that they a r e analytical functions of z in thisneighbor-
hood (to e n s u r e all this, it suffices t o r e q u i r e that the r o o t s w t (z) v a r y
continuously with the variation of z).
388
s32. EFFECT OF SI\I;\LL CHANGES IN PARAhlETER
where 7
-3% and f q . 9 are t o b e r e g a r d e d as o n e (fixed) value of e a c h
u20
w=T*,za''~+5Lzz3t+ ...,
w h e r e a,# 0. T h e last series g i v e s both solutions f o r w, s i n c e zl'a is a
two-valued function of z .
If equation (55) h a s the form
uo1z + u& + Ug& = 0,
389
Ch.XII1. LIMIT CYCLES OF SYSTEMS DEPENDING ON A PARAME'IEK
w = &'/a f $zz4/s + . . .,
where p i # 0, and t h i s notation gives all the t h r e e solutions of the equation,
since Z1/3 is a three-valued function of z.
In the above examples, the solutions of equation (55) a r e expressed by
series in fractional (rational) positive powers of z. This suggests that the
s a m e representation w i l l obtain in the g e n e r a l c a s e also. W e will therefore
s e e k solutions of (55) in the f o r m
W=yza+y~zal+y,z-+
where y # 0, and a and a , are positive rational numbers, a < a, < az < ...
..., (59)
I
Let u s f i r s t establish what power exponent a will e n s u r e convergence of
the power s e r i e s (59) to a solution of equation (55) f o r s m a l l z .
Let ukobe the f i r s t nonzero coefficient of the f o r m u i oin expansion (52),
and uo( the f i r s t nonzero coefficient of the f o r m uoI (these coefficients exist
by assumption).
If (59) i s a solution of equation (55), we have
F(yza+y,z"+ ..., Z ) E O , (60)
where 1 < i < k - 1, and the index ji s a t i s f i e s the inequalities l < j i < 1- 1
and is m o r e o v e r the s m a l l e s t index j f o r which the coefficient ut, with
fixed 1 does not vanish.
It is readily s e e n that the t e r m s of lowest o r d e r in z must be contained
among the t e r m s (61) and ( 6 2 ) .
If identity (60) is satisfied, t e r m s of the lowest o r d e r in E mutually
cancel. Since none of the coefficients U ~ in J (61) and (62) is z e r o , we con-
clude that a t l e a s t two such t e r m s should b e of the s a m e o r d e r , which,
however, should not exceed the o r d e r of the remaining t e r m s . Thus,
the numbers
ka, ( k - i ) a + j k - i r (k--)a+jR-21 . - . $ a+iiT 1 (63)
include a t l e a s t two equal numbers which a r e not g r e a t e r than all the other
numbers. Suppose that j k = 0 and i o = [ , i . e., the numbers in (63) have the
f o r m iz+ j , , i = O , 1, 2, . . . , k. Then a should satisfy a t l e a s t one of the l i n e a r
equations
$2:. EFFECr OF SlIALL CH.WGES IS PARAh!ETER
T h e s e v a l u e s of a w i l l tte c a l l e d f e a s i b 1e . T h e r e m a y b e s e v e r a l
f e a s i b l e v a l u e s . To find all t h e f e a s i b l e v a l u e s , w e w i l l u s e a g e o m e t r i c a l
m e t h o d known a s t h e m e t h o d of N e w t o n ' s p o 1 y g o n .
Lye i n t r o d u c e r e c t a n # u l a r c o o r d i n a t e s i. j i n t h e p l a n e a n d a s s i g n t o
e v e r y t e r m in ( 6 1 1 and ( 6 2 ) a point -4; o n t h e p l a n e Lvith t h e c o o r d i n a t e s (i. ji)
( i - I). 1. 2. . . ., k). T h e t e r m s i n ( 6 1 ) e v i d e n t l y c o r r e s p o n d t o p o i n t s of t h e
f o r m ito(0, I ) a n d -4h(k. 0)w h i c h lie o n t h e c o o r d i n a t e axes: the o t h e r p o i n t s
A i fall i n t h e f i r s t q u a d r a n t , a n d t h e i r a b s c i s s a s a n d o r d i n a t e s d o n o t
e x c e e d k - 1 a n d 1 - 1, r e s p e c t i v e l y .
S u p p o s e t h a t for s o m e r e l a t i o n ( 6 4 ) is s a t i s f i e d , a n d il # i2. T h e n
11% -i i ,
i2--l1 '
i.e., a i s t h e s l o p e f a c t o r of t h e s t r a i g h t l i n e t h r o u g h t h e p o i n t s A , , ( i , . ji,) a n d
-L2tLiiJ.
T h e e q u a t i o n of t h i s . s t r a i g h t l i n e is
C l e a r l v , f o r t h e p o i n t s fi. j ) w h i c h lie n o t 1o w e r t h a n t h e l i n e ( 6 6 ) , w e
h a v e j - j , , + a (i - i I ) 2.0 , i . e.,
a n d for t h e p o i n t s b e 1o w t h i s l i n e , w e h a v e
.
C o n d i t i o n ( 6 5 ) s i g n i f i e s t h a t e a c h of t h e p o i n t s -4, (i, j , ) , i = 0 , 1, 2, . . , A-,
l i e s e i t h e r o n t h e l i n e (E6) o r a b o v e t h i s l i n e . H e n c e i t follorvs t h a t e v e r y
f e a s i b l e a i s i n a o n e - t o - o n e c o r r e s p o n d e n c e to a s t r a i g h t l i n e p a s s i n g a t
l e a s t t h r o u g h t w o p o i n t s A;, w h i c h h a s a n e g a t i v e s l o p e f a c t o r a n d is s o
l o c a t e d t h a t n o n e of t h - p o i n t s .A, lies b e l o w t h i s l i n e . W e w i l l r e f e r t o
t h e s e l i n e s a s f e a s i b 1e 1i n e s . a is e q u a l t o m i n u s t h e s l o p e f a c t o r
of t h e c o r r e s p o n d i n g l i n e .
T h u s , i n o r d e r t o find all t h e f e a s i b l e v a l u e s of a , w e s h o u l d find all
t h e f e a s i b l e l i n e s . T h i s c a n b e a c c o m p l i s h e d i n t h e following way. L e t
s b e a m o v i n g l i n e w h i c h i n i t i a l l y c o i n c i d e s w i t h t h e axis i. W e t u r n t h i s
l i n e c l o c k w i s e a r o u n d the point A h (k,0) u n t i l it p a s s e s t h r o u g h o n e of t h e
p o i n t s A i , t h e point A*, (hI,j k , ) say. T h e l i n e -A!,;ik, o b t a i n e d i n t h i s w a y w i l l
b e d e s i g n a t e d sl. T h i s is e v i d e n t l y a f e a s i b l e l i n e . T h e l i n e s1 m a y p a s s
t h r o u g h m o r e t h a n t w o p o i n t s A t . T h e n , l e t An, b e t h e l e f t m o s t of t h e s e
p o i n t s ( i . e . , t h e o n e with t h e l e a s t a b s c i s s a ) .
If .4kl d o e s not c o i n c i d e w i t h t h e point .-to (0, I ) , t h e m o v i n g l i n e w i l l b e
f u r t h e r r o t a t e d i n t h e c l o c k w i s e d i r e c t i o n a r o u n d t h e p o i n t AR, u n t i l i t
p a s s e s t h r o u g h s o m e point Aka (k,, j k t ) (if t h e r e a r e s e v e r a l s u c h p o i n t s ,
.Ah, is chosen a s the l e f t m o s t ) . The r e s u l t i n g c u r v e is d e s i g n a t e d SZ,
a n d t h e p r o c e s s is c o n t i n u e d u n t i l t h e m o v i n g l i n e p a s s e s t h r o u g h t h e
39 I
-
point A , (0,1). T h e r e s u l t is a s t r a i g h t
line designated ,s ( F i g u r e 169). In p a r t i c -
u l a r c a s e s , m m a y b e equal t o 1.
T h e convex polygonal line AkAa,Ak,. ..
...
Ak,-iAo obtained in t h i s construction
i s known a s N e w t o n ' s p o l y g o n (or
N e w t o n ' s d i a g r a m ) . It is c l e a r
f r o m the construction that each s i d e of
Newton's polygon is a segment of a
feasible line. It is r e a d i l y seen, however,
that the c o n v e r s e is a l s o true: e v e r y
feasible line contains a segment which
is one of t h e s i d e s of Newton's polygon.
D A*no' We have thus established that all the
FIGURE 169 feasible values of a are equal t o minus
the slope f a c t o r s of the s i d e s of Newton's
polygon.
Now let the a i n expansion (59) b e one
of the feasible values of the index. We will d e t e r m i n e the corresponding
value of the coefficient y . T o t h i s end, we s h a l l make u s e of the condition
that the lowest t e r m s in t h e left-hand s i d e of t h e identity (60) should mutually
cancel. T o fix ideas, let a be t h e slope f a c t o r of the s i d e Ak,Attz of Newton's
polygon and let .411,A,2,.. ., A + k, > lI > l 2 > . . . > l a > k2, b e those among
the points A i which lie on t h i s side. The lowest t e r m s of the corresponding
e x p r e s s i o n will cancel out i f t h e coefficient of the lowest d e g r e e of 3; (equal
+
t o k,a j k l = Ita + j l l =. . ..= k2a +
j h z ) is z e r o , i. e., if
Since b y assumption y +
0, we a r e only i n t e r e s t e d i n the nonzero r o o t s
of equation (69). i . e., t h e r o o t s of t h e polynomial
392
$3'2. EFFECT OF ShfALL CH.4NGES IN PAR.4IIETER
L e t a - .L w h e r e p a n d q are i r r e d u c i b l e n u m b e r s , b e a f e a s i b l e v a l u e
v'
of t h e i n d e s c o r r e s p o n d i n g , as b e f o r e , to t h e s i d e A-l,,,.4tt:of N e w t o n ' s polygon,
a n d y = = 0 o n e of t h e r o ' 3 t s of e q u a t i o n ( 6 9 ) . T h e e q u a l i t i e s
k,z+ j k , = ip.-r i l l = . .. 7 =k
l,a-..,ir. ~ j k+.
To i n v e s t i g a t e t h e e q u a t i o n F (w,)I = 0 for :.
i0, w e s u b s t i t u t e
w h e r e ;I 1 is o n e of t h e '7 p o s s i b l e v a l u e s of t h i s q - v a l u e d f u n c t i o n . Using
( 5 2 ) a n d ( 6 0 ) , we r e a d i l y see t h a t
hl? i'bl
F (u,3) = F ( l . 9 q , 3) = 2 [g(L.)-z*',lT(Y* ;*q1. (73)
T h e c o e f f i c i e n t s of t h e pori-er series r e p r e s e n t i n g t h e f u n c t i o n q- ( 1 . . 5) a n d
t h e r e f o r e t h e f u n c t i o n i t s e l f a r e i n d e p e n d e n t of t h e p a r t i c u l a r v a l u e of t h e
q-valued function q u s e d in t h e s u b s t i t u t i o n (72).
F v (71),
Cb(y,O)=O, (P;(y. O ) # O .
T h e r e f o r e , b y T h e o r e m 68 ( t h e t h e o r e m of i m p l i c i t f u n c t i o n s ) , e q u a t i o n ( 7 5 )
h a s a u n i q u e s o l u t i o n i n a s u f f i c i e n t l y small n e i g h b o r h o o d of t h e point 5 = 0,
w h i c h r e d u c e s t o y f o r := 0 . T h i s s o l u t i o n h a s t h e f o r m
393
Ch.XIII. LIhlIT CYCLES OF SYSTEMS DEPENDING ON A PARAMETER
I ...+ r,
r,+rz+
I different o r d e r s of s m a l l n e s s relative t o z; t h e r e f o r e l i m
0 o r m, and the equality w i( 2 1 ) = w z (21) b r e a k s down for l a r g e 1 . If the
W 2 (Id
is either
I coefficients y . T h e r e f o r e l i m m=+l
Wz(b1)
and the equality w 1 ( z I=) w z ( z i ) again
b r e a k s down. O u r proposition is thus proved. It follows that a l l the k
solutions (79) of the equation F ( w , z) = 0 which g o t o zero f o r z-+ 0 are
different. But then by T h e o r e m 70, the functions (79) exhaust all the
solutions of the equation F ( w , z ) = 0 which go to zero f o r z-+ 0.
We will now show how to find the cyclic s y s t e m s of solutions men-
tioned in the r e m a r k t o T h e o r e m 70. In the p r o c e s s we will d e r i v e a
different f o r m of solutions (79), which w i l l be useful a t a l a t e r stage.
A s before, we a s s u m e that f o r e v e r y a i , i = 1, 2, . . ., m , all the non-
z e r o roots of equation (69) are s i m p l e . It suffices t o consider one of
the feasible values at. W e will designate i t a, and l e t
a=plq, , (P, 9) =I.
Let
h (Y)= W l j h ; Y k l - - A a t U . ..
~ ~ j ~ , y ~ - ~ ~-f- - 6&hsj**
f - (70)
b e the polynomial h corresponding t o the given a.
We have s e e n before that h ( y ) is a polynomial of d e g r e e d = k k 2 in y f .
q
Let
r=yg (80)
and
394
5 3'7. EFFECT OF S h I A L L CHANGES Ih' P.W&:ETER
and all the r o o t s of the polynomial h ( y ) a r e simple, the n u m b e r s rl, I'z. ..., r,
a r e all different.
Let
~ Z I Si?.
I - . . .) Y i y (83)
(L.. ',. -
- 5: (yijf yij,5, i-
y& . ..) ( j = I, 2, . ... q ) . (86)
CII,
C
w e obtain a s e t of Q solutions
- - >.. . . ,
U Z l . LC Vi*+ (88)
where
395
Ch.XII1. LIMIT CYCLES OF SYSTEMS DEPENDING ON A PARAMETER
where Lo is any fixed value of 7;. Making torun o v e r all the values of t h i s
root, we obtain q solutions
W i t , Wiz, . .. t Wiqr
396
5 3 2 . EFFECT OF Shl.4LL CHANGES IN PARAhlETER
o n l y c o n s i d e r s y s t e m s 2f t w o p a r t i c u l a r t y p e s , o n e of w h i c h i n c l u d e s
s y s t e m s o b t a i n e d from some f i x e d s y s t e m b y a r o t a t i o n of t h e v e c t o r
f i e l d . T h e m e t h o d s u s e d , h o w e v e r , c a n b e a p p l i e d t o o t h e r t y p e s of
s v s t e m s depending on a p a r a m e t e r . A s throughout this c h a p t e r , we
will a g a i n c o n s i d e r o n l y a n a l y t i c a l d y n a m i c s y s t e m s .
W e w i l l f i r s t p r o v e ;I n u m b e r of l e m m a s , w h i c h a r e e x t e n s i v e l y u s e d
i n t h e m a i n p r o p o s i t i o n s . T h e s e lemmas follow d i r e c t l y f r o m t h e r e s u l t s
of t h e p r e v i o u s s u b s e c t i o n .
Consider the equaticn
F (u;3) = U +
~ ~ Z Uoi2
C + u?~u*1- . . . = 0 . (55)
T h e r e f o r e , t h e e q u a t i o n F ( w , 2 ) = 0 h a s 21 s o l u t i o n s . A s w e h a v e s e e n
b e f o r e , all t h e s e s o l u t i o n s m a y b e w r i t t e n i n t h e form
b e t h e y i n ( 9 2 ) . T h e n a l l t h e c o e f f i c i e n t s y i , i = 1, 2 , . . . , a r e also real
b v L e m m a 1.
If z > O , t h e r e e x i s t t w o real v a l u e s of t h e f u n c t i o n z * / z l . T h e s e v a l u e s
c o r r e s p o n d , b y ( 9 2 ) , t o real v a l u e s of w . T h e c o m p l e x v a l u e s of z ~ / cor- * ~
r e s p o n d for s u f f i c i e n t l y small z to v a l u e s
of w w h i c h a r e close to t h e c o m p l e x n u m b e r
+,i . e . , a r e also c o m p l e x . If z c 0 , all
L==-
zt
47/41) t h e v a l u e s of t h e f u n c t i o n ~ 1 2 1are c o m p l e x ,
a n d t h e f u n c t i o n w m a y not have real v a l u e s
for s u f f i c i e n t l y s m a l l z .
U &,kUI S i n c e all t h e r o o t s of e q u a t i o n ( 9 1 ) are
FIGURE 170 d i f f e r e n t , all t h e k = 21 r o o t s of t h e e q u a t i o n
Ch.XII1. LIMIT CYCLES OF SYSTEMS DEPENDING ON A PARAMETER
uzl+l,oYsl+l +uot = 0,
and the corresponding solution of the equation P(w,z) = 0 is
is an analytical function of z . By L e m m a 1,
all the yr ( i = 1,2, . . . ) are real and, t h e r e -
f o r e , f o r any r e a l a , the solution 10 is r e a l .
The equation f o r y corresponding t o a2=f is
UZl+l o y ~ ~ + 1u,,y
+ =0 (95)
398
E :23. EFFECT OF ShlALL CHANGES I X PARAhlETER
*
C o n s i d e r the c a s e %+r 0 < 0 . Equation (96) h a s a real r o o t and, as i.n
o u r proof of L e m m a 2 , we c a n show that t h e r e a r e two real solutions of
the f o r m (96) f o r z > O and no such solutions f o r z < 0 . T h u s , if *o< 0, t h e
equation F ( w , z) = 0 h a s t h r e e real solutions for z > 0 (one of the f o r m ( 9 4 )
and two of the f o r m ( 9 6 : ) , and only one real solution (of the f o r m ( 0 4 ) ) f o r
z4.0.
T h e case co>O i s reduced t o the p r e v i o u s case b y substituting - z
for z . In t h i s c a s e , t h e equation F ( w , z ) = 0 h a s one real solution for z > O ,
and t h r e e real solutions f o r z < 0 . Since all t h e r o o t s of equation (95) a r e
different, all t h e r o o t s of t h e equation F ( w . s) = 0 (and i n p a r t i c u l a r , i t s
real r o o t s ) are also different and hence s i m p l e . T h i s c o m p l e t e s the proof
of t h e l e m m a .
We c a n now proceed u i t h t h e main propositions of t h i s subsection. We
will f i r s t e s t a b l i s h what happens t o a l i m i t c y c l e of a dynamic s y s t e m
when t h e v e c t o r field is rotated. T h e o r e m s 71 and 72 provide the a n s w e r s
t o this question.
Let
b e the s t a r t i n g analvtical s y s t e m .
T h e s v s t e m (A,) dep3nding o n a p a r a m e t e r i s chosen in t h e f o r m
__
it = P (I,Y) - pQ (5. Y) = p(z. Y. P).
dz
'$=Q(z. Y) t p P ( 5 , y ) = b ( z 7 Y, P),
399
Ch.XII1. LIMIT CYCLES OF SYSTEMS DEPENDING ON A PARAMETER
In particular,
d (no,0)= (ul0- 1) no +u m : + %n: + ... (99)
X==(P(O? Y=11,(4,
where 'p and 11, a r e periodic functions of period T, b e the solution of (Ao)
corresponding t o the limit cycle Lo. Then
p ('p (4, l# (4) 3 9' (4, Q ((P (4, 11, (d) E 11,' (4.
By t h e s e relations and (97), we have
400
53% EFFECT OF SLIALL CH.*GES [L P.4R.lilETER
t h e o r e m , i . e . , i t d o e s not v a n i s h . T h e p r o p o s i t i o n of T h e o r e m 7 2 t h e n
f o l l o w s d i r e c t l y from L,emma 3 . Q . E . D .
R e m a r k 1. If Lo is of m u l t i p l i c i t y 1. i . e., a s i m p l e l i m i t c y c l e of
( - A ) , t h e n it is a s t r u c t u r a l l y s t a b l e p a t h ( T h e o r e m 18, s 14). T h e r e f o r e ,
not o n l y t h e s y s t e m (A,) o b t a i n e d b y r o t a t i o n of t h e v e c t o r f i e l d , b u t a n v
s v s t e m s u f f i c i e n t l y close t o ( A ) w i l l h a v e p r e c i s e l y o n e l i m i t c y c l e i n a
S u f f i c i e n t l y s m a l l n e i g h b o r h o o d of L o . In case of h i g h e r m u l t i p l i c i t i e s of
t h e c y c l e L o , t h e r e a l w a y s e x i s t s y s t e m s a s close a s d e s i r e d to ( A ) , which
h a v e m o r e t h a n o n e l i m i t c y c l e n e a r L o . T h e o r e m 72 s h o w s t h a t i n a
s m a l l r o t a t i o n of t h e v e c t o r f i e l d , a m u l t i p l e c y c l e of odd m u l t i p l i c i t y
b e h a v e s l i k e a s i m p l e c y c l e , i . e . , t h e modified s y s t e m h a s o n e and o n l y
o n e l i m i t c y c l e i n a s u f f i c i e n t l y s m a l l n e i g h b o r h o o d of t h e o r i g i n a l c y c l e ,
which i s m o r e o v e r s t r u c t u r a l l y s t a b l e .
R e m a r k 2 . T h e o r e m s 7 1 a n d 72 a n d o u r p r o o f of t h e s e t h e o r e m s
r e m a i n v a l i d i f (-Ad is t a k e n i n t h e form
dr
-=
di J' (f,)'5 --Pf (2,Y) Q (I,Y). dy
7 = Q (2,Y) +pf (I,Y) P (2,Y).
w h e r e f (I.y) i s a f u n c t i o n w h i c h r e t a i n s a c o n s t a n t s i g n a t all p o i n t s of t h e
limit cycle Lo.
In c o n c l u s i o n of t h i s s e c t i o n , w e w i l l p r o v e a n o t h e r t h e o r e m , w h i c h i s
n o l o n g e r r e l a t e d to r o t a t i o n s of t h e v e c t o r f i e l d s .
L e t I,, b e a limit c y c l e of ( A ) , I = 'p ( t ) . y = 9 ( I ) t h e s o l u t i o n c o r r e s p o n d i n g
to t h e path L o . T > 0 t h e p e r i o d of t h i s s o l u t i o n . L e t f u r t h e r F (I,y) b e a n
ana1,ytical f u n c t i o n d e f i n e d i n t h e same r e g i o n a s s y s t e m ( A ) , w h i c h s a t i s f i e s
t h e following conditions:
(ai F ( c p ( s ) . ~ ( ( s ) ) = 0.
i (see e n d of 933.1).
l b ) I F ; ( v ( s ) . $ ( S ) ) ~ ~ + [ I ' ; ( ( F~( (Ss) ). ) I * . 0
T h e o r e m 73. Let
dr -
-
dt
=P (I y) -i-ppl ( I ,y) 4-p*p2 (". y) I .. f = P (I,y, p),
(A,)
$=Q (2,y) t p41 (I,Y) p% ( 2 , Y) t ' . . = Q (I, Y7 p)
be a dynuiiiic s y s t e m , und let the fiinctions PI (3, Y) ana' q1 (I,y) have the forni
401
Ch.XII1. LIMIT CYCLES OF SYSTEMS DEPENDING ON A PARAMETER
5438 402
5 33. CLOSED PATHS OF C0NSERL';ITIVE SYSTEAIS
J ( t )= 5 'i
(Dt)
p (E, Y) d x d y . (3)
Then 'i 5 p ( x , y ) d s d y = J ( O ) ,
(D)
a n d for e q u a l i t y ( 2 ) t 9 hold t r u e f o r a n y 1, it i s
n e c e s s a r v and sufficient that
J' ( t ) 3 0
( t h e d i f f e r e n t i a b i l i t y of J ( f )w i l l be p r o v e d b e l o w ) . To c o m p u t e J ' ( t ) , we
r e p r e s e n t J ( f )a s a n i n t e g r a l o v e r D. T h e s u b s t i t u t i o n of v a r i a b l e s
where
A I f ; so, Yo) = D (T( t ; 50. YO). $(t: 20. YO))
D(zo+ YO^
is t h e J a c o b i a n of m a p p i n g (4). This J a c o b i a n h a s b e e n c o m p u t e d i n QT,
w h e r e i t i s s h o w n (QT, 83.5, L e m m a 6) t h a t
F v (5), J ( t ) =
(W
5 pAdxo,2yo. S i n c e t h e r e g i o n of i n t e g r a t i o n i n t h i s i n t e g r a l
i s i n d e p e n d e n t of t , a n d t h e i n t e g r a n d is d i f f e r e n t i a b l e , J ( f )i s d i f f e r e n t i a b l e
and
=
J' (I) 1 5 & [ p (9( t ;
( D)
ZO, yo), 9 ( t ;50, YO)) ( t ;q,yo)] dxo &/a. (8)
403
Ch.XII1. LIhlIT CYCLES OF SYSTEMS DEPENDING ON A PARAMETER I
we find
- + ? L O .L
,=i
--'pp.
dr
dt dY=pQ
dt
i s a Hamiltonian s y s t e m
TILe o r e m 7 4 . Let ( A ) be an analytical s y s t e m , and G a closed annular
region coinpletely filled with concentric closed paths of system (A). There
exists an analytical function p (2,y) defined in G which satisfies the condition
405
Ch.XIII. LIMIT CYCLES OF SYSTEMS DEPENDING ON A PARAMETER
I
conditions 'p (0; xo. yo) =z0, 9 (0; xo, yo) = y o . Consider the mapping T, defined
b y the equalities
z=a)((t, s), y = Y ( t , s), (15)
where
Let
Q(0, s ) = Q ( T ( s ) , s), Y(0, s ) = Y ( r ( s ) , s). (17) I
t
-$ [ P ; ( Q ( t , r)'f'(!, s))+QL(m(t. *), Y ( f ,*)>I
r ( t , s)=e 0 at. (18)
The function r ( t , s) is defined in region R of the plane ( t , s). In virtue of
relations (15), i t may be considered a s a function of z, y defined in G .
Let the corresponding function be p (z, y).
We thus take
P (z7 Y) = r (1 (5, LA, s (z. 59). (19)
406
S 23. (:LOSED P.4THS OF CONSERI.-\TIVE SYSTEhIS
We w i l l now s h o w t h a t t h i s f u n c t i o n f u l f i l l s t h e p r o p o s i t i o n of t h e t h e o r e m ,
i . e . , s a t i s f i e s i d e n t i t y ( 1 1 ) . By (18) a n d ( I S ) w e h a v e
(20)
w e obtain
i . e . , relation (11).
We w i l l now s h o w t h a t t h e s y s t e m
-dd =
r
t pP=P, g=pQ=Q (A)
i s a H a m i l t o n i a n s y s t e m i n t h e r i n g G. S i n c e p > 0 , t h e p a t h s of ( A ) c o i n c i d e
with t h e p a t h s of ( A ) , i . e . , t h e y a r e c l o s e d p a t h s . F u r t h e r m o r e , i n v i r t u e
of ( X I \ ,
Q(0,P) U(P. V) = 0,
dr OY
I.t?.,
i s a s i n g l e - v a l u e d f u n c t i o n of I , y. T o t h i s e n d , it s u f f i c e s t o e s t a b l i s h
t h a t t h i s i n t e g r a l is i n d e p e n d e n t of t h e i n t e g r a t i o n p a t h y , i . e . , t h e i n t e g r a l
a l o n g a n y c l o s e d c u r v e C o n t a i n e d i n G i s z e r o . If t h e r e g i o n e n c l o s e d b y
t h e c u r v e C i s e n t i r e l y c o n t a i n e d i n G, w e h a v e [ odx- P*dy = 0 b y G r e e n s
():;
6
f o r m u l a a n d r e l a t i o n ( 2 1 ) . L e t now C b e t h e c l o s e d p a t h z = ( t ) , y = ( t ) of 4
s v s t e m ( A ) w h i c h p a s s e s t h r o u g h t h e p o i n t .\Io ( t h i s p a t h e n c l o s e s t h e i n n e r
b o u n r l a r v c u r v e of G , i.-e., i t is not h o m o t o p i c t o z e r o in G ) . L e t T b e t h e
p e r i o d of t h e f m c t i o n s g, and 9. T h e n
Ch.XIII. LIMIT CYCLES OF SYSTEMS DEPENDING ON A PARAMETER
H (x,Y) = S6
CY)
( x , Y) d x - p ( x , Y) d ~ .
ns
x = P ( + , Y ) + P P ( G Y, P), $=Q(x, y l + P q ( x , Y, P), (A,,)
408
5 33. CLOSED PATHS OF CONSER\'r\TI'I'E SYSTEIIS
T h i s s y s t e m c a n b e i n v e s t i g a t e d e i t h e r a s a p a r t i c u l a r case of a s y s t e m
close t o a H a m i l t o n i a n s y s t e m , o r d i r e c t l y b y c h a n g i n g o v e r t o p o l a r
c o o r d i n a t e s . S i n c e t h e d i r e c t a p p r o a c h is v e r y s i m p l e i n t h i s case, a n d
a t t h e s a m e t i m e p r o v i d e s a b e t t e r i n s i g h t i n t o t h e g e n e r a l p r o p e r t i e s of
a s v s t e m close t o a c o n s e r v a t i v e s y s t e m , w e w i l l f i r s t i n v e s t i g a t e ( i n t h e
n e s t s u b s e c t i o n ) a s y s t e m of t h e f o r m (BJ b y c h a n g i n g o v e r t o p o l a r
coordinates.
T h e r e s u l t s of t h e p r e s e n t s e c t i o n m a k e i t p o s s i b l e to e s t a b l i s h i n
c e r t a i n cases t h e p r e s e n c e (or a b s e n c e ) of l i m i t c y c l e s i n n o n l i n e a r
d v n a m i c s y s t e m s . T h i s is a c c o m p l i s h e d b y t h e s o - c a l l e d P o i n c a r e'
m e t h o d or t h e m e t q o d o f a s m a l l p a r a m e t e r . A c c o r d i n g
i o t h i s method, a n o n l i n e a r d y n a m i c s y s t e m i s c o n s i d e r e d as a s y s t e m
close t o a c o n s e r v a t i v e s y s t e m . T h e e x i s t e n c e of l i m i t c y c l e s in t h e
n o n l i n e a r s y s t e m i s e s t a b l i s h e d b v f i n d i n g t h e c l o s e d p a t h s of t h e c o n -
s e r v a t i v e s v s t e m which c r e a t e t h e s e c y c l e s . T h e P o i n c a r g m e t h o d I S
n a t u r a l l v a p p l i c a b l e o n l y i f t h e n o n l i n e a r s y s t e m is i n d e e d close t u a
c o n s e r v a t i v e s y s t e m , 01- i f it c a n b e "fitted" w i t h a c o n s e r v a t i v e s y s t e m
b v some t e c h n i q u e .
W e w i l l c o n s i d e r a s v s t e m of t h e f o r m
a n d t h i s i s e v i d e n t l y a n e q u a t i o n of t h e f o r m (B,,). T h e f u n c t i o n s p ( r , y, P) a n d
q ( r , y , p ) w i l l be a s s u m e d t o v a n i s h for r = y = 0, i . e . ,
P(o,o,Io=Q~o.o,~~=o. (24)
409
Ch.XIII. LIMIT CYCLES OF SYSTEMS DEPENDING Oh A PARAMETER
s=f(I47 v=g(C1)
BY ( 2 4 ) ,
p (0. 0) = q (0, 0) = 0, pz (0, 0, P) = qz (0, 0, P) = 0. (30)
1 + PF (P, 8, P),
where F ( p , 8, p) is an analytical function of i t s arguments (which need not
vanish at p = 0 ) . For s m a l l pr the l a s t expression does not vanish, and
410
933. CLOSED PA Ti;S OF COSSERV.4TIVE SYSTEhIS
'.VP mav t h e r e f o r e c h a n g e o v e r t o a s i n g l e e q u a t i o n
d!)
=P R (p, e. p). (33)
Lvhcre
R (P. e. ,
PI -
c o a 8 p ( p c o . 0 . p q i n 0 , p)-8inOq(pcoiR. ( > s i n @p)
I + P F ;P, e. p)
.
(34)
R ( p , 0, p) i s a n a n a l y t i c 2 1 f u n c t i o n w i t h a p e r i o d of 2 x i n 8 w h i c h v a n i s h e s a t
p :0 . T h e r e f o r e , p - 0 f o r e v e r y p is a s o l u t i o n of e q u a t i o n (33). S i n c e
t h i s s o l u t i o n i s i n d e p e r d e n t of 0 , it is d e f i n e d for all 0. B u t t h e n b y
T h e o r e m 1 of Appendix 1, t h e s o l u t i o n of e q u a t i o n ( 3 3 ) is a p r i o r i d e f i n e d
for all H . c ! , < ~ < ~ x , for all s u f f i c i e n t l v s m a l l p, for ipI<p*, say. L e t t h e
s o l u t i o n c o r r e s p o n d i n g t o t h e i n i t i a l c o n d i t i o n s Bo a n d po b e
P'Y ( 2 % Po, p ) = 0,
i . e . , f o r w h i c h for p f 0
41 1
QI.XII1. L I M I T C Y C L E S OF S Y S T E M S D E P E N D I N G O N A P A R A M E T E R
h a s a unique solution po = po (p) such that I p J (p) - p i \ -== 6 and po (0) = pl. T h i s
evidently implies that for a sufficiently s m a l l p + O , (B,) h a s a single limit
cycle in a s m a l l neighborhood of the c i r c l e 2 +
ya = p:, and t h i s limit cycle
I
c o n t r a c t s to the particular c i r c l e for p - t . 0 . W e can naturally s a y that t h i s I
limit cycle of (B,) is "created" f r o m the path sa y* = p: of the original +
linear system.
xa+
Note that the equation Y (2n; po, 0)= 0, alongside with pi, may have other
solutions satisfying condition (40). If pz is one of these solutions, the path
y2 = p i of the original conservative s y s t e m a l s o c r e a t e s a limit cycle.
Let u s d e r i v e expressions f o r Y(2n; PO, 0) and Jy(2:j!'o) in t e r m s of the
I
functions p ( x , y, p) and ~ ( xy,, p) entering the right-hand s i d e s of ( B & . To
t h i s end, we expand the right-hand side of (33) in powers of p. The equation
thus t a k e s the f o r m
Inserting the l a s t expression in (42) and equating the right- and the left-hand
s i d e s , w e obtain
d'4
-= R~(pot e). (44)
On the other hand, since f (0; 0, po, p) po, w e have Ur(0; po, p) E 0 . In -
particular,
Integrating (44) with the initial condition (46), using (45), and setting 8 = 2x,
we obtain the following expression f o r Y (2n; pa, 0):
Y (2%;po, 0)= s
2Z
n
[cos Op (po cos 0, posin e) +sin 6q (pocos 8, posin e)]d e . (47)
412
5 33. CLOSED PATHS OF COKSERC'.\TIVE SYSTEh!S
d ~ ( 2 PO,
~ ;0)=
JPO 0
@; q;) de +
f [( - p ; sin e e,
p ; cos e) sin
+- (q; s i n 0 - q; cos e) cos el de. (48)
The relations
d p (p,,cos 8, PO sin 0) -
dB
- ( -p ; sin 0 f p ; cos 0) p,,,
dq(p(cos8, posin8)-
d0
- (--;sin 0 &cos e)
po
a r e equivalent t o t h e cocditions
?n
S ~p (p, cos 0 , p, sin e) cos 0 + q (PI cos 0, pI sin e) sin el de =0,
0
2%
S [ p ; (pi cos 0, p, sin e) +
0
q; (PI cos 0, pi sin de + 0.
T h e above r e s u l t s t h u s lead t o t h e following t h e o r e m .
41 3
Ch.XII1. LIMIT CYCLES OF SYbIEMS DEPENDING ON A PARAMETER
is a root of the equation Y (2n;p0,0) = 0 which does not coincide with any of
the r o o t s p i , i = 1, 2, ..
. , s, in contradiction t o the conditions of the theorem.
T h i s contradiction proves
3 . The g e n e r a l case of a s y s t e m c l o s e to a
conservative s y s t e m .. .
Let (Ao) be a conservative s y s t e m in s o m e doubly connected region G .
W e w i l l consider a c l o s e s y s t e m of the f o r m
414
& h e r e p (z,y, p), q (z,y , 11) a r e a n a l y t i c a l f u n c t i o n s i n G .
In 5 13.1, i n o r d e r tc d e f i n e t h e s u c c e s s i o n f u n c t i o n , we i n t r o d u c e d
c u r v i l i n e a r c o o r d i n a t e s i n t h e n e i g h b o r h o o d of t h e c l o s e d p a t h Lo i n which
Lo w a s d e s c r i b e d b y t h e e q u a t i o n n = 0 .
\C'e w i l l now s h o w t h a t if (X,j) i s c o n s e r v a t i v e i n G , a n d Lo i s s o m e
c l o s e d p a t h of ( A * ) , L o c G , we c a n i n t r o d u c e c u r v i l i n e a r c o o r d i n a t e s
s. n i n s o m e n e i g h b o r h o 2 d of t h e p a t h L o s o t h a t t h e p a t h s of (A") w i l l b e
described by the equati3n n = const.
T h i s i s obvious f r o m g e o m e t r i c a l c o n s i d e r a t i o n s . X f o r m a l proof
c a n h e f o r m u l a t e d as f c l l o w s . L e t x = Q, ( t ) , y = $ ( t ) b e t h e e q u a t i o n s of
t h e p a t h L o , and T ? ~ Cpc.riod of t h e f u n c t i o n s g, and q. b r e f i r s t d e f i n e
i n t h e n e i g h b o r h o o d of Lo c u r v i l i n e a r c o o r d i n a t e s s a n d m u s i n g t h e
+-quations
z-=q( s ) + m . $ ( s ) , y=$-(s)-m.q(s) (52)
(see $13.1, ( 6 1 ) . In t h e s e c o o r d i n a t e s , (A,) is d e s c r i b e d b y t h e d i f f e r e n t i a l
equation
dm
-=
ds R'P; m, 1.0. (531
L e t t h e s o l u t i o n of t h i s e q u a t i o n s a t i s f y i n g t h e i n i t i a l c o n d i t i o n m = m o for
s = Ohe
m = f * ( s ; mot PI (5-1)
(see ?+32.1,(RW),(10)).
S i n c e for p = 0 all t h e p a t h s of (A,) i n t h e n e i g h b o r h o o d of Lo a r e c l o s e d ,
f* (s; mo. 0) i s a p e r i o d i c f u n c t i o n of s with a p e r i o d of T f o r all mo, 1 mo I < m*,
w h e r e m* i s a s u f f i c i e n t l y s m a l l p o s i t i v e n u m b e r .
Lye now d e f i n e t h e c o o r d i n a t e s s, n , t a k i n g
s=s, m = f * ( s ; n, 0). (55)
S i n c e Lo i s a c l o s e d p a t h , w e h a v e /*(s; 0, 0) 0. By $ 32,
T h e e q u a t i o n f * ( s , n, O ) = m is t h u s u n i q u e l v s o l v a b l e f o r n i n t h e n e i g h b o r h o o d
of t h e point n 0 w h e n m is s u f f i c i e n t l y small i n a b s o l u t e v a l u e , i . e . ,
e q u a t i o n s ( 5 5 ) c o n s t i t u t e a o n e - t o - o n e t r a n s f o r m a t i o n of c o o r d i n a t e s . T h e
r e l a t i o n s h i p b e t w e e n t h e c u r v i l i n e a r c o o r d i n a t e s s, n and t h e C a r t e s i a n co-
o r d i n a t e s x , y , i n v i r t u e of ( 5 2 ) a n d ( 5 5 ) , i s e x p r e s s e d by t h e e q u a l i t i e s
415
Ch.XLII. LIMIT CYCLES OF SYSTEMS DEPENDING O N A PARAMETER
(57)
A s in $32.1, we write
= f (s; 0, no, p) (59)
for the solution of equation (57) corresponding t o the initial condition n=no
f o r s = 0 . The succession function of (A,,) on the a r c without contact I
described by the equation s = 0 we designate f (no,p). Clearly,
i P),
d ( n o , ~ ) = p * d(no, (63)
where
di (no7 p) = UOI + Ull +nouozP + * (64)
416
5 33. ZLOSED PATHS OF CONSERC';\T'lt'E SYSTELLS
d, ( 0 , 0) = o
d ; ( O , 0 )= V , d j n o ( O , 0)2.0. (66)
Differentiation of (62) w t h r e s p e c t t o no g i v e s
41 7
Ch.XII1. LIMIT CYCLES OF SYSTEMS DEPENDING ON A PARAMETER
4. S y s t e m s c l o s e to a Hamiltonian s y s t e m
The equations of the closed paths of the original s y s t e m (Bo) have the
f o r m H (z, y) = C. (B,) is considered i n a doubly connected region G filled
with the paths H (z, y) = C , where Ci < C <C2. Let Lo be one of t h e s e paths,
z = 'p ( t ) , y = J, ( t ) the motion corresponding t o this path, T the period of the
functions cp and $. In the neighborhood of L o , we introduce curvilinear
coordinates s, n described at the beginning of 933.3 (see (56)), in which
the paths of the dynamic s y s t e m (Bo) a r e described by the equations
n = const. Let the path Lo be described by the equation n = io. The ex-
pansion of d (no,p ) around the point n = Go, p = 0 then h a s the form
+
d (no, P ) =u o i ~ it (no-Lo) p +u O 2 p+ . ..
(see (59)- (62)). In t h i s case, the numbers d; (O,O),d;"@ (0,O) of T h e o r e m 77
evidently should be replaced with d; (no,
0) dLno (no,0).
Since d; (no,0) = u o i , equation
- ( 3 6 ) , 932.1, can be used t o compute d; (no,(I
replacing A (0, 0) with A (0, no). Since f o r a Hamiltonian s y s t e m
(72)
where
(73)
418
33. CLOSED P A T H S OF COhSERL ;ITICE SYSTELIS
sG;
( l P i s ( Z , Y)-!-QiY(2, Y)ldZdY=o. (74)
J (no) = q, d x - p , dy = 0. (75)
(Lo)
-
.
Let u s c o m p u t e 0 To fix i d e a s , w e a s s u m e t h a t a s t i n c r e a s e s , t h e
dG,>
c l o s e d p a t h Lo is t r a c e d i n t h e p o s i t i v e d i r e c t i o n . We h a v e
L e t LOh b e t h e c l o s e d p a t h of (Po) w h i c h c o r r e s p o n d s to t h e v a l u e G o t h of
t h e p a r a m e t e r , Gh t h e r e g i o n b o u n d e d b y t h e p a t h s Lo a n d Lob. T h e s i g n of h
is c h o s e n s o t h a t t h e p a t h LO i s e n c l o s e d i n s i d e L O t , ( F i g u r e 173). T h e n
J ( ~ o f h ) - J ( is ~ ) t h e l i n e i n t e g r a l (73) t a k e n a l o n g t h e b o u n d a r y of Gh, a n d
by Greens formula
C h a n g i n g over to t h e c u r v i l i n e a r c o o r d i n a t e s s, n i n t h e l a s t i n t e g r a l
a c c o r d i n g t o t h e r e l a t i o n s Z = ? ( S , n), y = $ ( s , n), w e o b t a i n
419
Ch.XIII. LIMIT CYCLES 0% SYSTEMS DEPENDING ON A PARAMETER
N + QI
d
Ai0 (4= (cp9 (cp, 9)-xIn (A (S, GO))?
d -
and P ; + Q ; = O . Therefore zln(A(s, no))=O, i . e . , A(s, Lo)f o r e v e r y i o i s
independent of s. and f o r e v e r y n we have
A ( s , n) = A (0, n). (80)
I
T h e r e f o r e , the vector v(cph(s, KO), tpk(s, Go)) points inside the c u r v e Lo
( F i g u r e 1 7 3 ) . On the other hand, the direction of t h i s vector c o r r e s p o n d s
to increasing no on the curve z = G ( s , no), g=q(s, no), where s is constant.
T h e r e f o r e , since Lo is enclosed inside LO*,we have h < 0 . Changing o v e r
f r o m a double integral in ( 7 9 ) t o two successive integrations and seeing
that h < 0 and A ( s , n ) = A ( O , n)> 0, we obtain
x=cP(t), Y=tpU)
the motion corresponding to this path, 'c the peyiod of the functions 'p and 9 ,
Go the region enclosed inside the path Lor and
420
$ ?:3. CLOSED P A l H S OF COSSERC',\TII'E SYSTEhlS
(see ( 7 5 ) ) .
R e m a r k 2. It is readily s e e n that T h e o r e m 7 5 (see S 3 3 . 2 ) , relating t o
ds
s v s t e m s which a r e c l o s e to the linear conservative s y s t e m - dt
= --y, 9at
= t,
-_
dr
dt P + ppt T pap, f . .. , dt = Qf p41 ip'42 4*' (A,)
422
C h a p t e r XI\'
THE APPLICATION O F THE THEORY O F
BIFLJR CA TIOiVS T O T H E I i W E S T I G A TION OF
PAR TICC'LAR DY,VA,IIIC SYSTE.IIS
IN TROUUCTIOX
S34. EXAMPLES
424
4 34. EXlh!PLES
and f o r p = O this s y s t e m r e d u c e s to
dX
-=
dl 6y+&y, $=; -6t-2.2?+2xy+3y2. (4 i
P(L*,0) = 3 ~ i ( 3 + 2 p ) ~ , i ( 4 p - - ) o * + 2 ~ ~ = , 0 . (6)
425
Ch. X?V. APPLICATIONS OF THE THEORY OF BIFURCATIONb I
dx
FIGURE 174
BY (I), f o r x = o ,
4
-
A
1
dt =p(4-2y+3ya))0,
~ = 2 p ( x + 2 ) ( 1 - x ) , and$-=2(x+2) (1-4.
FIGURE 175
dv
i
and -;ii-=4-2y+-3yp>0. For y=O,
T h e r e f o r e the paths of s y s t e m ( 1 )
c r o s s the coordinate a x e s in the d i r e c t i o n s shown in F i g u r e 175.
We have thus established that s y s t e m (1) f o r a s m a l l p > 0 h a s two s t a b l e
foci A (1, 0) and B (- 2, 0) and a n unstable l i m i t cycle in the neighborhood of
the focus A . Using this fact, and taking into account the path configuration
a t infinity and the d i r e c t i o n of motion along the paths a t the points of i n t e r -
section with the coordinate a x e s , we conclude
that in the half -plane x < 0 s y s t e m (1) h a s a l i m i t
cycle C , u n s t a b l e f r o m t h e o u t s i d e to
which the s e p a r a t r i x of the saddle point D g o e s
f o r t -+-co, and in the half-plane x > 0 the
//
s y s t e m h a s a l i m i t cycle Cz s t a b l e f r o m t h e
o u t s i d e to which the s e p a r a t r i x of the saddle
point D' goes for t-++co. Evidently, any closed
path of s y s t e m (1 ) a o t h e r than Cl and C2, is
e n t i r e l y contained e i t h e r in the half -plane x < 0,
and then i t is enclosed inside C1 and e n c l o s e s
the point B , o r in the half -plane x > 0, and then
i t is enclosed inside C z and e n c l o s e s the focus A .
FIGUKE 176 It is r e a d i l y s e e n that s y s t e m (1) may only have
a finite number of closed paths. Indeed,
suppose that this is not so. Then t h e r e e x i s t s
an infinite s e t of closed paths {r}a r r a n g e d concentrically inside a cycle,
C , s a y . We c a n s e l e c t an infinite sequence of paths rl, rZ, r3,... with the
following p r o p e r t y : e v e r y s u c c e s s i v e path e n c l o s e s i t s p r e d e c e s s o r and
e v e r y path of the s e t {J?) is enclosed a t l e a s t inside one of the paths rr( s e e
QT, S l 6 . 9 , L e m m a 1 6 ) . L e t K b e the t o p o l o g i c a l l i m i t of the sequence
rL( s e e QT, Appendix, S l . 1 0 ) . It is r e a d i l y s e e n that e i t h e r K is a closed
path r*, such that closed paths l i e in any sufficiently s m a l l neighborhood
inside r* and no such paths a r e observed outside I'*, or K h a s the s t r u c t u r e
of a 0-limit continuum ( s e e QT, 523.2, Theorem 70), i.e., i t c o n s i s t s of
426
F 34. EXAh!PLES
-
di.
dt
= -u f z - pL'3 - y= - ut, - us, dz
-
dt
= -z- vz - p,* f L.za - usz. (8)
FIGURE 111
3 FIGURE 178
. . . .
in F i g u r e 178. One of the paths i s the loop i originating and terminating
a t the saddle point A , which is described by the equation
All the paths of system (9) enclosed inside the loop Lo a r e closed.
Consider the c o n t a c t c u r v e of s y s t e m s ( 7 ) and ( 9 ) ( s e e QT, 512.5).
I t s equation is
or
u2 ( p i x +l/) = 0. (12)
428
5.34. EX i l P L E S
429
-
"t
330
5 34. EX;\! IPLES
43 I
ch.XIV. APPLICATIONS OF THE THEORY OF BIFURCATIONS
I
path, which is m o r e o v e r s t r u c t u r a l l y s t a b l e . Asafirst
step, let u s consider what happens to a limit cycle of the s y s t e m when the
vector field is r o t a t e d .
R e m a r k r e g a r d i n g t h e v a r i a t i o n of t h e l i m i t c y c l e
f o l l o w i n g r o t a t i o n of t h e v e c t o r f i e l d
Let I
dx dy
~ = P ( XY,? P), x=Q(">
Y, PI (A,)
432
S 34. EX-AhfPLES
( F i g u r e 179), the point; .Ifl and .If, of the s e p a r a t r i c e s L , and L , moving one
toward the other along the I a x i s .
F o r p = p*, the s e p a r a t r i c e s L, and L 3 m e r g e forming a n unstable loop.
Since the equilibrium s t a t e 0 is stable in this case, s y s t e m ( 7 ) may have no
limit c y c l e s under o u r assumptions, and i t s topological s t r u c t u r e is
correspondingly shown in Figure 182.
A s p i n c r e a s e s above p = p*, the s e p a r a t r i x loop c r e a t e s a n unstable
limit cycle. The s y s t e m may not have any o t h e r cycles, and i t s topological
s t r u c t u r e a s s u m e s the form shown in Figure 1 8 3 . A s p increase f r o m y * to
0, this cycle c o n t r a c t s and f o r p = 0 i t "collapses:' into the equilibrium
s t a t e 0 , which changes i t s stability a t this instant. Since f o r p = 3 the
s y s t e m h a s no closed p,&ths, i t may not have any closed paths f o r p -= 0
e i t h e r . Indeed, as I( d e c r e a s e s f r o m 3 to 0, a closed path may be c r e a t e d
only f r o m a condensaticm of paths, but then i t is not s t r u c t u r a l l y s t a b l e .
Thus, the topological s r r u c t u r e of the s y s t e m corresponding to p :;,O is shown
in Figure 181.
A s p d e c r e a s e s f r o m 03, the s y s t e m a t f i r s t h a s no closed paths, and i t
is only when the system crosses the value p = 0 that a n unstable l i m i t cycle
is c r e a t e d f r o m the focus 0, which then expands and f o r p = p* t r a n s f o r m s
into a s e p a r a t r i x loop which d i s a p p e a r s as the s y s t e m p a s s e s through the
value p = p*.
The r e a d e r is advised to w o r k out for himself a s i m i l a r ("tentative")
analysis assuming that p* > 0 or p* = 0 and that the s y s t e m a t any time h a s
the l e a s t possible number of closed paths.
E x a m p 1e 14 (the ci-eation of a l i m i t cycle f r o m the loop of a saddle-
node s e p a r a t r i x , see /34/).
Consider the s y s t e m
433
Ch.XIV. APPLICATIONS OF THE THEORY OF BIFURCATIONS I
(S,) f o r the v a r i o u s values of the p a r a m e t e r p is shown i n F i g u r e 185 (the
a r r o w s in this figure m a r k the direction of motion of the equilibrium s t a t e s
as p i n c r e a s e s ) .
The c h a r a c t e r of the equilibrium s t a t e s is determined by the usual
techniques. F o r p # 0, I p I # 1, the points A , and B , a r e nodes or foci
when p > 0 and saddle points when p<O, w h e r e a s the points B , and C, a r e
nodes o r foci when p < 0 and saddle points when p > 0 ( F i g u r e 185).
The equilibrium state C, of (S,) is multiple f o r p = & I , having A = 0,
+-
u = P; Q; # 0. To fix i d e a s , l e t p = - 1. We w i l l proceed by the method
outlinedinQT, $21.2, using Theorem 65 of this section. System (S,) for
p = - 1 h a s the f o r m
dz
-
dt
= y (z- 1) f2e + ya-I,
*=
dt
-z(z-I).
5438 434
S 34. EXAhlPLES
-
(the two s y s t e n l s (S,) and (S,) can be considered a s p a r t i c u l a r cases of
the s y s t e m
--c
X
a b
435
Ch.XLV. APPLICATIONS OF THE THEORY OF BIFURCATIONS
Suppose that (S,) h a s a closed path L . Since the s u m of the indices of the
equilibriuni s t a t e s of (S,) enclosed inside L i s 1, at least one node of (S,)
lies inside L and a t l e a s t one saddle point l i e s outside L. This mean?,
however, that the path L inevitably c r o s s e s closed paths of s y s t e m (S,) and
consequently h a s a ( t r u e ) contact ( s e e previous e x a m p l e ) with one of these
closed paths, Since the ( t r u e ) contact m a y only l i e on the c i r c l e W , which
is a path of (S,) for e v e r y p +
0, the closed path L of (S,) should be tangent
to the c i r c l e W . This is feasible only if L coincides with W(since W is a
path of (S,) or c o n s i s t s of paths of this s y s t e m ) .
We have thus established that (S,) h a s no closed paths for 1 p 1 4 1 and h a s
p r e c i s e l y one closed path - the c i r c l e W - for 1 p > 1. For p = - 1, (S,)
h a s a saddle-node C-, whose w-separatrix L+ f o r m s a loop which, together
-
with the point C+ constitute the c i r c l e W . For t + 00, the s e p a r a t r i x L+
goes to the saddle-node C-,> being one of the i n t e r i o r paths of the node
s e c t o r . At the point C-, (1, 0),
I
P ; ( x , Y, -I)+Q1(z, Y, -1)=2>0. (16)
o<p<;, .O<e<oo.
436
5 34. EXAMPLES
and
The f i r s t is the equation $of a hyperbola and the second that of a parabola..
I'hese equations partition the half-plane 1 +&z>O into r e g i o n s where x and
r e t a i n a constant sign. Let t h e s e r e g i o n s be designated I, 11,111, I\'
( F i g u r e 188). The s i g n s of 3 and y, r e s p e c t i v e l y , a r e indicated in
p a r e n t h e s e s in the figure.
FIGURE 188.
43 I
I
a.XIV. APPLICATIONS OF THE THEORY OF BIFURCATIONS
Since e > 0, 1 + pxz > 0, yz > 0, and 0 < p <f , the two r o o t s of (21) a r e
negative. Hence i t follows that the s e g m e n t s of the s e p a r a t r i c e s located
n e a r the point O2 lie in r e g i o n s I1 and IV ( F i g u r e 188).
Seeing that two s e p a r a t r i c e s go to the saddle point f o r t + 00 and +
the other two for t + - 00, and examining the variatior. of x and y in I
regions I1 and IV, we readily find that the configuration of the s e p a r a t r i c e s
n e a r the saddle point O2 can be r e p r e s e n t e d a s in F i g u r e 188.
Consider the point of the s z p a r a t r i x L, lying n e a r O2. Let this point
c o r r e s p o n d to the time to. Since this point l i e s in region IV, i t w i l l move
to the left and up as t i n c r e a s e s ( x d e c r e a s e s , I/ i n c r e a s e s ) . But then the
s e p a r a t r i x L, w i l l not c r o s s the parabola (20), which is an isocline of the
horizontal inclinations, and i t should evidently c r o s s the s t r a i g h t line
1 $. f3s = 0. We s i m i l a r l y conclude that the s e p a r a t r i x L, goes to infinity as
t increases.
The behavior of the s e p a r a t r i c e s Lz and Ls cannot be determined u n -
ambiguously, and a detailed a n a l y s i s is r e q u i r e d . To this end, consider
an auxiliary system
dt =-e ( x + y e ) .
dx
-=
dt y, 3 (E)
g
-= -2 e e Z C " (5 + y*) (1 - B). (23)
438
5 34. EX .Ah!PLES
FIGL'RE 189
439
ch.XIV. APPLICATIONS OF THE THEORY OF BIFURCATIONS
of the parabola - 1
+ s + g* = 0, the path of s y s t e m (B) p a s s i n g through
this point is a closed path ( F i g u r e 1 9 0 ) . We designate this closed path z,.
zo,
At the point Oz, the s e p a r a t r i x Lz e n t e r s into s i n c e a t this point the
inclination of La is negative and the inclination of gois horizontal
( F i g u r e 190; Oz l i e s on the isocline of horizontal inclinations of s y s t e m (E)).
While in region where x + yp > 0, the s e p a r a t r i x L2 cannot c r o s s the c u r v e
Lo going f r o m inside to outside, since in this region i t s behavior is such
that i t c r o s s e s all the closed paths of (B) f r o m outside to inside. Moreover,
a s t i n c r e a s e s , the s e p a r a t r i x Lz cannot move f r o m region I1 into region I
c r o s s i n g the a r c OiOz of the parabola y f xp = 0, since in all the i n t e r i o r
points of this a r c the paths of s y s t e m (A) a r e d i r e c t e d f r o m left to right.
W e should t h e r e f o r e consider the following a l t e r n a t i v e s for the
s e p a r a t r ix Lz:
1) without leaving region 11, LZ goes to the equilibrium state 0,f o r
t-c + W;
440
5 34. EXAhlPLES
x=- p-2e
2Ep *
By Dulac's c r i t e r i o n , (A) may not have closed paths in the region where
d d
z ( Q p ) - k > (OQ)
~ 1 0 . Therefore, i f the above s t r a i g h t line d o e s not lie
between the v e r t i c a l s r=q and x = x * , i.e., if e i t h e r
or
s y s t e m ( A ) h a s no closssd paths.
The f i r s t of the two conditions in (24) c a n be written i u the f o r m
$ex x - ~ Z - - 1 ) =e?exz(x2+yi-x). 1
( 4
or after e l e m e n t a r y manipulations,
i - 2=* ~ p2e(c?--x*)
I1 - 2e (x2 f yi)]. (25)
441
Ch. XIV. APPLICATIONS OF T H E THEORY OF BIFURCA'I'LONS
s Q X
442
S 34. EXhllPLES
443
Ch.XIV. APPLICATIONS OF THE THEORY OF BIFURCATIONS
But
Let
eo G - b
(1-b)- -e (30)
444
9 34. EXAhlPLES
e
v a l u e . The bifurcation values of the p a r a m e t e r in o u r c a s e a r e and 0 . 5 5 ' ~
will show that E ( e o . Indeed, i f ;> e , , Oii s an unstable node or focus f o r
E = E and the s y s t e m h a s a s e p a r a t r i x forming a loop, which loop, a s w e
have s e e n before, i s d s o unstable. By condition (a), no closed paths may
develop in the s y s t e m . T h e r e f o r e , the paths enclosed inside the loop should
go e i t h e r to the loop or to the point O1 f o r f --t t o o , which is impossible s i n c e
both the loop and the point O l a r e unstable.
U'e have thus established that e< e o . For E = the point O1 is a multiple
unstable focus, and for all e between e l and E the s y s t e m h a s a constant
topological s t r u c t u r e (that shown on F i g u r e 191).
As E is f u r t h e r i n c r e a s e d , O1 is t r a n s f o r m e d into a s t a b l e focus, and a
s i m p l e unstable l i m i t cycle L o is c r e a t e d in its neighborhood (S25.3). The
s y s t e m a c q u i r e s the topological s t r u c t u r e schematically shown in F i g u r e 193.
?Is E v a r i e s between the l i m i t s < E < E ~ , this topological s t r u c t u r e is
retained.
-
FIGYRE 193. E -=z e <eo. FIGL'RE 1"4. e eo.
445
Ch.XIV. APPLICATIONS OF THE THEORY OF BIFURCATIONS
==- [ i + ( x + y ) y + 6 ] = P ( x .
dz
y), $-= -y+(s+y)s=Q(x, y) (31)
f o r positive values of the p a r a m e t e r s y and 6.
The coordinates of the equilibrium s t a t e s satisfy the equations
x t ( x t Y) +6 = 0, Y- b+r)t= 0. (32)
F ( x , y, 6) = i + 2 y Z + + ( y ~ + 1 ) x + 6 = 0 . (33)
446
5 34. EXAhlPLES
* Our prooi is confined to the neighborhood of a triple equilibrium state. In this case, the sought results also
can be obtained from d direct .rLalysis of the cubic equation F (z,y. 6 ) = 0.
Ch.xIV. APPLICATIONS OF T H E THEORY OF BIFURCATIONS
6 ~ --vya-a-.h (7)
2v (vZ+ 9)i - 2 w - 3 ) (36)
27
and
6=2~(~~+%-2(P-3) 7/y'--3
27 =f(7). (37)
FIGURE 195
448
4 34. EXAh!PLES
u z - (2% f Y X f 2 ) . (39)
449
Ch.XIV. APPLICATIONS OF THE THEORY OF SIFURCATIONS
dt -x+
25 ( y -6 ) Y - X Y , $= (26-3y) x- Y +X'. (42)
I
Q ( y , 6 ) = 2ya-3y6+ 6*+2 = O
and
(y -6 ) (26- 3y) + i =0
have a single common point in the f i r s t quadrant, namely the point
A ( 55 p),
.8 and that this is t h e i r point of i n t e r s e c t i o n (and not a t r u e point
of contact). The e x p r e s s i o n (y - 6) (26 -- 3y) -I- 1 t h e r e f o r e r e t a i n s the s a m e
sign e v e r y w h e r e along the branch A B of the c u r v e (41)(except the point A )
and a n opposite s i g n everywhere along the branch AC of this c u r v e .
Consider the points (3, 5) and (9/2, 5) of c u r v e ( 4 1 ) ; we r e a d i l y f i n d t h a t t h e
e x p r e s s i o n ( y - 6 ) ( 2 6 - 3 y ) f 1 is negative on the branch A B and positive on
the branch A C . T h e r e f o r e , by (43), i f the dynamic s y s t e m ( 3 1 ) c o r r e s p o n d s
to a point on the branch A B , i t s equilibrium s t a t e with u = 0 is a multiple
focus o r c e n t e r (we shall see l a t e r on that this is a multiple focus of
multiplicity 1). If the s y s t e m c o r r e s p o n d s to a point on the branch A C , i t s
equilibrium s t a t e with u = 0 is a saddle point.
5438 450
9 ?4. EX.-\\IPLES
4
X=-%
+ I-
b
* If y < 3, cp ( y , d) > 0 (see (35)) and system (35)has one equilibrium state for a l l 6.
452
5 34. EX.1hlPLES
56-8y = 0, (48)
which joins the o r i g i n with the point -4( 5 4 0 . 8 v5). It is readily s e e n that
the branch d B of c u r v e (41) and the h a l f - l i n e s 36 - 47 = 0 and 26 - 3 y = 0
located in the first quadrant l i e on the two s i d e s of the line (48).
E x p r e s s i o n (47) thus h a s the s a m e s i g n on the branch A B and on the s t r a i g h t
line (48). On the line (48) this e x p r e s s i o n is positive. Hence, as> 0 .
Then, a c c o r d i n g to the table at the end of 25.3, the multiple focus is
unstable and its multiplicity is 1; on c r o s s i n g o v e r into region IIb, it b e -
c o m e s s t a b l e and c r e a t e s a single unstable l i m i t cycle.
Let u s now i s o l a t e c e r t a i n r e g i o n s in the p a r a m e t e r plane which c o r r e -
spond to s y s t e m s without closed paths (in p a r t i c u l a r , without limit c y c l e s ) .
Consider the s t r a i g h t line x + y = O . W e s e e f r o m the f i r s t equation in ( 3 1 )
that f o r 6 = y this line is an i n t e g r a l c u r v e . If 6 # y a i t is a line without
contact. Indeed, for x = - y a n d d # y , ddt+ --
d-y#O, i.e., the paths do not
touch this line.
Take Dulac's function i n the f o r m
This gives
z=6--2y. (51)
453
Ch.XIV. APPLICATIONS OF THE THEORY OF BIFURCATIONS
454
5 34. EX.4hlPLES
455
Ch.XIV, APPLICATIONS OF THE THEORY OF BIFURCATIONS
456
8
D
I p
r/,
E
branch A D of the c u r v e q = 0 (other than the
point A ) have a stable node or focus and a
saddle-node with a n unstable node region.
Their topological s t r u c t u r e is shown in
F i g u r e 202.
On passing f r o m branch A D to region 11,
w e obtain s y s t e m s with one s t a b l e and one
unstable node o r focus, whose topological
s t r u c t u r e is shown in F i g u r e 197.
The topological s t r u c t u r e of the s y s t e m s
on the line A D is analogous to the s t r u c t u r e
@
In region 3 3 ( F i g u r e 2 0 0 ) , the s e p a r a t r i x loop
b r e a k s up and the s y s t e m a c q u i r e s the topological
s t r u c t u r e shown i n F i g u r e 198. The point M,,corre-
sponds to a dynamic s y s t e m with a triple equilibrium
state. It is a s t a b l e node, and the topological s t r u c -
t u r e of t h e s y s t e m is the s a m e as in F i g u r e 201.
Finally, the dynamic s y s t e m corresponding to the
point A h a s a s t a b l e focus and a d e g e n e r a t e
eq.iilibrium s t a t e . Its topological s t r u c t u r e is
FIGURE 203. s h o w n in F i g u r e 205.
457
Ch.XIV. APPLICATIONS OF THE THEORY OF BIFURCATIONS
where H (5,
1
y) = T (x' + ye). The paths of s y s t e m (53) a r e c i r c l e s centered I
a t the origin.
Since (53) is a l i n e a r conservative s y s t e m , we may investigate system
( 5 2 ) using Theorem 75 ( 3 3 . 2 ) , o r the m o r e g e n e r a l Theorem 78. We w i l l
u s e Theorem 78 h e r e , a s it a l s o provides a n indication of the stability of
the c r e a t e d l i m i t cycle.
Let
458
5 34. EXAhlPLES
R e r e f o r e , by (47), 33.2,
2s
po, 0 ) =
$ (21; (ape sin e +- BpZ sin2e yp3 sins 6 .+
0
taking y > 0, e > 0, and assuming that a may take on both positive and
negative values (this c o r r e s p o n d s to the physical conditions of the actual
problem associated with this system; s e e f 6 f a Chapter IX, lo).
W e should consider only the positive r o o t s of (58). A s w e have s e e n
above, f o r a # 0, the equilibrium s t a t e 0 (0, 0) of the original s y s t e m may
not c r e a t e a limit cycle.
Setting in (58)
pa=r, a3 y = a , T5 e = b
I
C d
FIGURE 206
460
S 34. EXAhfPLES
Between the (negative) a f o r a* $- 4ba <0 and those f o r which a* + 4ba > 0,
w e have one value a = a* = - $.c 0 f o r which a= +- 4ba = 0 . This value
c o r r e s p o n d s to a single positive root p: of equation ( 3 7 ) . Calculations show
that $A (2%; p:,O)= 0; therefore the theory of 5 3 3 . 2 is inapplicable to t h i s c a s e
( s e e r e m a r k to Theorem 75, 5 3 3 . 2 ) . It is r e a d i l y seen, however, that the
closed path of s y s t e m (56) corresponding to t h i s p i is a double l i m i t cycle
which s e p a r a t e s into t w o l i m i t c y c l e s - a stable and a n unstable one - a s a
increases.
A s a is f u r t h e r i n c r e a s e d and p a s s e s through z e r o , the unstable limit
cycle c o n t r a c t s to the equilibrium s t a t e , which becomes stable for a > O .
F i g u r e 2 0 6 , a - d, shows the path configurations of s y s t e m ( 5 6 ) c o r r e -
sponding to the c a s e s a < a * , a = a*,a* < a < 0, a > O . It is a s s u m e d that
p > 0 is sufficiently s m z l l .
Remark . It is readily s e e n that the problem of the c r e a t i o n of a l i m i t
cycle f r o m a n equilibricm s t a t e of the type of a c e n t e r cannot be solved
with the aid of the sufficient conditions of 5 3 3 . 2 . Indeed, these conditions
only prove the existence of a n equilibrium s t a t e p = 0 f o r s y s t e m (B&).
Investigation of the nonzero r o o t s of the equation 9 ( 2 ~ p, ; p) = 0, which
go to z e r o f o r p -+ 0, may naturally shed s o m e light on the problem of
c r e a t i o n of a l i m i t cycle f r o m a c e n t e r - t y p e equilibrium s t a t e of s y s t e m
(Bo). Note that the solution of the equation 9 (2n; p, p) = 0 corresponding
to this limit cycle should be sought a s a n expansion in fractional, and not
integral, powers of p, and, in the s i m p l e s t c a s e , a s a n expansion in powers of
6.
461
APPENDIX
Let
Pk %%Oi
l, ... I G O ) =ckg (21
which i s defined f m all t from the interval (7, T ) , where r c t o < ~ . Let,
462
further
-
:rA = 'PA ( t ; t o ? TlOt XZO, .. t %;to) = (PA ( t ) ( 3I
be the solution of syste?m (A) satisfying the same initial conditions. Then,
f o r any+ I and ~ 2 T
. < T ~ < ~ , < T ~ < T , and any e > O , there exists a>Osatis-fying
the follozoing condition: if I PA ( t ;t l ,x 2 , . .., I,,) I < 6, k = 1, 2, . .., n , solution ( 3 )
i s defined for all 1 , T, G:t 4T ~ ,and f o r ecery t from this interval we have
Ek
-
= '?k ( t ; to* IO, x?oo, . . . * XnO) (ti to, I?o, . . . ,X n o ) . (6)
The functions E k are defined f o r all t f o r which the functions <k and (Fk are
a p r i o r i defined. They are therefore a p r i o r i defined for all t sufficiently
c l o s e to to. For t = t o , Ek = 0. Clearly,
where the point ( t : &, GI:, . . . , &,) lies on the segment joining the points
. c -
.
( t ;91, $ 2 , . . . Tn) and ( t l ; q l , Q. . . . (Fn).
Consider a n auxiliary differential equation
-
6 [ e n B ( f - - t o ) - 11. (9i
B
363
APPENDIX
6 [enB(r*-to) - 11
0 <v ( t )< (10)
and v' ( t )> 0.
Let e * = min {e, $}. For b>O we choose any number satisfying the relation
6 [enB(ra--lo)-ll ce*.
(11)
1% I<na.
On the other hand, f o r a l l tEIto. TZJ,
464
APPEXDIX
465
APPENDIX
the solution of system (A)corresponding to the initial values To. Zlo, &,. . . ., x,,~.
-
Then, f o r any T~ and z2, r0 < q < t <72<T , and any E > 0, there exist 6 >0 and
q > 0 which satisfy the following conditions: if
(Pk(t.xl,XZ,...,xn)l<6, k=i, 2, . . , n ,
and
lG-tol<q u I.z*o-xItoI<?l, i = 1 , 2, . . ., n,
the solution (G) is defined f o r t , T , < ~ = S T ~ , and for every t f r o m this interval
I$k(t)-(Pk(t)I<E ( k = i , 2, . . ,n).
-
~ x k o - x h o ~ < qa_nd_the point ( t ' , to; xi,. . ., &)Ea, the functions (P,+ a r e defined a t
the point (t", to; %IO, . . . , Xno) and
c c
I (Pk (t", t o ;
-
110, ... 7
-
28~0) -(PA (t'. to; . . ., Xno) I <E
@ = = I , 2, ..., n).
Corollary 1 follows f r o m the previous theorem. It is proved again by
reductio ad absurdum, and the compactness of Q is used.
C o r o l l a r y 2 . For a s y s t e m
466
.APPENDIX
puow let the functions Pk and entering the right-hand s i d e s of (A) and
(A) be functions of c l a s s r > 1. In this case, the solutions ( F k ( t , to;rlo,q 0 .. . ..
. . . . % o ) , f o r all the values of the v a r i a b l e s f o r which they are defined, have
continuous (in all the v z r i a b l e s ) derivatives: ( a ) to o r d e r r -+ 1 with r e s p e c t
to t ; (b) to o r d e r r with r e s p e c t to all the v a r i a b l e s r i o ; ( c ) to o r d e r r Z +
with r e s p e c t to all the v a r i a b l e s , provided i t contains a t l e a s t one differentia-
tion with r e s p e c t to t ( s e e QT, Appendix, 8.3, Theorem B). An analogous
proposition applies to Cp,%.
T h e o r e m 3. Let &hesolution ( q )of system {A) be defined for all
t c ( T ~ ,T ) , and let ro < T ] < f < T~ e T . Then, for ecery e > 0 , there exist
6 > o and r) > o satisfyingthefollowingconditions: if (A) is 6-close to rank r
to \A) and if I io- to I < 1, I i i 0- x i 0 I < q (i = i , 2, . . ., n) the solution (Cp) i s
defined for all t , rl.<t<rt., and for these values of the variables
- ,).- _ . . ., -
i
dgr(t.
ot
r10, 1~0)-
Jft
-- - P k ( t , 21, Z:, . . ., Znr p) ( k = 1, 2, . . ., n). (A,)
167
APPENDIX
and
P: (0,0)= 0.
Po (I,Y) = f (0,01,
k
pk (I,y) 2 &?a (0,0)
*=O
and
k
p* (I,.I) = y
*=O
lg, (I,Y) -gu ( 0 , 0)l i - a y o .
169
APPENDIX
Through each point M (9 (s), 9 (s)) of the path Lo we draw a normal to the
path a t that point and l a y off s e g m e n t s of the length 6j/rp (s)l + *
(s) on e i t h e r
side of the point M .
L e m m a 1 . If 6 > 0 is sufficiently small, no two segments of navmals
drawn through dgferent points of the curve Lo intersect.
P r o o f . Since Vrp (s)l + q (s)l is bounded f r o m above, i t
the l e m m a under the assumption that s e g m e n t s of length 6 a r e laid
off all the n o r m a l s . Moreover, i t suffices to c o n s i d e r the c a s e
when these s e g m e n t s a r e laid off on one side of the c u r v e Lo(either
all inside the c u r v e or all outside the c u r v e ) . We a s s u m e that both
t h e s e conditions a r e satisfied. Let the proposition of the l e m m a be false.
Then t h e r e e x i s t s a sequence of n u m b e r s 6, -+ 0 (6, > 0) and a sequence of
p a i r s of points P n , Qnof the c u r v e Lo such that the s e g m e n t s of n o r m a l s of
length 6, drawn through the points P, and Qn i n t e r s e c t . Since the c u r v e L, is
compact, we may take P, -+ P and Q, -+ Q. where P and Q a r e points of Lo.
Let u s f i r s t consider the c a s e when P and Q a r e two different points.
Let M , be the i n t e r s e c t i o n point of the n o r m a l s e g m e n t s through the points
P, and Q,. Then p ( P , , M,),<6,, p(Qn, M,),<6,, and by the triangle inequality
P (PT Q) <P ( P , Pn) + P (Pn,Mn)+P ( M n , Qn) -I-P (Qnt Q )Q I
4P (P,Pn) +26, fP (Qn, Q)
( F i g u r e 207). Since for a sufficiently l a r g e n, the right-hand s i d e of the
inequality is as s m a l l as d e s i r e d , w h e r e a s the left-hand side is constant,
this inequality cannot be satisfied. P and Q thus may not be two different
points, and we have to consider only the c a s e when they coincide.
+
*
p a r a m e t r i c equations of the c u r v e Lo are s t i l l x = rp (s), y = (s). Clearly,
rp and 1p a r e functions of the second c l a s s and rp ( s ) ~ rp (s)* f 0 f o r any s.
L e t the point 0 of c u r v e Lo c o r r e s p o n d to the value so of the p a r a m e t e r s.
Near the point 0, the equation of the c u r v e Lo is y = f (2). Then
=a,
f (2)
v f (0) =o,
(8)
* (so) =o, rp (so) p 0.
470
Therefore, n e a r the point x = 0, the function f (I)h a s a continuous second
derivative f (I).
By assumption, the :lorma1 s e g m e n t s of length S, > 0 drawn through the
points P,,and 0,i n t e r s e c t f o r e v e r y n ( h e r e 6, -c 0, P, 0 , f& 0). Let
-f
On the o t h e r hand,
lim IF,/(E,,) = 0,
n-0
f 8 ( p , O ) = p fi (pcos8, p s i n 0 ) f o r p#O.
(1)
f* (0, 8) = f ; (0, 0 ) COS 0 +- 1; (0,0)sin 0.
47 I
APPENDIX ~
. .
k=i q=O
p=o
== ~ g f $ - ~ , ~
N
1
F ( E , q) ( E , q) COSN-P e sinp 8. (3)
p=o
Similarly, using the Taylor s e r i e s of the functionf$)-rv-r,r,I < g < N-i, O,(r,<q,
under the s a m e assumption and r e m e m b e r i n g that the p a r t i a l d e r i v a t i v e s
of the function f ( x , y) to o r d e r N inclusive vanish a t (0, O), w e obtain
p=o
or
where
472
Differentiating the function
f (I,y) f (p C O S 0, p sin 0)
q t i m e s with r e s p e c t tc, p (i<qP--<S-l), we obtain
au
dp4 f ( x , y) = 2 C{f($rur ( r , y) cos+' 0 sinre. (6)
r=O
r=o
- -
If p 40, w e have x -+ 0. y + 0, .,I. 3 0, Fqr -+ 0, and t h e r e f o r e F,, (I~,,
yur)-+ 0.
The e x p r e s s i o n
1 IjQf (G Y) -pq-N W!+, Y)
7 op'l OP', (7)
a l s o goes to z e r o for p -4
0, uniformly i n 8.
Let u s now prove proposition ( a ) of the l e m m a . \Ve f i r s t take p + O and
apply the Leibnitz r u l e to obtain e x p r e s s i o n s for d e r i v a t i v e s of o r d e r k of
the function
1
f*(p, e ) = p f ( p c o s O , p s i n 8 ) ( s e e (I)),
where l , < k , < N - l .
k
- ( 2 C ~ ( - ~ ) k - q ( k - ~ ) ! p apq
q - . ~ ~ ) p ~ - k - i(9)
.
q=o
uniformly i n 0.
f ' be) - 0 (11)
473
APPENDIX
414
where $ # O . and the functions rp and 9 together with their f i r s t derivatives
vanish a t the point (0,C). Let
f o r p + O and
(I,(P, e) = 9 (p cos 8, p sin 6) cos e - P (0 cos 6, P sin f4 sin e
P
e) = 0,
(I,(0,
P
} (17)
F ( P - 6)
R(pv e) = p+(0(p, e) (18)
-
CF ((I cos 6. p sin 6)
and
P
and, using equations (15)- (18) and the inequality $ +- (I, (p, e) # 0 (which is
satisfied f o r e v e r y point (p, e) of the relevant region f o r a sufficiently s m a l l
p*), w e conclude that the function R (p, e) a l s o h a s continuous p a r t i a l
d e r i v a t i v e s with r e s p e c t to p to o r d e r .V - 1 inclusive a t e v e r y point
(p, 0) ( 0 4 I p I < p* for any 0 ) and to o r d e r X inclusive a t e v e r y point where p # V.
Lye thus only have to establish the existence of a continuous .V-th derivative with
r e s p e c t to p a t points where p = 0. We r e p r e s e n t R (p. e ) a s a product of two
functions
av- 1
and find -
aph-f using the Leibnitz r u l e (this is p e r m i s s i b l e , since each of the
f a c t o r s h a s p a r t i a l deri-gatives with r e s p e c t to p to o r d e r K- I inclusive at
e v e r y point (p, e)). Simple manipulations show that
R
&&--i ~ ( p e)
, ~ ( p e). aV-la
- ~ - - _ _ .
a t the point (0, 0). We will f i r s t prove the existence of this derivative for
p=O. For p=O, F ( p , e)-O, and expression ( 2 0 ) thus vanishes. Therefore,
i.e.,
476
APPEXDIX
1
F o r p + O , w e have = -P+ a a , -+L
@Ab,)* pa '
and the e x p r e s s i o n in
b r a c k e t s goes to z e r o by proposition ( b ) of L e m m a 2 . M o r e o v e r ,
lim F ( p , e) = 0, and
p-.')
By ( 2 4 ) w e then have
477
BIBLIOGRAPHY
1. A n d r o n o v , A.A., E . A . L e o n t o v i c h , I . I . G o r d o n , and
A. G . M a i e r . Kachestvennaya teoriya dinamicheskikh s i s t e m
vtorogo poryadka (Qualitative Theory of Dynamic S y s t e m s of
Second O r d e r ) . - Moskva, Nauka. 1966.
2 . B a u t i n , N . N. 0 prodol'nykh dvizheniyakh samoleta, blizkikh k
fugoidnym dvizheniyam (Longitudinal A i r c r a f t Motions Close to
Fugoid Motions). - Uchenye Zapiski Gor'kovskogo Universiteta,
13. 1947.
3 . B e l l y u s t i n a , L . N . K dinamike simmetrichnogo poleta s a m o l e t a
(The Dynamics of Symmetric A i r c r a f t Motion). - Izvestiya
AN SSSR, tech. sci., No. 11. 1956.
4. A n d r o n o v , A . A . and L . S . P o n t r y a g i n . Grubye s i s t e m y
(Structurally Stable Systems). - Doklady AN SSSR, 14, T
5. B a g g i s , G. F. Dynamical S y s t e m s with Stable S t r u c t u r e s . - In:
Contributions t o t h e T h e o r y of Nonlinear Oscillations, Vol. II,
pp. 3 7 -59. P r i n c e t o n Univ. Press. 1952.
6. A n d r o n o v , A.A., A.A. V i t t , and S . E . K h a i k i n . Teoriya kolebanii
(The Theory of Oscillations). - Fizmatgiz. 19 59.
7 . P e i x o t o , M . M. S t r u c t u r a l Stability on 2 -Dimensional Manifolds. -
478
14. P e i x o t o , M . hI. On Structural Stability.- -4nn. of Math., 69:155-
222. 1959.
15. P o i n c a r e , H . Thbses prdsente'es a la Facult6 d e s s c i e n c e s d e
Paris: Sur les propriCt6.s d e s fonctions definies p a r les
Cquations aux differences p a r t i e l l e s . P a r i s , Gauthier - V i l l a r s .
1875.
16. G u b a r I, N . A. Kharakteristika slozhnykh osobykh tochek s i s t e m y
dvukh differentsial'nykh uravnenii p r i pomoshchi grubykh osobykh
tochek blizkikh s i s t e m (Classification of the hiultiple Singular
Points of a SysLem of Two Differential Equations Using Structurally
Stable Singular Points of Close Systems). - Matematicheskii
Sbornik, 40\82), 1. 1556.
17. S t e p a n o Y , V . V . K u r s differentsial'nykh uravnenii (A Course in
Differential Equations). - hioskva, Fizmatgiz. 1955.
18. B a u t i n , N . N . Povedenie dinamicheskikh s i s t e m vblizi g r a n i t s
oblasti ustoichivosti (The Behavior of Dyanmic Systems N e a r the
Boundaries of the Stability Region). - hIoskva, Gostekhizdat.
1545.
19. K r a s n o s e l ' s k i i , 5 I . A . e t a l . Vekfornye polya na ploskosti
(Vector F i e l d s on a Plane).- Moskva, Fizmatgiz. 1963.
2 0 . B a u t i n , K .N . G t odnom differentsial'noni uravnenii, imeyushchem
oredel'nyi t s i k l (Concerning a Differential Equation with a Limit
Cycle). - Zhurrial rekhnicheskoi Fiziki, IX, N o . 7:601- 611. 1535.
2 1 . L e o n t o v i c h , E. A. C rozhdenii predel'nykh tsiklov ot s e p a r a t r i s y
( f i e Creation cf Limit Cycles f r o m a Separatrix). - Doklady
A h SSSR, X S V I I I , No.4. 1551.
2 2 . 31 a r k u s h e v i c h , A. I. Teoriya analiticheskikh funktsii (Theory of
Analytical Functions ). - bIoskva-Leningrad, Gostekhizdat. 1950.
23. L a V a l l d e P o u s s i n , C h a r l e s J., de. Cours d'analyse
infinitksimale. 8th edition revised and enlarged with the collaDora -
tion of F. Simonart. Louvain, L i b r a i r i e Universitaire, Paris,
Gau thier -Villars. 1938.
2 4 . P o i n c a r k , H . L c s mCthodes nouvelles d e la mdcanique cCleste,
t. 111. - P a r i s . 1899.
25, A n d r o n o v , A . A . and A.G. L y u b i n . Primenenie teorii Puankare o
"tochkakh bifurkatsii" i "smene ustoichivosti" k p r o s t e i s h i m
avtokolebatel'nym s i s t e m a m (Application of the PoincarC Theory
of "Bifurcation Points" and "Stability Changes" to the Simplest
Xutooscillatory Systems). - Zhurnal Eksperimental'noi i
I'eoreticheskoi Fiziki, 5, N o s . 3-4. 1935.
2 6 . A r o n o v i c h , G.V. and L . X . B e l l y u s t i n a . Ob ustoichivosti
kolebami gorizcnta v uravnitel'noi bashne (Concerning the Stability
of Horizon Oscillations in a Leveling T u r r e t ) . - Inzhenernyi
Sbornik AN SSSR, XIIT. 1552.
27. B a u t i n , N . E. K t e o r i i sinkhronizatsii (Synchronization Theory). -
Zhurnal Tekhnicheskoi Fiziki, 9 . 1939.
28. B e 1 l y u s t i n a , L . .?I. Ob odnom uravnenii iz t e o r i i elektricheskikh
mashin (Concerning a C e r t a i n Equation f r o m the Theory of
E l e c t r i c hIotors). - A. A. Andrcnov hIemoria1 Collection, AN SSSR,
pp. 173- 186. 1955.
379
BIBLIOGRAPHY
480
t
SUBJECT INDEX
Attraction e l e m e n t s ( s i r k s ) 1 4 1 Conservative dynamic s y s t e m 401,
408
Bifurcation point 205 Continuation of boundary a r c 140
value of the p a r a m e t e r 208 of c o r n e r a r c 1 4 0
Bifurcations of a dynamic s y s t e m Covering of a s p h e r e
202,205 closed 52-54
in the neighbor.iood of a open 52
multiple limit cycle 282 Creation of a closed path f r o m a
in t h e neighborhood of a multiple limit cycle 127
multiple focus 259 of a l i m i t cycle f r o m condensation
in t h e neighborhood of a of paths 217
multiple focus of f r o m infinity 217
multiplicity 1 261 f r o m a loop of a saddle-node
of s y s t e m s of f i r s t d e g r e e of s e p a r a t r i x 332, 324, 326
s t r u c t u r a l instability 375 f r o m a loop of a saddle-point
Branching point of an analytical s e p a r a t r i x 309, 311, 319
function 389 f r o m a multiple focus 254
limit cycle 277
Canonical f o r m of dynamic s y s t e m Curvilinear coordinates in the
( n e a r an equilibrium s t a t e ) 68- 70 neighborhood of a closed path 110
Canonical neighborhood Cycle without contact 145
limit cycle 1 4 2 Cyclic s y s t e m s of solutions 389
node o r focus 1 4 2
saddle point 143 Decomposition of a multiple equili-
Canonical neighborhoods, r e g u l a r brium s t a t e into s t r u c t u r a l l y s t a b l e
s y s t e m 144 equilibrium s t a t e s 218
C e l l s of dynamic s y s t e m s 141,175 Degree of s t r u c t u r a l instability of
of one type 177 dynamic s y s t e m s 206,207
of s t r u c t u r a l l y s t a b l e s y s t e m s Density of integral invariant 402
doubly connected 1 7 7
simply connected 177,179 Elementary a - and a - a r c s 145
C h a r a c t e r i s t i c index of a closed Equilibrium s t a t e , multiple 65
path 1 1 8 decomposition into
E - C l o s e n e s s of dynamic s y s t e m s structurally stable
23.24 equilibrium s t a t e s 218
of functions t o rank r 2 of multiplicity r 65
of regions 27 simple 66
of r e g u l a r transformation t o e-Extension of a region 151
identity t r a n s f o r m a t i o n 27.28
to rank r 2 4 Focal value, f i r s t 9 2
Conjugate e l e m e n t a r y a r c s 146 calculation 244
Focal values 243, 244 Rotation of vector field of a dynamic
s y s t e m 29
Hamiltonian dynamic s y s t e m 405
Saddle-to-saddle s e p a r a t r i x 97
e-Identity of partitions into paths Semistable limit cycle 107
in a plane region 31 Separatrix loop of a saddle-node,
on a s p h e r e 58 creation of a l i m i t cycle 322,
Integral invariant 402 324,326
density 402 of a saddle point, creation
of a limit cycle 309,311,319
Limit cycle (also s e e Creation of a stable 301,304
limit cycle) saddle-to-saddle 97
multiple 103 Simple intersection point of two
of multiplicity k 108 c u r v e s 15
s e m i s t a b l e 107 root of a function 8
simple 103,109 Singular elements 1 4 1
stable 1 0 7 paths. s e m i p a t h , a r c s of paths
unstable 1 0 7 140, 141
Sinks 141
Lyapunov value 244 Sources 141
Stable limit cycle 107
Method of small p a r a m e t e r s e p a r a t r i x loop 301,304
(Poincare' method) 409 Structural instability, d e g r e e of
Metric in the s p a c e of dynamic 206,207
s y s t e m s in a plane region 51-52 Structurally stable dynamic s y s t e m in
on a s p h e r e 52 - 54 a plane region 55
Multiple equilibrium s t a t e , decom- on a s p h e r e 58
position into s t r u c t u r a l l y stable intersection point of two
s t a t e s 218 c u r v e s 15
Multiplicity of a common point of path 62
two c u r v e s 15 root of a function 8
of a limit cycle 108,272 Structural stability of dynamic s y s t e m s
of a multiple focus 243 relative t o a given s p a c e 59
of an equilibrium s t a t e 6 5 Structurally unstable path 6 2
of a root of a function 7, 1 0 closed path 133
relative t o a given c l a s s of s e p a r a t r i x loop 301,304
functions 13, 14 Succession function on an a r c without
contact n e a r a closed path 104, 378
on a n o r m a l t o a closed path
116
on a" r a y f r o m a focus 91 - 92,
Poincare' method 401 240
Symmetry of phase p o r t r a i t 190
Region of stability in the l a r g e of a Systems c l o s e t o conservative 408,409
s i n k 189 t o Hamiltonian 408,418
with n o r m a l boundary 139 of f i r s t d e g r e e of s t r u c t u r a l
Regular partition of a region 146 instability 206,331
e-Translation of a s e t 31
Repulsion elements ( s o u r c e s ) 141
Unstable limit cycle 107
482